Social Enactive Perception: Practices, Experience, …...1 and in the last section of chapter 2...
Transcript of Social Enactive Perception: Practices, Experience, …...1 and in the last section of chapter 2...
Social Enactive Perception:
Practices, Experience, And Contents
By
Alejandro Arango
Dissertation
Submitted to the Faculty of the
Graduate School of Vanderbilt University
in partial fulfillment of the requirements
for the degree of
DOCTOR OF PHILOSOPHY
in
Philosophy
May, 2016
Nashville, Tennessee
Approved:
José Medina, Ph.D. Lisa Guenther, Ph.D.
John Lachs, Ph.D. Shaun Gallagher, Ph.D.
Copyright © 2016 by Alejandro Arango All Rights Reserved
iii
To my professors, everywhere
iv
Acknowledgements
This dissertation is the fruit of a tree whose innumerable roots reach deep. A proper list of
acknowledgments is impossible. On the visible side of things, I would like to acknowledge the help of
many people who made it possible for me to get this point; people who contributed to my philosophical
education, to my social wellbeing, and to my personal growth. First, I would like to thank José Medina,
Randy Friedman, and Bernardo Correa López, my mentors in philosophy throughout the years, who
have been so generous with me. At Nashville and Vanderbilt, friends and fellow philosophers made the
ride easier. Adam, Carolyn, Geoff, and Andrea have been wonderful fellow philosophy travelers. My
non-philosophy Nashville friends are too many to name; their presence has made these last few years a
lot richer and more enjoyable than they would have otherwise been. I would also like to thank my
dissertation committee members, Lisa Guenther, John Lachs, and Shaun Gallagher, and the people in
the Philosophy Department at Vanderbilt. I am grateful too for my friends and professors at
Binghamton, where these ideas began to germinate. I would like to thank especially Shoni Rancher,
Sarah Seeley, Regan Rule, Jack Marsh, Max Pensky, and Bob Guay.
My family has always been with me. En ella he encontrado el ánimo y la seguridad que en tantas
ocasiones he extraviado. I have always noticed the supportiveness, in our Colombian way, of my mother,
my father, my sister, my nephew, my two very special aunts, my uncles, and my cousins. Esta nota
estaría incompleta si no mencionara mi gratitud por la compañía de Manuel a través de los años.
I am profoundly grateful for having had the company of all these people along the way.
v
Like trees we grow – it’s hard to understand, like all life! – not in one place, but everywhere; not in one direction, but upwards and outwards and inwards and downwards equally;
our energy drives trunk, branches, and roots all at once.
Nietzsche, The Gay Science
vi
Table of Contents
Acknowledgements ......................................................................................................................................... iv Introduction ....................................................................................................................................................... 1 Chapter I Perceptual Practices ......................................................................................................................................... 9 1.1 Social Practices And Their Theoretical Role ............................................................................... 11 1.2 The Perceptual Practices Approach ................................................................................................... 20
1.2.1 Contextuality .................................................................................................................................... 30 1.2.2 Performativity .................................................................................................................................. 36 1.2.3 Expressivity ...................................................................................................................................... 43 1.2.4 Normativity ...................................................................................................................................... 51
1.3 From Practices to Experience .............................................................................................................. 58 Chapter II Perceptual Experience as the Basis for Perceptual Content ................................................................ 61 2.1 The Felt Quality of Perceptual Experience ...................................................................................... 64 2.2 Phenomenon, Appearances, and Relationality: The Real Object When Perceived ................ 68 2.3 On Appearances, Aspects, and Properties ......................................................................................... 78
2.3.1 From Relationality to Activity ..................................................................................................... 79 2.3.2 High-Level Properties .................................................................................................................... 83 2.3.3 Pragmatic Dependence .................................................................................................................. 89
Chapter III Perceptual Experience and Perceptual Content ................................................................................... 101 3.1. The Relation between Perceptual Experience and Perceptual Content ................................. 105 3.2 The Polemics with Chalmers: Visiting the Garden of Eden for The First Time .................. 106 3.3 Eating from The Tree of Science and The Presentational Desideratum ................................ 110
3.3.1 Directness and The Three Dependencies of Perception ...................................................... 121 a. Idiosyncratic Dependencies .......................................................................................................... 124 b. Non-Socially Pragmatic Dependencies ..................................................................................... 127 c. Socially Pragmatic Dependencies ............................................................................................... 129
3.3.2 Are There Perfect Sensory Properties? ................................................................................... 130 3.4 Eating from the Tree of Illusion and the Veridicality Desideratum ........................................ 142
3.4.1 In Virtue of Appearances, Not In Spite of Them ................................................................... 157
vii
Chapter IV Dynamic Content in The Social Enactive View ................................................................................... 163
4.1 Object and Content: The Relation Between Perceptual Object and Object-As-Perceived .... 166 4.1.1 Perceptual Intentional Relation and Object-As-Perceived ............................................. 174
4.1.2 Perceptual Intentionality, Detachability, High-Level Properties, and Perceptual Practices ..................................................................................................................................................... 182 4.2 Full Content Is Core Content plus Environing Content ........................................................ 184
4.2.1 Lowest-Level Interpretive Take on Physical Reality: The Roots of Normativity ... 191 4.3 The Charge of Phenomenalism ..................................................................................................... 198
Chapter V The Normativity of Perceptual Experience and of Dynamic Content ............................................ 206
5.1 Perceptual Experience as Original Intentionality .................................................................... 208 5.1.1 Perceptual Experience Grounds Awareness ...................................................................... 215 5.1.2 Perceptual Experience Grounds Thought, Judgment, and Inference .......................... 215 5.1.3 Perceptual Experience Grounds Perceptual-Related Action ......................................... 219 5.1.4 Perceptual Experience Grounds Perceptual-Related Emotion ..................................... 222
5.2 The Normativity of Perceptual Content ..................................................................................... 224 5.2.1 Core Content Is Not Individuated Conceptually .............................................................. 226 5.2.2 Full Content’s P-Properties And The Case of Attention ................................................ 227 5.2.3 Master Argument for Pragmatic Normativity of Perceptual Content: A Pragmatic System of Possibilities ....................................................................................................................... 229 5.2.4 Environing Content at the Lowest Level ........................................................................... 239
5.3. Objections .......................................................................................................................................... 243 5.3.1 Crowell, Environing Content, and the Lowest Basic Level of Contact With Physical Reality .................................................................................................................................................... 243 5.3.2 Siegel's Comparisons and Properties ................................................................................... 249
References ...................................................................................................................................................... 257
1
Introduction
Perception is one of the fundamental ways in which we are in contact with the world. We
inhabit the world with others; our lives are determined and structured by this fact. The texture
of our lives—what we do, the things we encounter everyday, and the things that are significant
for us—is largely perceptual, and this perceptual character is woven into the fabric of our
relations with others. Perception, as a way of relating to the world, and sociality, as a fact of our
lives, belong together. This is what social enactive perception is about.
This dissertation offers the Social Enactive Theory of Perception, or SEP, a theory of
perception that accounts for this mutually constitutive link. According to SEP, perception
consists in socially constituted, sensory-based practices of interaction with objects, events, and
states of affairs. SEP situates itself in opposition to representationalist views—the paradigm in
Modern and contemporary thought about perception—, and on the side of a family of theories
comprising realism, relationalism, as well as situated cognition theories and other theories of
phenomenological inspiration. More precisely, and in a positive fashion, SEP is a refinement of
enactivism about perception, whose most notorious representatives are Alva Noë, Susan Hurley,
Evan Thompson, and Daniel Hutto.
The most distinctive feature of SEP, and a common denominator of both its rejection of
representationalism and its improvement of enactivism, is its social character. It is customary to
think of perception as an essentially and incontestably individual business through and through.
After all, the thought goes, I smell with my nose—it is my nose, I like the smell or I don’t, it is
my nerves, it is my brain cells and circuits. What can be more personal than the way things
appear perceptually to me? Whatever social features seem to appear in perception, the standard
theory says, they are not properly perceptual. In the case of representationalism, since
perception is understood as a matter of personal representations that play the functional role of
inputs, there is no room ex hypothesi for the social. In the case of standard enactivism, perception
2
is conceived as a matter of sensorimotor individual correlations, so there is only room for
perception as an individual occurrence. In SEP’s view, conceiving of perception as an individual-
only business is fundamentally wrongheaded.
For SEP, perception is neither only nor mainly an issue of smells and colors and the way
they are translated or not into brain lingo. It is neither only nor mainly about qualia—about
how it feels to smell or taste something. It is not about mental things, if that means things
happening in consciousness as in an inner space.
For SEP, the problems of perception are problems of fundamental philosophical
anthropology. In order to understand perception, it is necessary to understand perceivers, and
understanding perception helps us understand what perceivers are. The key to perception lies in
the type of life we lead—in the way we inhabit the world. What lives do we lead? This issue is
largely a matter of how we see ourselves, a matter of the type of beings that we think we are.
We must have a theory of perception in which we can recognize ourselves—in the one who
dances and plays music, in the one who cooks handed-down recipes, in the one who pets a dog
or a cat, in the one who is moved by the memories that a smell conjures. We must be able to
recognize the rich, finely grained, and nuanced ways in which we do things with and about the
things we perceive, and the importance these things have in our lives.
The Social Enactive View is heavily influenced by the contextualist, pragmatic view of
Wittgenstein, and by the phenomenological views of Husserl and Merleau-Ponty, and of their
contemporary heirs.1 Through his notion of social practices, Wittgenstein proposes a way of
looking at forms of life that situates what we do as partaking of the active as well as of the
social. The significance of his view for perception is hinted at by Hurley, who says: “What is
needed, rather, is to understand why it is no accident that only perceivers are agents, as well as
why it is no accident that only agents are perceivers: to understand the interdependence of
perception and action” (Hurley 1998, 242). For the phenomenologists, perception is a matter of
1 Heidegger’s and Levinas’ phenomenologies have also been important influences for this work, though their influence is more global than specific.
3
the essential link between our embodied nature and our own mode of being in the world, both as
subjects and as members of intersubjective communities.
As a sort of synthesis of both influences, conceptualizing perception as a practice consisting
of perceivers’ interactions with the world reflects the idea that there is no proper theory of
perception that does not entail substantive commitments about what perceivers are and what
the world is. The interrelation between subjectivity, intersubjectivity, and world has been a
central tenet of phenomenological thought, especially in Husserl and Merleau-Ponty, and more
recently in the situated approaches to cognition, of which enactivism is a part.
The distinctive element of SEP is its social element and the way it qualifies our engagement
with the world. Let me then make explicit what I mean by the social.2 While I think that social is
not exclusively a human category, I only refer here to human sociality, which I take to be
synonymous with intersubjectivity.3 For SEP, the social is an ontological condition of the human
being. It is a dimension of our existence constituted by the fact that we partake in ways of doing
things, and that our individual engagement with things is based on those shared styles. Our
common ways of doing things, our practices, depend on the fact that human beings live
together: we are born in the midst of communities, are raised by others, are taught by others,
create ties and relationships with others, exert our natural capacities with others. Our social
practices, which define sociality, rest upon our physically living together.4
Living together, not just physically, is defined by the participation in shared patterns of
behavior. Concretely, the social is instantiated in shared ways of doing things. Sociality is
expressed in families, cultures, political organizations, generations, religious communities,
sexual orientation-defined communities, political communities, dominant groups, cultural elites,
2 This view of the social is embedded all throughout this dissertation, but it can be seen with special clarity in chapter 1 and in the last section of chapter 2 (section 2.3.3). 3 For an account of sociality pertaining animal groups in general see my Animal Groups and Social Ontology (Arango, 2015). 4 For SEP social practices are what we intuitively find in familial customs, cultural habits, class styles, generational similarities, which are taught to or picked up by newcomers—newborns are a type of newcomer. A language, with all its regional, class, temporal, dialectal, lexical, and phonological variations, is the paradigm of a social practice. The cultural anthropologists’s objects of study are social practices in the sense here employed (Lance and O’Leary-Hawthorne, 176).
4
guilds, groups of friends, etc. The characteristics of human groups or social formations depend
on the activities people undertake in shared ways. The political, the aesthetic, the ethical, the
epistemological, and the perceptual, among others, are spheres of practices and determine
communities. All practices are worldly and historical practices. There is no practice that is not a
way of inhabiting a space. There is no practice that does not stand in relation to a history of
practices. As for origins, in the social domain there is never truly a first time—a first time for
cooking, a first time for speaking, a first time for feeling pain—for there is always a gradient of
something that was there before.
Thus, wherever there are social practices, there is a social formation. And the type of social
formation depends on the type of practices in common—from guilds of carpenters to nations as
political organizations. Further, social formations range both in size and in duration, from the
small and ephemeral to the broad and temporally stable—from families to cultures.5 Sociality is
a function of the endless overlapping and interweaving of social formations defined by shared
practices.
SEP’s conception of sociality has the characteristic that it is synonymous with
intersubjectivity. This fundamental characteristic means that individuals are never merely
subsumed under groups, for those shared practices are still performed by individuals, and while
a good deal of meaning depends on shared aspects, the person still contributes to her own take
on things. Individual performances do not stand in a social void. Intersubjectivity supposes
subjectivity, but it does not assume either’s primacy.6 In the crisscross of the multiple,
5 In the discussion about what culture is, I take culture to be a pole in the continuum of intersubjective human life. Culture consists in sets of practices common to groups of people that normally inhabit the same territory and have had a similar history, that is transmitted mostly generationally, that is constantly transformed, and that encompasses beliefs, norms, rules, cognitive approaches, and material dependencies, all of which are nevertheless understood as dependent on the level of practices. I situate myself between those who think of culture as the commonality of customs and uses, of norms and rules, or of “shared routines” of people inhabiting a territory (Brumann 1999) and those who are skeptic of culture in light of social fluidity, particularly the fluidity of the contemporary world. I certainly do not think that the commonalities are about beliefs and mental representations, as mainstream cognitive anthropologists think (Atran, Medin, and Ross 2005, 744–750, Romney 1999). 6 While in animal species there is a notion of individual organism that is necessary for an account of sociality (see Arango 2015), there may be other living species whose sociality does not require a notion of individuality. In the case of the human being, our individuality is a subjectivity, and our sociality is an intersubjectivity.
5
overlapping social formations to which a person belongs, she expresses her individuality, which
is never an entirely original, isolated, and individual performance.
I would like to add a couple caveats about two things that SEP is not and does not do.
First, SEP is not a theory of the perceptual aspect of social things, but about the social nature of
perceptual things.7 Second, I do not examine the influence of language on perception. SEP does
not conceive of perception as a linguistic issue. Our linguistic practices are in some cases part of
our perceptual practices, and they are at times mutually constitutive, as in the case of speech.
SEP is not an analysis of perception in terms of the words we use or the languages we speak.
There is undoubtedly a place for that analysis, but SEP is a philosophical theory of perception in
its non-linguistic aspect: in the things we do, which, I claim, are those aspects of perception that
take place based upon a consensus of action with others.
7 Some enactive theorists like De Jaegher and Di Paolo (2007) and McGann and De Jaegher (2009) have proposed other ways of linking enactivism and the social domain. One strand of these social enactive proposals focuses on the constitution of meaning as it happens in interactions with the world and others—what they call “participatory sense-making” (“how meaning is generated and transformed in the interplay between the unfolding interaction processes and the individuals engaged in it” (De Jaegher and Di Paolo 2007, 486)). In this case, the object of study is the consitution of meaning in the social domain, and the analysis is not perceptual.
A different area explored by social enactivists (McGann and De Jaegher 2009) is referred to as “social cognition,” by which they mean cognition of others, specifically our undestanding of the other in interpersonal interactions. In other words, it is about how we make sense of others. To put it in more traditional terms, they take up the problem of other minds, and offer an enactivist solution to it. The specific connection with perception is perhaps more clear in De Jaegher’s “Social understanding through direct perception? Yes, by interacting” (2009). Here the focus is the understanding of others, not perception. Perception is instrumental to the goal of social understanding. The difference between this social enactivism and SEP is the difference between an account of the understanding of others partly through perceptual interaction, and an account of perception itself as an interaction, which is at the heart of SEP. However, for SEP our interactions with others are also interactions with the world, however peculiar, and in that sense, they fall under the scope of SEP. See chapter 1, footnote 29, for further clarification on the relation between SEP and the perception of others.
McGann and de Jaegher have talked about understanding others as a perception-based activity that, instead of sensorimotor contingencies (sensorimotor enactivism), relies on mastery of self-other contingencies. If Noë’s enactivism cashes the relation action-perception in terms of sensorimotor knowledge, McGann and de Jaegher propose a knowledge of the ways in which the subject’s behavior is attuned to others’, that is, how the subject masters the way in which others change according to her behavior, and the way she adapts to others’ behavior’s changes. These self-other contingencies are not perceptual, though they are perceptually based. For SEP, however, something more is needed. As an understanding of perception in general, SEP requires contigencies—or dependencies, as I call them—that are part of perception in general. The result is the three dependencies of perception that I develop in chapter 3.
Thus, in contrast with the social enactive theories just mentioned, the Social Enactive Theory of Perception (SEP) does not focus on the perceptual aspect of elements of the social, including the perception of others (as if perception occupied itself sometimes with social stuff and at other times it didn’t), but rather on the social aspects that are constitutive of perception in general. Instead of taking the social at first as its object and inquiring for how perception serves that goal, what is distinctive about SEP is that it takes perception and inquires into how perception, in its workings, is intrinsically social, that is, in how perception is partly constituted by the intersubjective domain. The different social enactivisms just reviewed are linked and are complementary in various ways, and I consider SEP to be broadly compatible with other available social enactivisms.
6
In order to situate sociality in a constitutive relation to perception that takes place in the
form of an active engagement with the world, SEP is deployed in two tempos or gears. Chapter
1 offers the overall framework for the understanding of perception as a matter of practices:
shared ways of doing things with perceptual objects. Perception is woven into social perceptual
practices that are characterized by contextuality, performativity, expressivity, and normativity. This is
a diachronic approach to perception. The second gear is a synchronic approach to perception,
executed in chapters 2 through 5. In those chapters I focus on the shortly temporally bounded
individual interactions of a perceiver with worldly things. A central feature of SEP is that the
practice-based view of chapter 1—that perception is best understood as a type of social
practice—entails that the diachronic conditions the synchronic. In other words, that social practices
condition individual interactions.
The significance of this relationship between the diachronic and the synchronic approaches
is that even seemingly individual-only, practice-independent aspects and elements of perception
are, in relevant respects, constituted by social practices. The aspects and notions that have been
traditionally considered the descriptive and explanatory blocks of perception are: recognitional
and discriminatory capacities; individuation of perceptual objects, sensory properties, and
phenomenal qualities; perceptual content; and normativity of perceptual content. Thus, in
chapters 2 through 5 SEP investigates the traditional topics of philosophy of perception in a
broad framework that makes justice to the complexity of perception.
It is important for SEP’s take on the social that it does not reduce perception to shared
practices, as if the normative onus is on the social side alone—this goes in hand with
understanding sociality as intersubjectivity.8 Perceptual interactions operate on the basis of a
baseline knowledge—the mastery of techniques in which practices consist—, in which the
subject is able to interact and produce in manners that are partly individual.9 As in the case of
8 See Medina (2010) for an argument rejecting both individual and social normative inflation. 9 There is a second sense of pragmatic dependence, namely, that in individual interactions perceptions and their aspects depend on the personal-level activity in which a person is engaged. For instance, in a perceptual comparison between two kinds of paper (in order to choose one notebook over another, or in order to determine which one fits a
7
speaking a language or playing an instrument, the fact that the techniques are fundamentally
social does not mean that they are the sheer repetition of models, bur rather enactments of
possibilities in the midst of pragmatic circumstances, in which individual goals, styles, and
constraints also operate. It is the same sense in which an individual speaker of the Spanish
language is likely to use a noun after an article because of grammar structure, which is a feature
of our linguistic practices, even though the speaker is performing an individual activity. When a
person speaks, her use of a language is not a private fact of her life, although it is certainly
something she does.10
Chapters 2 through 5 present the synchronic instantiation of the diachronic perceptual
practices in the following way. Chapter 2 starts by developing a notion of perceptual experience
as interaction with worldly objects, events, and states of affairs, characterized by the fact that
these objects are temporally extended and appear only in perspectives or appearances, and do so
as a function of the materiality of perceptible reality and of the activities in which perceptual
interactions consist. This constitutive link between experience and the contents of experience is
further explored in chapter 3 through a detailed comparison with the way representationalism
conceives the connections between experience and content. This broad scope makes this chapter
be the longest one in this dissertation. Particular attention is paid to two structuring elements
of the representationalist view: perception’s intrinsic need for veridicality and perception’s
fundamental indirect character. SEP’s rejection of both these features is at the very core of the
Social Enactive View. SEP objects to these views by offering a series of arguments for the
directness and trustworthiness of perceptual appearances. The appearing of objects in
perspectives will then be qualified through the three types of dependencies or mediations at
certain job better) the perceiver may not be aware of the color of the papers at all. Although most of this interaction can be seen as instantiating a perceptual practice—the idea of comparing papers’ thickness for the socially constituted activity of notebook use—, it is possible to see in what sense the dependence is to an extent event-bounded. This sense of pragmatic dependence is secondary. It will be accounted in chapters 2 through 5. 10 Naturally, SEP takes into account the existence of physiological constraints, some of which are universal or nearly universal (i.e. the range of electromagnetic spectrum to which retina’s rods and cones are sensitive, or the frequencies that are normally captured by the human ear). However, even the relative significance of sensory properties (smells, flavors, colors) or perceptual categories (parts and wholes) are subject to pragmatic determination. These two elements are present all throughout the dissertation and will be specifically targeted where appropriate.
8
work in perception: idiosyncratic, non-socially pragmatic, and socially pragmatic. I argue that the
appearing of things specified along the lines of these dependencies is the proper meaning of
directness in perception, which provides further explication for dropping veridicality as a
concern about perception.
Chapter 4 is devoted to perceptual content, where, on the basis of the distinction between
perceptual object and object-as-perceived, it is argued that the full content of a perceptual
interaction should be parsed between core content, which picks the always-changing, dynamic
specific object or aspect of our actions and predications, and environing content, which picks
perceptual aspects surrounding objects that play a role in perceptual transitions and variations
of objects, and go all the way down to the very contact with physical properties of the world.
This division between core and environing is not about the nature of content, but about its
structure and about levels of concretion of possibilities within the whole perceptual field.
Chapter 5 further investigates perceptual normativity, now addressed under the synchronic
lens. This section responds to SEP’s dropping of the narrow concern for veridicality. It is shown
that SEP has a more appropriate notion of normativity for perception than representationalism.
This version articulates our ways of doing things perceptually, the relation of perception with
other aspects of our mental life, and the relation between objects and content. In this view,
normativity is about the placement of perceptual stuff in a system of possibilities and
expectations—a matter of degrees of fulfillment of expectations in a horizon of pragmatic
significance, where both expectations and horizon are a function of the socially constituted
interactions between perceivers and a rich theory of appearances.
Chapter I
Perceptual Practices
In perception, we relate to worldly objects, events, and states of affairs on the basis of what we
smell, what we taste, what we hear, what we touch, what we see, the feeling of our own bodies,
and what we perceive through other modalities, such as the feeling of temperature, and different
combinations of these modalities. Perception is about our sensory acquaintance with worldly
objects, events, and states of affairs, including our own bodies.
Our mastery of things perceptual extends to every nook of our lives. Our perceptual
mastery is not about abstract sounds or geometrically defined shapes. Our mastery of perception
is about the food we cook, the clothing we put on, and the music we listen to, dance to, enjoy
and dislike. It is about the way we speak and the way we relate to others’ utterances,
exclamations, and expressive sounds. It is about the importance we give to the smell of things
and people, about the things or spaces we make smell as we like. It is about the fabrics, walls,
and skins that surround us and whose textures matter for us. Thus, in perception, we are
constantly in relation to others. In this relationship with the world and with others, we are not
simply receptive. We are also active and productive. We move closer to others in order to hear
them better, we present ourselves to others through fabrics and their colors, or through the
smells we put on or simply allow. And in everyday life, in the food we eat, in the food we cook—
that we serve, eat, smell, and taste—we are actively relating to others in complex ways that
reflect our backgrounds, stories, styles, personalities, and also preferences.
In this chapter I propose the view that perception is properly understood as woven into a
type of social practices that includes food, dance, dress, music, languages, etc. More specifically,
I propose that perceptual practices are the enactment of culturally structured, normatively rich
techniques of commerce of meaningful multi- and inter-modal perceptible material. This thesis
10
constitutes one of the central tenets of the Social Enactive Theory of Perception (SEP). On
SEP’s view, perception is not an individual process of recognition and assessment of perceptual
properties, playing only the functional role of input for a separately conceived output, partly
serving higher-level cognitive activities. SEP agrees that there are individual processes involved
in perception, i.e. brain-processes, and that perception can be understood at times as receptive,
provided receptivity is not characterized by passivity. SEP denies, though, that individual
processes and receptivity are the categories under which perception should be placed and
understood. In contrast, SEP holds that all things perceptual are defined by their being woven
into perceptual practices and, as such, dependent on their motivations, methods, and goals.
Perception is a social practice whose activities have significance for everyday life. While the
perceptual aspect does not exhaust the nature of these practices (for cooking is also about the
sustenance of the organism, and listening to music could also be for the sake of someone’s
emotional well-being) perception is at their core—it is essentially woven into them.1
This chapter follows a Wittgensteinian way of thinking about practices. I first outline the
contextual pragmatism of Wittgenstein and extend the mostly linguistic-based arguments of
Wittgenstein and several commentators to the perceptual domain. I will argue that perception
is the type of thing that finds “bedrock” at a pragmatic level, instead of at a semantic or syntactic
one. I will show how perceptual practices evince the triple structure Medina (2003) has
identified in practices: contextuality, performativity, and normativity. To these three characteristics,
I will add expressivity as an essential feature of perceptual practices.
The notion of perceptual practices shares the basic enactive insight that perception is not
merely receptive, but rather, that perception is a way of acting. In this chapter I begin to
distinguish the Social Enactive Theory of Perception (SEP) from sensorimotor enactivism,
whose best-known representatives are Alva Noë, Susan Hurley, Evan Thompson, and Daniel
1 About language-games, Wittgenstein said: “I shall also call the whole, consisting of language and the activities into which it is woven, a ‘language-game’” (2009a, §7). German-English bilingual editions of Wittgenstein’s works are confusing as to pagination, hence I give the number of the sections or remarks where quotations are located, except for the English version of The Blue and Brown Books (1965), where I stick to the standard pagination usage.
11
Hutto. Instead of talking about individual sensorimotor actions, where movement is the key to
perceptual interactions, I argue that perception encompasses a richer set of determinations,
namely, those that belong to the socially constituted techniques in which it plays a role.
Perceptual practices are not simply individual actions, but socially structured ways of going
about perceptual things. While individual variations aren’t precluded, a social background is
built into practices insofar as they are the product of processes of learning. Perceptual practices
are ways of inhabiting the world, and they are social. Following Wittgenstein, I hold that
perceptual practices constitute forms of life.
1.1 Social Practices And Their Theoretical Role
I take the lead to think about practices from Wittgenstein and the non-skeptical branch of his
commentators. On the non-skeptical view, Wittgenstein’s philosophy is not occupied with
solving philosophical problems, but rather with dissolving them by showing how the very
conceptual scaffolding on which such problems arise is not self-evident or commonsensical, as
the skeptics, and several traditional views, think.2 But what are the problems that are dissolved
by appealing to social practices? What are the issues and concepts that a contextualist, practice-
based view addresses?
A well-established tradition of commentators takes the issues to be located in the
philosophy of language.3 In this case we find, for instance, the issue of the skeptical threat of
meaning-indeterminacy relative to sensations and sentences: there is no non-arbitrary way of
securing our utterances’ references and meanings. Others think that the issues that the appeal to
practices addresses have to do with the nature of meaning itself (whether it applies to sentences,
2 Non-skeptical commentators of Wittgenstein include Hurley (1998), Lance and O’Leary Hawthorne (1997), Medina (2002; 2003; 2006; 2010), McDowell (1984), Michael Williams, and Meredith Williams (1999), among others. Of the skeptical commentators (those that do not reject the basic conceptual scaffolding of the traditional picture, and hence try to solve the problems presented by it, or realize their inescapability), Kripke (1982) is perhaps the most famous. 3 This is no surprise since the entry point of Wittgenstein himself into these investigations is quite often a linguistic one. Thus we read in The Blue Book: “What is the meaning of a word?” (Wittgenstein 1965, 1); and we see a direct questioning of Augustine’s account of language learning in both The Brown Book and in the Philosophical Investigations (Wittgenstein 1965, 77; Wittgenstein 2009a, §1). The Last Writings begin with the author wondering about a possible word “to frightle oneself” or “to torture oneself with fearful thoughts” (Wittgenstein 1982, 2), and even his Remarks on colour open with a language-game of reporting comparisons between colors (Wittgenstein 2004, 2).
12
beliefs, or other mental objects), with the concept of truth, and with the nature and possibility of
justification or other normative concepts, such as inference.
In a broader epistemological spirit, one can also see Wittgenstein concerned with the
seeming separation between the inner and the outer, and with the gulf between mind and world
(Wittgenstein 2009, §§281-315). Hurley (1998), on the other hand, gives linguistic views a twist
and puts Wittgenstein’s approach to practices in connection with themes in the philosophy of
mind such as the issue of content and content’s unity, both for action and for perception (which
one could see as mirroring the problem of reference). For Hurley, the main problem
Wittgenstein’s philosophy illuminates is one of aboutness, namely, the possibility that we have
targets for our actions and contents standing for the things we perceive, where perception is
treated as dealing with a phenomenal experience (Hurley 1998, 221).
The central idea of Wittgenstein-inspired contextualist pragmatism, according to the non-
skeptical brand of his commentators, is that the key to dissolve some traditional puzzles
concerning meaning, truth, and normativity, consists in appealing to our epistemic and socio-
linguistic practices. Social practices are the ground on which meaning, truth, and normativity
depend for their intelligibility and correctness, if we are to understand meaning, truth, and
normativity as actual phenomena and not as approximations to an ideal structure.
Skeptical views, in contrast, insist in searching for epistemological criteria in a domain
independent from our practices, such as an autonomous grammar or the realm of logical truth.
This route faces insurmountable obstacles in securing its epistemic privilege, and this is why
skeptical readings find that our communicative endeavors and our lives in common are illusory,
and we, delusional. This view dismisses the certainty and meaningfulness of everyday
experience because it assumes that traditional theories of meaning are correct in demanding
determinacy and immutability from out utterances and our epistemic repertoire (Medina 2006,
3). Non-skeptical readings dismantle these traditional requirements on meaning (and truth,
13
normativity, content, etc.), by focusing on the nature of social practices, in ways that will soon
be clear.
The fact that these pragmatisms have arisen in the context of philosophy of language
speaks of the pervasiveness of discursive, propositional frameworks as the default framework
used to deal with philosophical problems in epistemology, ethics, philosophy of mind, and
metaphysics. In this chapter I show how, notwithstanding this linguistic-turn inclination, the
practice-based framework is the proper one to understand perception, without making
perception a matter of our perceptual reports or our perceptual beliefs (whatever a perceptual
belief might be).4 I aim to show that the practice-based view on epistemic practices and language
can be transported to the domain of perception. This transposition will reveal the phenomenon
of perception, attending to its own features, in a way worthy of consideration, that is, without
making perception a matter of words—a matter of our smell or color vocabulary.
This is not the place either to launch a defense of the many deep issues that support a
pragmatic outlook on philosophy of language and epistemology. In what remains of this section,
I will at only offer an outline of the pragmatic orientation in general, making emphasis on a few
points that are important for my ensuing discussion on perception. In section 1.2 I will defend
the perceptual practices account on deeper grounds.
In the Social Enactive Theory of Perception (SEP), the appeal to practice tries to solve parallel
problems to those present in the linguistic and epistemological discussions. Traditional theories
of perception, mostly of representational lineage, are structured around questions concerning
the possibility and pervasiveness of illusion, the indeterminacy of perceptual aboutness, the
separation between mind and world, the seeming impossibility of directness in perception, the
difficult tensions between low-level and high-level properties, and the problematic relation
between perception and action in a framework that refuses to accept more than an instrumental
relation between them two. Some of these issues are issues of perceptual consciousness, issues of
4 Hurley also shows how core issues about mind are understandable in connection to Wittgensteinian themes (1998, 221–244).
14
perceptual normativity, and issues of the phenomenal aspect of perception. In this regard, this
chapter has a limited scope. In this chapter I won’t show how the appeal to practices
conceptualizes and attacks philosophical problems in all those areas—that is one of the tasks of
the entire dissertation.5 In this chapter I will offer the general outlook of perceptual practices.
This outlook is aimed at shifting the way of conceiving perception, the way of conceiving the
relation of perception to its objects, and the way of conceiving the relation of the perceiver, as a
perceiver, to the social and intersubjective structures in which she lives. This chapter will at
least start to show how and why SEP looks at perception the way it does. Borrowing an
expression from Hurley, part of the goal now is to begin to soften our confidence on the traditional
views, as well as to start to doubt their commonsensicality. Chapters 2 through 5 will account
for specific aspects of perception in the framework that takes perceptual practices as its basic
structure.
To think of a domain of philosophical reflection from a pragmatic point of view means to
see that its “ultimate global justification” is found “in terms of its usefulness to people” (Lance
and O’Leary-Hawthorne 1997, 135). “What is useful to people” does not refer to a set standard
of usefulness (utility or expediency) but should be understood as that which accords to the
explicit or implicit goals internal to what people do, even when the goal is the inertial
continuation of the way we do things. “What people do” is what Wittgenstein calls a “consensus
of action” (Medina 2002, 150), and such consensus is the basis for intelligibility and normativity,
although not merely on account of being a consensus. For Lance and O’Leary-Hawthorne, a
social practice—“what people do”—is “the basic vehicle of understanding” (1997, 133) and is the
structure of “social appropriatenesses” (1997, 184), that is, the space where actions and reactions
are subject to normative assessment. Normative assessment is also present in cases of mere
conformity to the allowed ways of doing things. Further, they argue that “we must interpret the
5 Chapter 3 will articulate a theoretical diagnosis of the central demands that traditional epistemology places, and wrongly so, upon perception—namely, the veridicality concern and the directness concern. These are demands that cause us to settle for theories that rob perception of its natural interactive role, in fear of conceding to skeptic worries about our contact with the world. For the idea of a theorical diagnosis see Medina (2006, 1–7).
15
community in terms of its practices” and the point to take from here is that there is no
interpreting device for a specific community more basic than what the community does (Lance
and O’Leary-Hawthorne 1997, 184).
The consensus of action on which practices consists is not only the de facto agreement in
behaviors and attitudes, that is, in actions, reactions, and dispositions, but a style of doing things
that is the product of processes of acculturation and training. The normative force of social
practices lies not in the number of practitioners but in its continued existence through time in a
community, where skilled practitioners train others into practices, by getting them to act
according to patterns of behaviors and within domains of moves allowed. This training does not
occur in an abstract space. It takes place against a background that includes a constant
environment, i.e. a stable, physically defined environment, and a certain natural set of
dispositions and reactions—which Wittgenstein called “natural reactions”— that can
nevertheless be shaped and developed (Medina 2002, 162; see also 136, 171).
In relation to training, Lance and O’Leary-Hawthorne have said that “talk about meaning
is concerned with language-learning moves, but tacitly presupposes that appropriate
recognitional capacities and dispositions to non-linguistic behavior are already in place” (1997,
137; Medina 2002, 162). The extension of a practice-based view to the perceptual domain will
partly deal with those capacities and dispositions to non-linguistic behavior. These capacities
and dispositions will be addressed not only in the sense that they are prior to linguistic learning,
but also insofar as they are constantly present in a person’s life, not simply subordinate to, but
coexistent with, language and other cognitive activities.
The normative dimension of practices, issuing from the processes of acculturation by which
novices are brought into such practices, configures a “space of attribution of commitments to
practitioners of the practice,” that is, a space where expectations about actions, reactions,
dispositions, attitudes, and other moves are in place, and are the basis for judgments about
behavior and attitudes of self and others (judgments that may not even arise when things are
16
done according to the established social practice) (Lance and O’Leary-Hawthorne 1997, 174–
175).
Social practices are characterized by contextuality, performativity, expressivity, and
normativity.6 Practices are contextual in that determination of meanings, truth, and other
normative aspects is only decidable by the whole concrete practices that happen over against
specific social circumstances, including a physical environment. Practices are performative
because they consist in actions, reactions and dispositions. Practices are expressive because they
express the form of life of a community. Communities, in this perspective, are not aggregations
of individuals but active groups structured by patterns of behavior (Medina 2002, 170). Lastly,
practices are normative because they feature a dimension of correctness and intelligibility—of
successfulness and pragmatic meaningfulness—that is exhibited in the practices themselves and
is grounded in the processes of training by which new practitioners are brought into the
community and by which the community continuously develops and transforms itself.
Wittgenstein’s view on practices is holistic: these four features are highly interwoven, and each
of them will appear in one way or another in the account of the other three. For example, there
is no talking of contextuality that is not at the same time performative, since the context is first
and foremost found in a normatively structured consensus of ways of doing things that express the
forms of life of the communities that practice them.
At the heart of the discussion on meaning, truth, and normativity is the idea that to
understand what we say or what we do partly means that we should be able to tell when what
we say (or do) is correct and when it is incorrect. It is also the idea that to understand what we
say means to be able to tell the intelligible from the unintelligible. In both cases there seems to
be an immediate appeal to a rule or norm that guides what we say or do. Counterfactually put:
unless there is a rule, there is no telling (i.e. it remains indeterminate) whether acts or words are
correct or intelligible. These are, at least, the terms in which the discussion has been conducted.
6 Medina has argued for the triplet contextuality, performativity, and normativity (2003, 62ff.). To that group I add expressivity.
17
The pragmatic take I am articulating refuses to take a semantic requirement (the idea that ‘how
to proceed' is fixed semantically, independently of practices), or consciousness of a semantic
requirement (that there is always a ‘knowing how to proceed’, an interpretation of a rule) as the
key to normativity. Does this practice-based view on rules surmount the classical problem of
indeterminacy?
In the practice-based view, acting according to a rule or guided by a rule is not a distinction
that can be actually brought to decide when an action or utterance is correct or intelligible. The
distinction is not entirely ruled out. It is kept but in a very deflated sense. The issue cannot be
decided either by considering an act or utterance in isolation from a social practice, or by
whether someone is consciously going by (or not going by) a rule. Rather, the primacy of
practice means that one is situated within a normative space when one acts in accordance to a
practice in which one is skilled, even if one doesn't know why things are done thus or so, or is
perhaps not aware of doing things thus or so. If there is a rule—and at this point the notion of
rule starts becoming misleading—, it is something immanent in practices. The deciding factor
is, once again, whether the patterned behavior is the product of the technique that was acquired
through a process of training or acculturation. And this process is the one by which novices are
taken to self-regulate their behavior so as to be in accord to the practices embedded in the
majority. When practices are performed by skilled practitioners, by members of a community,
the issue of consciously or unconsciously acting guided by a somewhat explicit rule loses its
intuitive grip as a way of demonstrating what following a rule consists in. Furthermore, an
action done when one is part of a social practice seems oftentimes done automatically. In this
respect Wittgenstein has said that things done in the spirit of the practice are cases of following
a rule blindly, and Lance and O’Leary-Hawthorne have referred to participation in unreflective
engagements or unreflective conformities. These engagements and conformities are a matter of
actions, reactions, and attitudes. In acculturation processes we not only learn to react in certain
ways upon certain occurrence but also learn to take certain occurrences as such and such, that is,
18
as having a certain significance and standing in need of a certain reaction. Perceptually, we can
say that a sensibility is learned along perceptual behavior. And while many actions are done
automatically, and there is a ground level of automaticity and unreflective conformity, this does
not mean that automaticity, blindness, or unreflectiveness are necessary for actions to be done in
the spirit of a social practice.7
Our unreflective engagement with the different domains of our social practices seems to be
mostly about actions, about what subjects do or don’t do. There is, however, a counterpart on
the side of items dealt with—sentences, actions, and objects. Let me introduce Lance and
O’Leary-Hawthorne’s notion of Quine-analytic sentences. For Lance and O’Leary-Hawthorne
the issue of truth is tied to the issue of whether there are analytic sentences at all, even
tautological ones. While they reject the existence of analytic sentences in themselves, much á la
Quine, they find it necessary to postulate a quasi-analytic type of sentences, whose quasi-
analyticity depends on actual social practices. These are termed Quine-analytic sentences and are
defined as sentences that do not admit of bare challenges, that is, they do not admit of being
questioned lest the questioner is taken to be an outsider, a joker, or a lunatic. In the reality of
social patterns of language use there are sentences that are taken to be analytic by speakers, and
whose being taken to be analytic by speakers is in fact the mark of what constitutes to be a competent
speaker, a practitioner, to be a member of the actual community of language users. The idea of
Quine-analyticity includes the entitlements carried by them: its not admitting of bare challenges
is a type of entitlement, and so it is, for instance, its being taken for granted in deductions or
inferences. I will get back in section 1.2 to the issue of Quine-analytic items, where I will
suggest that consensus about perceptual things are comparable to Quine-analytic sentences in
that questioning certain perceptual occurrences, such as combinations of flavors or ways of
7 The acknowledgement of this unreflective or automatic acting in a way that accords with rules should not be understood as an endorsement of a Dreyfus-like theory of mindless coping. Suffice it to say that, following Zahavi, the idea of mindlessness is very problematic since it limits the mindful to the conscious, in the sense of awareness. What matters, instead, is that actions that are done somewhat blindly or automatically have an experiential import that must be counted as mindful: “the level of absorbed coping involves a dimension of self-experience – at least in so far as that level is supposed to be experiential rather than simply a matter of non-conscious automaticity” (Zahavi 2013, 5).
19
consuming food, or what counts as perceptually appropriate when it comes to touch or color in
dressing, are entitlements carried by certainties analogous to Quine-analytic sentences, and that
disputing or challenging them amounts to place oneself outside of the community. (I will call
this analog the seemingly given8). One takes it for granted that loud yelling is not conducive to
listening to a song playing softly in the background—but a child may need to learn this. One
does not question whether one can add a sound to a cup of hot coffee—although one may
entertain the idea of adding a color. Those possible combinations, and the things deemed
appropriate, delightful, or disgusting, are also part of what skilled practitioners take for granted
and follow blindly, and thus constitutes perceptual practices.
Zooming out for a moment, the broader epistemological picture that underlies a pragmatic
approach is aptly put by Lance and O’Leary-Hawthorne: “despite the fact that there is no
substantive, non-circular, empirical reason to prefer [some Quine-analytic claims] to certain
other incompatible claims, our linguistic practice involves a world-view which is a loosely
defined set of sentences, practices, attitudes, and methodologies, each taken to be prima facie
justified in the sense that bare challenges to them are inappropriate. That is, there is an
arbitrarily stipulated onus of proof on anyone who would attempt to criticize these practices”
(Lance and O’Leary-Hawthorne 1997, 111).
By means of a reflection on the all-encompassing nature of social practices for a community
and its practitioners, we come to see that social practices are constitutive of world-views (as
Lance and O’Leary Hawthorne put it), or forms of life (Lebensformen, in Wittgenstein’s terms). In
fact, we find that Husserl’s notion of lifeworld (Lebenswelt) speaks of a similar reality in pointing
to the world that comes to be experienced in specific manners according to the practices by
which people inhabit it. SEP’s position in this respect is that our perceptual practices constitute
8 I will refer to the perceptual analog of Quine-analytics sentences as seemingly given perceptual instances, since the idea of the given plays a self-evident justificatory role in some traditional philosophies of mind, analog to that of the analytic in epistemological discussions. The seemingly given is a deflated notion in the same sense that Quine-analytic sentences are, that is, that their seemingly givenness or seemingly analyticity is, first, forceful yet only seeming, and second, that it is derived from practices in which it plays somewhat of a grounding role in its, once again, forcerful yet seeming character.
20
forms of life, world-views, lifeworlds—that the way we interact with perceptible material, act on
it and respond to it, is at the very core of our ways of inhabiting the world.
1.2 The Perceptual Practices Approach
In this section I present a series of arguments for the claim that a practice-based approach is
appropriate for perception. The following sections will show how perceptual practices share the
central characteristics of social practices previously described, namely, contextuality,
performativity, expressivity, and normativity. Weaving all these aspects together, the specific
definition I will propose is that perceptual practices are the enactment of socially structured and
regulated, finely attuned, techniques of commerce of meaningful perceptible material.
The Arguments From Seeing Aspects. In one of the preliminary studies for the
Philosophical Investigations, Wittgenstein observes that the visual experience of a person who
sees something she recognizes is not the same than that of a person who sees the same thing but
does not recognize it (1982, §§539, 574, 575). The phenomenological evidence is at an almost
intuitive level, but more is needed in order conceptually to ascertain the difference. But how can
this be done? “What can be cited in support of his seeing it [a smile, in this case] differently?”
(Wittgenstein 1982, §576).
Wittgenstein explains that visual experience exceeds what can be accounted for by solely
relying on sensory input, as his examples of the cube/box or the duck-rabbit show (2009b,
§§116, 118). This is the difference between having a visual experience (Sehenerlebnis) and having
an impression. In his view, if we relied solely on what could impact the retina, it would be
impossible to explain why the very same visual properties—which he calls the visual impression
(Gesichtseindruck)—are seen differently by the same person, or by two different people, one of
which was familiar with the object. There is a different story to be told, which suggests a more
complex conception of seeing: seeing is always seeing as or, what is the same, seeing aspects. The
trick, as it were, is that we always see as, but the as is hidden. In other words, the argumentative
21
strategy in using two different visual experiences sharing the same visual impression is to
highlight that while impression is necessary for visual experience to happen, it is not sufficient.
What does the as in seeing as consist in? What does seeing aspects entail for a theory of
seeing? One way to proceed is to investigate what makes the difference between different visual
experiences. One possibility is that the organization of an image and the aspects that such an
organization reveals are not a “property of the object, but an internal relation between it and
other objects” (Wittgenstein 1982, §517; Wittgenstein 2009b, §§247–248). These relations are
not additional to what is sensed. In this version, it is someone’s being able to grasp those
relations, evinced for example in the ability to describe shapes in a certain way, what makes it
possible to grasp an aspect.
On one end, then, perception is different from having impressions, and internal relations are
the key to explaining this difference. On the other end, we should try to clear up the relationship
between perception, on the one hand, and thinking and knowing, on the other. Since visual
experiences often involve familiarity with objects, which sometimes involve our having a
concept (Wittgenstein 1982, §741), does one see an animal, or does one know that what one sees
is an animal? Does one have to think about it before one says it is an animal? Does this mean
that perception is a type of knowing or thinking because of common characteristics with them?
Consider the following cases Wittgenstein examines:
“I look at an animal in a cage. I am asked: ‘What do you see?’ I answer: ‘A rabbit.’ — I gaze into the countryside; suddenly a rabbit runs past. I exclaim: ‘A rabbit!’” (1982, §549) “I see that an animal in a picture is transfixed by an arrow. It has stuck it in the throat and it sticks out at the back of the neck. Imagine the picture is a silhouette. — Do you see the arrow — or do you merely know that these two bits are supposed to be part of an arrow?” (1982, §644)
The first step in his reasoning is that it is wrong to try to impose a separation between
perceiving and recognizing, or between perceiving and thinking. To this end, one must imagine
the two-stage process that would take place if seeing were different from recognizing and from
22
thinking. What part of the experience whose exclamation was “A rabbit!” is recognition, and what
part is seeing? There is no telling. The question is ill-posed.
But this similarity is dubious because there are cases where there is seeing without
recognition. Think in the case of seeing something familiar but not being able to see it right
away as the familiar thing one soon comes to see it as—as when it takes a moment to recognize
an old acquaintance one has not seen in years (See Wittgenstein 1982, §544). This shows that
the recognition, or absence thereof, can lead to different visual experiences. Now, this would
work all the same if we downshifted the recognitional level, as it were, and said that there was
recognition—a person, a face—but not a detailed recognition—the old acquaintance. In that
same vein, one could say that one recognizes warmth when one walks in a sauna bath, i.e. that
one has a certain understanding of what goes on, namely, that it is a temperature, and that it is
not cold. Notice that one does not think in that moment counterfactually, but one would agree to
different counterfactuals: If I were wearing lots of clothing, the heat would be unbearable. Yet it
would clearly be a stretch to say that one recognizes warmth in such situation. These two cases
match the case of immediately seeing something, like the rabbit in the countryside in the
quotation above, or like fear rising after suddenly noticing a lion outdoors (Wittgenstein 1982,
§589). The common denominator in these last four cases (face, warmth, rabbit, and lion) is that
the type of familiarity underlying the encounter with those cases is characterized by immediacy
and bodily engagement. There is no room between seeing and recognition, but this does not
mean that seeing is the same as thinking or knowing.
The second example, the case of the animal transfixed by an arrow, offers a reductio
argument. If one does not really see the arrow but knows it to be one, that is, one infers that it is
an arrow, then one does never see any object. But we do see, or perceive, objects, events, and
states of affairs: arrows, cars, clouds, warmth, spiciness, etc. Therefore, it is not the case that the
familiar recognition in perception is a knowing. It is possible to motivate the conclusion in a
different way: If in the case of the drawing of an arrow one could not see the arrow because a
23
part of it was missing, then in every pictorial representation of an object there is always
something missing visually, for even in the most detailed two-dimensional reproduction, the
object would be missing the perspectival variations that only real objects could offer. Thus, in
pictorial representations one could never see objects. Furthermore, and by parity reasoning, any
case in which the “totality” of the object is not present is a case of the perceiver completing an
image, inferring, supplying what the visual impression offers with one’s own knowledge. Still by
parity reasoning, it could be argued that even in the case of a real object, there is always an
inference since no perspectival totality can be given at once, and the back side of visual objects,
for instance, is not given.9 This would mean that we never see any objects, neither in drawing
nor in normal interaction with objects. Yet we see objects.
But what do we make of the fact that perception is not detachable from a certain type of
recognition? Wittgenstein’s position is that perception is not thinking or knowing even though
some characteristics of perception are characteristics normally associated with thinking and
knowing. Perception shares with thinking and knowing what we can describe as the familiarity
of an encounter. The epistemological tradition of Modern philosophy takes it to be essential to
“familiarity” that it requires previous instances over against which a present situation is
compared, a comparison stage, and a conclusion output. To place perception in the same
category as thinking and knowing assumes that perception is an intellectualistic process that
requires of concepts, probably of language, employs logic, and seems separate from emotion and
feeling. However, perception’s familiar encounters with things perceived aren’t rational: one
finds warmth warm, as it were. It is found as something familiar, but there are no comparisons
made. In perception, there is a taking of things for something (Dafürhaltens). In perception, this
familiar encounter is behaviorally significant, even if not acted upon, and has a phenomenal
element (that may or may not be strongly felt).
Sensory impressions do not account for perceptual experiences, but what is combined with
sensory impressions is not a knowing or thinking process, but a type of immediate, bodily, 9 I explore in greater detail the issue of the perspectival appearing of perceptual things in chapter 3.
24
behaviorally related encounter with things in the world. Perception is a bodily engagement with
the world. This is why I prefer to refer to the familiarity of a perceptual encounter and not to
the recognition of an object or event. Recognition is located in the anatomy of inputs, in the
physiology of inferences, and using it unadvisedly becomes an obstacle to making sense of a
view that, like SEP, disputes the input-output picture of perception and action.
Aspects and Doings. Wittgenstein realizes that the difficulties in analyzing perception are
associated with the many phenomena and variations at play in perceptual experience (1982,
§§579–583). His remarks on perception in the Investigations, in the different preliminary studies
for the Investigations, and in the Remarks on Colour, among other works, are full of fine
distinctions involving the things we perceive, the aspects we perceive, the ways in which we
perceive, the relation of things perceptual with words, and of things perceptual with things
behavioral, to list only some.10 But it would be wrong to try to systematize or to offer a
taxonomy of Wittgenstein’s treatment of perception: the interrelatedness of aspects does not
yield that type of treatment. Once again, I want to use these distinctions as a way to weave
through conceptual difficulties. Here I pick one more thread of Wittgenstein’s argumentation
(1982, §§686, 728).
Part of the problem with all the different concepts, phenomena, and variations one could
find in live perception is not only that no one element furnishes a decisive proof of a new
perspective. It is not evident either what concepts or phenomena are to be addressed and how.
Next to ‘seeing aspects,’ one neighboring perceptual phenomenon is noticing the
organization of a visual array, in which a perceiver notices the dependence of a visual experience
on taking certain lines of a drawing to be connected in one way or another (Wittgenstein 1982,
§511). In the duck-rabbit case, for instance, one may notice that it looks like a duck when one
takes the lines that form the beak to be as if to the left, and not as if on top, for then one sees a
rabbit. There is also the phenomenon of suddenly becoming able to see an aspect—the dawning
10 These preliminary investigations include The Blue and Brown Books (Wittgenstein 1965), the Last Writing on the Philosophy of Psychology (Wittgenstein 1982) and fragments on the philosophy of psychology, known before as the second part of the Philosophical Investigations (Wittgenstein 2009b).
25
or lighting of an aspect—and which is the realization of a new perception, that is, of a new
perceptual experience, oftentimes accompanied by a linguistic expression (Wittgenstein 1982,
§§474, 495, 520).
So, what else is needed to give an account of perceptual experience additional to the
insufficiency of sensory input alone and the immediate comprehension of things perceived—the
familiarity? We start by realizing that we learned about perception by looking at the things we
do in relation to perception.
For instance, we can ascertain that there is a difference in two visual experiences when we
mimic things differently (Wittgenstein 1982, §575), or as we try to copy them (§598), or in the
ways we react to them (§§601-603), or in the descriptions we offer of them, among others
(§611). However, the perception and the accompanying action seem too close to each other, even
entangled. Consider the two following remarks:
“What kind of man is said to be enjoying this picture’s telling expression? Well, someone who looks at it this way, talks about it in such-and-such a way, and reacts to it this way.” (1982, §471) “I have always seen it as a rabbit could even mean: for me it always was a rabbit, I have always spoken to it is a rabbit. A child does this. It means that I have always treated it as a rabbit.” (1982, §§472)
In both cases, Wittgenstein is calling into question the distance and seeming difference
between perception and action, specifically action ensuing from perception. In the first case,
enjoying the “picture’s telling expression” requires a recognition of such type of expression.
Since recognition entails something other than the mere visual impression—for we can think of
someone who does not enjoy the picture’s telling expression, perhaps because she does not see
such telling expression—, so does the enjoyment. We then find that enjoying the picture
amounts to a certain way of looking and talking vis-a-vis the picture. In the second case, the
implication is clearer: to see something as something means (under certain conditions, I hurry to
add) to treat it as something. These conditions might be those of a person who does not reflect
upon a perception, and just keeps on going (as we do pretty much all the time) in the very way
26
in which we go down the street and see many things, some of which elicit and some of which do
not elicit a reaction. Similarly, in experiencing a change of aspect in an image (Aspektwechsel),
Wittgenstein remarks how the change is expressed in what “I occupy myself with,” which
makes the experience of change “similar to an action” (1982, §556).
In similar remarks, like the following ones about hearing a melody and a spotted wall,
Wittgenstein calls into question the distance between impression and action:
“Hearing a melody and the movements that go along with the particular way someone interprets (auffasst) or hears (hört) it.” (1982, §584) “It’s as if doing and the impression didn’t happen side by side, but as if doing shaped the impression” (1982, §586) “I hear it differently, and now I can play it differently. Thus I can render (wiedergeben) it differently.” (1982, §587)
To begin with, notice how even though the language of impressions is gestured at, the
impression appears already in experiential tones and not in the form of a raw uptake of
information. A decision on whether impressions are the same in aspect changes is downplayed
by Wittgenstein, since in order to decide this matter it is difficult to find criteria other than a
description of what is experienced (1982, §§609, 611).
The case of the melody shows the entanglement of doing and perceiving so clearly that
Wittgenstein asks: “Why does it seem so hard here to separate doing and experiencing?” (1982,
§585). Sure it is the case that the doing could have shaped the impression, but there is more than
an instrumental link between them. When dancing, a dancer’s listening to the music is modified
by the dancing movements that put different emphases on different sections or moments that
carry more significance for the dancing. At the same time, the dancing is modified by the music
as it is heard. How is a melody heard in different ways? It is heard differently by the emphasis
one puts on the melodic or rhythmic aspects, in the sounds of certain instruments, in the feeling
conveyed by certain sections, etc. A dancer can only dance to nuances in the music he is able to
listen to—yet not necessarily in a way that can be described or talked about. Since these
nuances are more than isolated sounds, but rather melodic and rhythmic sequences, a dancer can
27
only relate to sequences that can be brought to have corporeal significance, including, naturally,
stillness. The example has a counterpart in the case of a player that plays a melody they
recognize, whom can be addressed in this way: “But surely when you play it you don’t play it
anyhow, you play it in this particular way, making a crescendo here, a diminuendo there, a
caesura in this place, etc.” (Wittgenstein 1965, 166; emphasis is the author’s).
Hearing a melody is not a plain being impacted by or an absorbing of sounds, and while it
can be shaped by dancing or moving, the taking of sounds one way or another—always a
“taking something for something” (Dafürhaltens)—is a certain doing.11 This is a doing even if one
is not conscious of such doing, and even if it seems to be a passive taking it all up—there is not
absolute passivity. A similar relation is even clearer in the following remark:
“A wall covered with spots: and I occupy myself by seeing faces on it: but not so that I can study the nature of an aspect, but because I find those shapes interesting and because of the destiny that leads me from one to the next. More and more, aspects dawn, others fade away, and sometime I ‘stare blindly’ at the wall” (1982 §480)
In this case, the doing is the perceiving itself, and it is specified as the perception is specified.
Her occupying herself with faces is her seeing faces. When she let herself be led by connections
that arise on the go, there is also a doing, like when one plays to find shapes in clouds. And
when the perceiver “stares blindly at the wall” it is because no specific aspect lights up (or what
is the same: because the aspect consisting of “lacking aspects” lights up). It is not because at that
moment she is merely having an impression, as opposed to moments were impressions were
accompanied by something else. In fact, never does an impression exist apart from the being
taken as one thing or another (Dafürhaltens), and the seeing one aspect or another is part of the
occupying oneself with faces, or with staring blindly (See Wittgenstein 1965, 169).
11 Consider reports made in “aesthetic observations”: “‘You have to hear these bars as an introduction,’ ‘You must hear it in this key,’ ‘You must phrase the theme like this’ (which can refer to hearing as well as to playing)” (Wittgenstein 1982, §632). A few remarks below, Wittgenstein says: “In aesthetics isn’t it essential that a picture or a piece of music, etc., can change its aspect for me?” (1982, §634). Part of the point here is that artistic experience expresses very clearly the fact that aspects are essential perception. It is evident that in a lab experiment in which the subject is exposed to beeps or flashes of light there may be not be much of an aspect, however significant the results of those experiments might be for the purposes of understanding some physiological constraints or tendencies having a bearing on perception.
28
Notice, however, that I have been treating all seeing the same, and all hearing the same, as if
what we do when we hear is always the same, that is, as if hearing is only one thing. That is a
wrong assumption. Hearing, smelling, or tasting, and other modal-specific activities, along with
intermodal interactions, can each take different shapes so as to account for different types of
interactions. There is, for instance, an enormous difference between hearing the sounds in the
streets as a person walks on her way to take public transportation on her daily routine, namely,
without paying attention, and a seasoned dancer hearing a song while he dances to that song
(which he enjoys very much) with a partner with whom he enjoys very much to dance. These
two situations are different as well from the novice classical music spectator, listening to a long,
obscure symphony, attempting (naively) to catch every detail. Or take the case of looking at a
flower without looking at the color of the flower—without being conscious of it—and suddenly
turning one’s attention to its color (Wittgenstein 1982, §721). Those are clearly two different
ways of seeing the flower. Notice how something would be lost from each case, were they
reduced to a common type. These cases also reveal that perceiving, since it is a perceiving of
aspects, can be a voluntary act (Wittgenstein 1982, §§451, 453).
Thus, there are clear differences as to the activity of the perceiver in these cases, including
what to focus on, how attentive the perceiver is in each case, and to what concrete end she
perceives at the moment. But that is only one side of the story about the differences in ways of
hearing, smelling, touching, tasting, or seeing. The analysis of contextuality and performativity
will explore the roles different ways of doing things play in our lives.
Perception is a bodily engagement with the world happening at the level of lived experience,
in which the phenomenal and the responsive are indiscernible. This bodily engagement is a
matter of degrees of engagement: “engagement that reaches its highest intensity in the original
immediacy of the exclamation and its lowest in the silence of habit or indifference” (Krebs 2010,
129). As Hurley argues, the conflict felt by many philosophers in putting actions and responses
together comes from the programmatic assumption that perception and action are about inputs
29
and outputs. The fine shades of behavior and of lived experience that Wittgenstein explores and
that phenomenology takes as the basis of its theorizing question the input assumption and
deliver a different picture. But behind the assumption, or rather beyond it, what is at stake is a
way of looking at ourselves—at our lives, what we are and what we do. SEP follows
Wittgenstein and the phenomenologists in looking for a theory of perception that explains the
connection between the sensory and the significance of things for human existence—a theory of
perception where we could recognize ourselves and our lives.
The things we perceive and the ways in which we perceive matter in our lives. Smells,
tastes, flavors, textures, melodies, and others sensory aspects, have a significance in our lives,
which is evinced in the way we interact with them. Perception is interaction with a perceptible
world. This is the basic insight I have been trying to motivate up to now, and this is the insight
that I now will flesh out and develop as perceptual practices. Since ways of doing things, in the
sense here explored, are not individual but constitute social systems of possibilities and
appropriatenesses by which people live their lives, ways of doing things are forms of life.
Perceptual practices, my argument runs, are forms of life.
As I now turn to explore the four features of perceptual practices—contextuality,
performativity, expressivity, and normativity—I would like to insist that these features are
highly interwoven. There is no adequate discussion of each of them without reference to the
other three.
One of philosophy’s tasks is, Wittgenstein says, untangling knots (1982, §756). But this
“untangling knots” cannot be the undoing of the braids of actual life because actual life only
occurs in those richly woven braids. You can think of braided ropes with knots. It’s no problem
to disentangle the knots, but make sure to not destroy the rope in the process, such that we end
up with a collection of loose threads that hold or tie nothing.
30
1.2.1 Contextuality
Social practices are contextual in that the determination of meaning, truth, and normative aspects
(which depend on the type of practice: epistemic, moral, perceptual, emotional, etc.) is only
decidable by the whole concrete ways of doing things that occur in specific social circumstances,
including a physical environment.
Perceptual practices consist of shared ways of approaching, producing, and reacting to
perceptible material. The behavioral significance of things perceived and the perceived
perceptual properties are dependent upon established ways of interacting with object, events,
and states of affairs. Consensus on ways of interacting perceptually with objects influence what
we perceive, what is appropriate to do and perceive, and what is possible to do and perceive.
Take for instance the perceptual interaction with a beer—drinking the beer, savoring it.
This perceptual practice consists in the custom in which a relatively bitter, low-alcoholic
beverage is an object of enjoyment in specific modes and circumstances. The practice includes
the “mechanical” aspect of the action (how much it is served; how it is drunk, i.e. in sips, shots,
or with a spoon; whether it is normally drunk cold, or only ideally, or whether that is irrelevant,
according to the community); or the social occasion, specific environment, or weather in which
such practice is common, if those have social significance. In some parts of the world, for
instance, beer is a common drink for hot days. A beer can be perceived in many ways and these
many ways are partly dependent on context. It is the same beer, and it generates reactions and
invites interactions that are roughly similar to each other in a given community. This partly
means that it can have a different flavor depending on the context, but the rich and nuanced
perceptual interaction with a beer is about more than the flavor.12
12 These considerations do not exhaust the contextual character of perception, since specific perceptual interactions are personal, hence involving a pragmatic dependency at the personal level, and a host of personal-level considerations deriving, for instance, from the perspectival properties of objects. In the case of beer, for instance, the illumination that paints the beer in golden or darker colors, on the degree of personal preference for beer over other drinks, on the freedom or lack thereof by which the person ended up drinking a beer, among others, are cases of this personal level-dependencies which I treat in detail in chapters 2 through 5 in different ways. In chapter 2 I will also explain in more detail that the perceptual experience of taste is different from the perceptual experience of flavor (cf. section 2.3.2). Taste is related to taste buds in the tongue, whereas the experience of flavor is linked to taste, smell
31
There is a dependence of the broad domain of taste and flavor on this practice, but this
dependence is not an all-or-nothing thing, but it contributes to the delimitation, as it were, of a
perceptual horizon. The contextuality of the beer-drinking perceptual practice entails that a
certain range of taste-bilia and flavor-abilia —i.e. relatively bitter and non-dense liquid (a broad
description only intended here for illustrative purposes)— is placed within the domain of the
enjoyable. Since bitter flavors are not exclusive of drinks, the possibilities for consumption and
enjoyment (or dislike) of bitter items may be influenced by the place of beer within a broader
range of flavors. Since taste is connected to smell, and the experience of flavor is connected to
both taste and smell (plus tact, feeling of temperature, and even vision), it is conceivable that
attitudes towards beer may influence and be influenced by relevant configurations in other
sensory modalities.
To be clear, I am not saying that the sheer capacity of a human being to have a perceptual
experience of cold things, of cold beverages, of bitter things, or of bitter beverages depend on
there being beer-drinkers. That aspect is partly determined by anatomical and physiological
facts. They may be present in everybody all the same, or there may be personal differences, or
developmental differences (newborns vs. adults), or they could even get altered by experience or
by accidents.13 Think of nuanced flavor notes that one gets used to looking for and enjoying,
like wine connoisseurs seem to do.14 However, the perception of beer and bitter flavors—the
perceptual experience of them—depends on beer-drinking practices. It is certainly entailed by
SEP’s perceptual practices approach that a member of a community where no bitter beverages
somewhat similar to beer are enjoyed in the manner beer is, would have an entirely different
experience of a beverage like beer —a different perceptual interaction of it— than members of a
beer-drinking group would.
(retronasal), texture (receptors in the mouth, including lips, and even perhaps in texture perception with hands), temperature, and even vision. 13 In this sense, Block is wrong in “ridiculing social constructivism about phenomenal consciousness,” since it is not possible to isolate P-consciousness as sheer feeling, separate from aspects of the experience such as the disgust or delight immediately perceived with it (Block 1999). 14 In chapter 2 I will expand on the hedonics of taste and smell, that is, the continuity between the characteristics of flavor and smells and the enjoyment or disgust one feels about them.
32
The presence of the flavor of beer as part of the repertoire of available flavors, and the
constellation of possibilities that comes with it exemplifies the important sense in which
perceptual properties—their availability and behavioral significance—are contextually
dependent on perceptual practices. Consider the following passage, where Wittgenstein
elaborates on the idea that one could not “normally say ‘I take that to be a knife and a fork’”
(1982, §535):
One doesn’t take what one knows as a knife and fork at a meal for a knife and a fork; any more than one ordinarily tries to eat as one eats, or aims to eat. (1982, §536)
These passages build upon the “as” aspect of “seeing as” that defines perception—what I
have termed as the familiarity in perception. This familiarity, as explained before, points to our
perceiving objects and events with a certain intrinsic significance. The point Wittgenstein
makes here is that although we always take something for something (since not every perceiver
sees a fork as a fork), the familiarity is oftentimes so established that one takes it for granted and
goes unnoticed.15
This recognitional familiarity depends on a stable world. But the world is not the
summation of all objects, events, and states of affairs with which every perceiver interacts. The
world of perception is brought to life by practices that reveal such world in different manners.
Thus, the dependence of the phenomenal aspect of perceptual experience on practice partly lies
in the things that one cannot try to take one way or another or cannot aim at doing. As explained
in section 1.1, we find at the basis of all social practices that our interactions with the world are
structured around our unreflective engagements or unreflective conformities, by which we take
15 The familiarity of an encounter —a certain “recognition” (if only the term did not have such a cognitive burden)— does not only operate at the level of object- or event-identification. Even an unknown object, for instance, is perceived as an object, or as heavy; or a liquid as dense; or a smell as a strong smell; or a sound simply as a sound. These cases are also instances of a familiarity in the encounter. At this basic level, perceptual practices also play a role establishing attitudes towards the perceptual aspect of our encounter with the world, even though the physical, material aspect of occurrences also plays a role and in that sense we may find a greater commonality between between members of different communities. While no person would try to drink a solid object, different people may see a very dense liquid as having different behavioral significance, based on practice. The aspect of friction with reality at the physical level in relation to the human body has, in one sense, no need for practice, but, on the other hand, its specific boundaries may need to be established by practice.
33
occurrences as such-and-such, and display certain attitudes, actions, and reactions towards those
things.
A central aspect of these unreflective conformities concerns the items (i.e. sentences,
objects, or events) whose specific significance is taken for granted by competent practitioners, on
the basis of processes of training or acculturation. I have followed Lance and O’Leary-
Hawthorne in calling these items in the linguistic domain Quine-analytic sentences, and I am now
offering their perceptual counterpart: the seemingly given. Thus, perceptual practices contribute
to the establishment of attitudes and reactions towards specific perceptual properties, ranges,
domains and possible combinations. In this way, if one partakes of the practices associated with
beer drinking, one does not take beer to be beer, and one does not question whether such a type
of beverage is even drinkable. There are global characteristics of types of food and drinks
belonging to groups (groups of different scope) that make up the perceptual geography of
members of those communities.16 Cases of acquired tastes, revealed when one travels to a
community different than one’s own, are a good illustration of what it means to have a
background of ordinary circumstances and ordinary responses to things one perceives, in
relation to which specific occasions acquire their significance. One does not respond to beer by
having hot coffee along with it, although one may drink water along with it or may eat
something along with it.
The seemingly given are, then, the perceptual occurrences that one takes for granted as
perceivable or enjoyable, situated here or there in a range of perceptual properties, combinable
or not, etc.—these are the things for which “bare challenges” are not in place. Disputing or
challenging them amounts to “declare” oneself “outside” of the community, and understanding
them and deftly navigating them amounts to be part of the community. This experience is
common to most people who have traveled to worlds other than one’s own, and, with great
certainty, common to all who traveled to communities that are culturally different from one’s
16 Personal preferences are built on top of community consensus. They are, for the most part, exceptional, and can for the most part be still mapped onto community preferences. Readers of affluent, industrialized, Western societies must not overstate personal preferences into the basic characteristics of perceptual practices.
34
own —we know, as Lugones reminded us, that oftentimes world-travelling involves no
geographical trips (1987). The seemingly given evinces the normative dimension that perpetual
practices establish. They are established and maintained by concrete, consensual ways of doing
things about perceptual material. When the practices change, the things that are taken to be one
way or another change. Except for some physical extremes (extreme temperatures for liquids or
for surfaces; or sounds that are intolerable by the human ear), their significance is not intrinsic
to them.
To interact with perceptual properties in one domain of perception or another is not a
matter of an individual being impacted by natural kinds of properties—bitter1, bitter2, bitter3,
etc. It is rather about specific ways of interacting with objects, events, and states of affairs that
are located within horizons of perceptual properties, which can be broader or narrower, strict or
plastic, where several factors are interwoven. This is why I have said that in perception we are
not simply confronted with a world open to every individual all the same, but rather, that the
world of perception is revealed—brought to life and selected—to human beings by the practices
through which their communities interact with the world.
I would like to finish this section with a ground-level notion regarding the contextuality of
perceptual practices. Perceptual practices constitute the meaningfulness of perceptual
interactions. Perceptual interactions are not a natural kind in the sense that not every human
being explores things perceptually in the same way. Wittgenstein says:
You need to think of the role which pictures (as opposed to working drawings) play in our life. This role is by no means something uniform. (2009b, §195)
While most humans smell, taste, hear, etc., not all of them smell their romantic partners (at
least not in the same way), not all of them listen to very low music in surrounding silence, not
all of them use touch to determine what constitutes a good garment. This is because not every
perceiver uses smell as an ingredient in the dynamic of intimacy, not every perceiver uses
35
audition as a way of achieving tranquility, and not every perceiver uses touch as a variable to
use in the process of selecting clothing for the different cultural uses of clothing.
Let us take that last case: comparing fabrics’ textures in order to choose one—as in some
cultures mostly maternal figures used to do, or still do, when choosing fabrics for their
children’s special occasion’s suits and dresses. Perceiving a fabric by touch is not the same
touching than touching the skin of a newborn. The role of things we perceive is not uniform,
and this is evinced in the things we do perception-wise, that is, in our perceptual practices.
Through these differences we can offer a way of tracing the contextual aspects of perception.
The very practices of comparing thickness and softness are activities that only make sense
in a social context, in which thickness and softness are comparatively noticed and put in valuing
systems. There is no comparing of fabrics but in communities in which people compare fabrics,
following similar procedures (in a loose sense) and with similar goals in mind. Only in that
context, someone is dextrous in comparing fabrics or in describing colors, in a sense in which
one could be judged by others to be knowleadgeable (or not) about it.
Perceptual practices belong to groups of practitioners or intersubjective formations, which
can be broad or narrow. Examples of groups of practitioners can be families, generational
groups, national cultures, and subcultures, among others. My interest here is not to offer a
taxonomy or a set of criteria for social formations. I operate with a broad intuitive idea that
there is an intersubjective formation wherever a group acts in a some relatively constant
manner. A person is normally at the crossing of several intersubjective formations that influence
their life. This belonging is not necessarily a matter of choice, and very common instances are in
fact not a matter of choice at all—e.g. a historical belonging, as we see in our being members of
societies for whom the 21st century is meaningful. Thus, at whatever intersubjective formation
level we were taught how to proceed perceptually by a group’s practices, our coming to be part
of those groups of practitioners has formed the fundamental structure by which we make sense of
the world. We have come to know about food and drinks—about flavors and smells—on the
36
basis of culturally inherited foods. We have come to know about clothing, home decoration, and
visual personal appearance—about colors and shapes—on the basis of our communities’
practices. We have come to know about tones of voice, voice inflections, the loudness of laughter
and crying, the music we hear, its musical scale and choice of sounds—about sounds—on the
basis of our communities’ auditory-related practices.
Meredith Williams says that it is wrong to think that “the idea that grammar […] sets the
limits of sense, independently of the characterization of any actual community and actual uses of
language” (Me. Williams 166). Since rules are interpretable in different ways, and grammar
alone cannot individuate meaning, we need social practices. Likewise in perception. A world in
which flavors are possible does not entail what flavors and sounds are part of a person’s
repertoire, what things can be done with those flavors and sounds, or the relative significance of
those flavors and sounds in people’s lives. In this way, we can also see why all things perceptual
are contextually dependent on the things we do with them.
1.2.2 Performativity
Perceptual practices are performative because they consist of actions, reactions, and dispositions
to act and react.
Wittgenstein criticizes traditional modes of thinking about perception by reflecting on the
interweaving of action and perception that is mutually implicated by the conception of perception
as perceiving as. In the bodily engagement of perception, perception is itself active. As I showed
above with the case of someone whose hearing a melody is intermingled with playing the
melody or dancing to it, the perceptual moment is not isolated from a full-fledged interaction
with the thing. It rather occurs in the interaction. These interactions occur in concrete contexts
that structure them and where they have significance—practices are contextual. Practices are not
just movements, motor performances, but socially situated ways of doing things, that is,
techniques. We interact with the perceptible world in specific ways and the worldly richness that
37
we encounter is the product of defined, normatively structured ways of approaching, exploring,
taking, and combining the things we perceive.
We are experts in navigating the world of physical objects when we look for them, avoid
them, and use them. We are skilled in our interactions with sounds and noises, with smells and
flavors, with the soft and rough. We know when something is loud or low, the way smells and
flavors go along, or how we should touch a certain surface in order to feel it.
First of all, our exposure to the perceptible world is rarely, if ever, a matter of an open
channel that receives a raw input. In our perceptual interaction with the world, we touch and
taste in specific manners. In perception, we explore auditorily by getting closer, going silent,
raising the volume, or paying attention to some sounds. We explore flavors by taking bigger or
smaller bites or sips, by perhaps quickly licking something, by letting the food or drink stay
longer in our mouth, perhaps by closing our eyes, or by combining different pieces of food. We
explore visually by looking from different perspectives and by paying attention to certain
aspects or visual scenes, which we may even do unconsciously as a feature of the cultures we
belong to (Norenzayan, Choi, and Peng 2007). In all these doings, the end point is rarely the
gathering of sensory information for the purposes of simply determining what the thing in front
of us is or what its objective properties are. The interaction with perceptual objects is mostly
pragmatically significant.
Further, in our perceptual interaction with objects, events, and states of affairs, we relate to
things having a significance—they are perceived as something—by virtue of the context in
which we experience them, in virtue of the way we approach them, and in virtue of facts about
its constitution and our physiological and anatomical makeup. This significance is first and
foremost behavioral. In everyday interaction, there is no separation between our having a
phenomenal experience of something (as something) and that thing being for us a bearer of
possibilities or impossibilities. This may be clearer when a certain occurrence elicits an
immediate action—as the perception of an impending direct threat is a fleeing-causing perceived
38
object. For instance, I can experience a given smell as a something desirable or as disgusting. If
it is a pastry I really like, I may be drawn to smell it more fully, taking a big breath to enjoy the
smell of it. My perceiving it is not my detecting a smell, but my enjoying it as I smell it. In
contrast, when I smell something that is rotting, I act so as to stop the contact with the thing. I
may plug my nose or walk away. The response is not the next step after perceiving, but an
aspect of the way it is perceived (Wittgenstein 2009b, §§222ff.). Once again, there is a telling
contrast between the perception of someone who fully recognizes something and someone who
does not recognize it. The difference is that the one who recognizes the object or event is said to
recognize it on the basis of the behavioral entailment that comes to life when the perceptual
interaction takes place: “We react to a facial expression differently from someone who does not
recognize it as timid” (Wittgenstein 2009b, §231; See also §§180ff, 222ff).
The performativity of our perceptual practices exhibits how perception is a way of
inhabiting the world. On the one hand, perceptual practices are built on the materiality of the
objects at stake. The specific possibilities for perceptual exploration —e.g. with a view to mere
discovery, usefulness, or enjoyment— depend on the physical nature of objects, events, and
states of affairs. In regards to flavors and smells, take the cases of slurping or taking loud whiffs,
which allow a greater engagement with the object and are a part of some practices. Likewise,
our ways of exploring sounds and the limits of our possible interactions with sounds are greatly
constrained by the physicality of sounds. Because sounds do not have the temporal permanence
or clear boundaries of most visual objects, our ways of interacting with sounds—exploring
them, dissecting them, combining them, suppressing them, etc.—are devised by communities of
practitioners in ways that respond to these constraints. Asking someone to repeat what they
said, or being quiet so we are able to listen to sounds that will be gone otherwise are part of our
auditory practices. So it is our talking quietly in spaces that call for silence and whose acoustic
conditions propagate sounds more easily than normal, like cathedrals: “The excessive
reverberation forces the congregation into silence of hushed whispers, because otherwise speech
39
is rapidly amplified by reflections and creates and ungodly cacophony […] The acoustic has
also influenced services, as the use of chanting and the slow liturgical voice counters the muddy
speech in such reverberant spaces” (Cox 2014, 42).
In this manner, we see that our perceptual practices weave characteristics belonging to the
social domain into the material manipulation of perceptible properties. Some perceptual
performances are taken to be socially proper or polite, while others are not. It is at least curious,
for instance, that expert tasters (of coffee or wine, for instance) do it in ways that increase the
grasp of flavors but are normally socially non-acceptable, like loud slurping or spitting the
beverages after they are drunk. Our reach into the possible perceptual properties and
combinations of perceptible objects is constrained by our practices, which are built on the
materiality of the objects of perception. Those same practices also impose limits on what
members of communities regularly experience on the basis of other considerations, such as
social appropriateness. One can imagine communities whose members never explored and
enjoyed in their own clothing or home decoration the wide range of yellow and orange colors.
In our lives, though, there is no one single way of using our senses or one world that
shows up for everybody all the same. Rather, as I have been showing, there are different ways of
interacting with perceptible things, and these different ways reveal different aspects of the
world for different people. The variety of foods and kinds of music around the world are the
highlighting of certain palettes of flavors and sounds that make up the perceptible world.
Further, the symbolic richness of our living together is reflected in perceptible configurations
and possibilities that members of communities are able to encounter in their significance.
Those who partake in a form of life are those who, on the basis of training and
acculturation, are able to perform perceptual practices correctly, thus being able to act, react, be
disposed in certain manners, and, in that way, share meanings. In those actions and reactions,
practitioners bring to play the structure of perceptual appropriatenesses and entitlements.
Skilled practitioners display the character of unreflective conformity and unreflective
40
engagement toward seemingly given perceptual elements—from sensory properties and ranges of
them, to harmony or disharmony relations, to possible combinations, to available moves, to
objects and events. Practitioners experience the familiarity of these elements and are disposed to
act in specific ways about them.17
Wittgenstein has called the partaking in a perceptual practice “the mastery of a
technique” (2009b, §222). In the fact that perceptual practices are characterized by normative
constraints they are techniques. In the fact that performances of these techniques operate within a
normative domain they are said to require mastery.18 This is better understood by thinking in
those who are being trained in a technique—the infant, the immigrant, perhaps even the
convalescent—or in those who are alien to a practice—the newborn, the new immigrant.
This mastery goes from the type of familiarity in encountering a perceptual occurrence, to
the capacity to alter the perceived stimulus (if possible) either by changing the source of it or
adjusting one’s own position, to the capacity to effect changes on items on a specific modality.
Thus, Wittgenstein says that “Only of someone who can do, has learnt, is master of, such-and-
such, does it make sense to say that he has had [a given] experience” (2009b, §224). But social
practices also develop techniques for the manipulation of perceptual properties. This includes the
determination of preferred conditions for consumption of drinks or foods (cold or not, in small
portions, consumed in bits or larger chunks, more or less bitter, etc.) and the combination of
ranges of flavors and tastes with others, such that a certain beverage may be commonly
consumed by itself or with other foods or drinks. While the specific mastery of manipulation is a
matter of the specific perceptual practice at stake, we are skilled at a general level to produce
certain configurations of perceptible material for us and for others. Some may not know how to
17 My position does not entail that some social practices simply have a perceptual element in them, such that one could subtract the perceptual from them and still have a practice. The perceptual aspect is barely definable independently of the practices in which it is woven. Conversely, the practices in question would simply disappear if a perceptual element were abstracted from them. The perceptual and the social are here not in a parthood relation—rather, they are interwoven. 18 As I will explain in section 1.2.4, the mastery of a technique and the correct application of it is not a volitional issue. Just as there is a learning of walking and a potential walking wrongly, it is not the case that the one who knows how to walk walks wrongly. The mastery, in the perceptual case too, amounts to a baseline on the basis of which individual perceptual interactions take place. Instead of right or wrong, this normative dimension operates in terms of successfulness and unsuccessfulness.
41
cook a meal successfully, but we know the effects of adding salt to our food, and we combine
pieces of our food so at to interact with it in ways we consider appropriate. Likewise, we know
how to modify our voices so they express what we want or how to decorate our houses so they
will look good to us and to others. It is in this sense that I have said that perception is the site of
commerce of perceptible material that is produced so as to be seen in a given way, and that is
perceived as something or that elicits certain responses.19 It is in this wide-encompassing sense
that practices are said to be forms of life (Wittgenstein 2009a, §19, 23, 241).
Perceptual performances play a key role in the way we inhabit the world. The behavioral
significance that objects, events, and states of affairs carry in perception arise from the fact
perceptible objects, events, and states of affairs are worldly things with which we interact
bodily. In a basic sense, we are appropriately situated, like every other living being, to interact
with the world in a way that matters for us. This mutuality between perceiver and environing
world is at the basis of J. J. Gibson’s ecological approach to perception (Gibson 1979). While
Gibson developed his ecological approach with a view to non-human animals, it is appropriate to
extend his analysis and say that we are also ecologically attuned to the world we live in on the
basis of our body, its capabilities and potentialities, and the different possible human forms of
life.20 Our world, unlike most other animals, is not only the environing world that we shape out
of the totality of the natural world. Our world involves the world that is transformed into
material culture, whether in a stable manner (as in architecture) or transiently (as in food), the
immaterial yet physical world of songs and the like, and in general all the products of social
practices that configure our living together, and that are products of historically situated
19 There is a certain similarity between this commerce and the way in which Putnam refers to perceptions as transactions (Putnam 1999). On his view, partly inspired by Wittgenstein and the classical American pragmatists, the picture we should get rid of, is best exemplified in the Berkeleyan case: we are never in direct contact with things. Putnam’s transactions also oppose versions of perception as an interface between external world and internal representations. Putnam’s goal is to erase the distinction inner-outer. He thinks that this separation has fatal consequences for our understanding of what we do and who we are. However, Putnam’s analysis is still far from sociality. Putnam’s transactions between subject and world do not require sociality. Transactions are available for individuals in their dealing with the world. My idea of commerce, instead, is thought of as suggesting a world of others in relation to whom things are done, even in the sense that individual performances are not truly individual—just as there is no private language—because they are instantiations of perceptual practices. 20 This aspect will also be explored in the Expressivity section, when an analogy is presented between perception and animal expressive communication.
42
communities. Likewise, our forms of life are enacted in the social worlds that we bring to life
precisely as we live together, through social practices.
Marx Wartofsky offers a formidable illustration of the ecological, social, and historical
character of our perceptual practices by reflecting on hunting: "the hunter, hearing a crack of a
branch, or seeing a sudden flight of birds, transforms the very sound and sight into an artifact
—an instrument— of the hunt itself. But what the cracking branch is heard as is already an
index of a social mode of praxis, —of hunting, in this case— and therefore, insofar as the hunt
has a specific historical form or function, nature itself has become historicized and socialized,
and has come to be a representation of a certain mode of praxis or human action" (Wartofsky
1979b, 206).21 The human encounter with the natural world already exhibits the complexity of
social practices in the form of a perceptual practice: the encountering the crack of a branch as
carrying the pragmatic significance of prey. While I distance myself from the signitive and
representational talk of Wartofsky, the perceptual practice remains. Furthermore, the case of
hunters that are skilled at imitating the sounds of animals (or producing sounds that generate a
reaction in animals) we see that the mastery of perpetual practices is exhibited at social and
historical institutions, as we also saw in the case of reverberating cathedrals.
The mutuality between subject and environment of the ecological approach is also
at the root of the enactive approach to perception, first presented by Varela, Thompson, and
Rosch (1991), and then defended by Noë (2004; 2001) and others (Hurley 1998; Thompson
21 Despite the strong disagreement between my position and Wartofsky’s as to the representational character of cognition (even though he conceptualizes perception as praxis), the richness of his analyses would merit further study. It is noteworthy the way he brings into traditional topics of philosophy of mind categories belonging to social analysis. Wartofsky articulates his social take on perception through the notion of artifact. He sees social practices as bearing the basic characteristics of artifacts, defined as "Anything which human beings create by the transformation of nature and of themselves [...] thus, also language, forms of social organization and interaction, techniques of production, skills" (Wartofsky 1979a, xiii). They are all a making, a praxis, and as such they are forms of social interaction for which communication is a pre-condition. Wartofsky refers to artifacts as models, and models fundamentally as representations. In contrast to the mainstream views of perception that make it a matter of a biological, ahistorical, inner occurrence, Wartofsky will say that "Perception is a highly evolved and specific mode of human action and praxis" (1979b, 189). Through the notion of artifact, we arrive to perception as a form of action—and not only as basis for it. So he says: "Extending the notion of 'artifact' as 'tool' still further, the acquisition of skills, in the process of production (or even at the level of foraging, scavenging or hunting, and prior to the introduction of agriculture and the domestication of animals) creates such skills as themselves 'artifact', even where these skills do not entail the use of tools in the ordinary sense, but only the mastery of the natural organs of the body, and of perceptual skills in pattern-or-cue-recognition" (Wartofsky 1979b, 2001).
43
2009; Hutto and Myin 2013). The enactive approach holds that cognition is a particular type of
relation that living beings engage in with the world on the basis of a “history of structural
coupling” and their own natural constitution. It is, therefore, something we actively do in our
relation with the world and not something that happens in us or to us. According to the
standard enactive approach, perception is a type of action governed by the mastery of
sensorimotor skills, which allows the perceiver to integrate sensations into an ongoing practical
life. Noë’s enactivism is the idea that perception available for action (perception one can
understand) depends on a particular type of implicit understanding, namely, the dependency
between our sensory and motor skills.
But just as the ecological approach needs to be supplemented by the richness of the social
world and the complexity of human subjects in order to respond to the human forms of life, the
enactive approach must be modified in like ways. The difference between standard sensorimotor
enactivism and the Social Enactive Theory of Perception that I am proposing originates
precisely in the performative aspect of perception. For SEP, perception is not only a matter of
coupling the sensory and the motor to which each individual of the species is naturally disposed.
For SEP, the type of things that we do in perception is far broader than sensorimotor
dependencies. Instead of motor actions, SEP takes practices as the key concept to understand the
way in which perception is an active engagement with a world on the basis of our senses. The
performativity of perceptual practices is at the basis of SEP as an alternative to standard
enactivism.22
1.2.3 Expressivity
The expressivity of perceptual practices has two senses. First, perceptual practices take the
world to be expressive and make the world express itself. Perceptual practices are ways in which
social formations inhabit a world that reveals itself in perspectival and dynamic ways, by means
of interactions with perceivers, which interactions are the concrete displays of those practices.
22 I offer further contrasts between SEP and sensorimotor enactivism in chapter 3 (section 3.3.1), chapter 4 (section 4.1.1), and chapter 5 (section 5.2.2).
44
Second, perceptual practices express the form of life of the perceivers and the social groups in
which they partake.
I take the family of concepts expression-the expressed-to express-being expressive to refer to the
unfolding of phenomena, such that what is expressed does not pre-exist its expression—it is not
a plain showing or pointing to something internal—, emerges from a potentiality, and comes to
achieve its specific form in the expression itself—it is not a translation (Merleau-Ponty 2002;
Arango 2015).23 In expression, there is no going back from what is expressed to something
prior, which one may think as now being made public.
The dynamics of expression are part of the dynamics of perception.24 The type of relation
that expression describes is precisely what we find in perception’s basic characteristic that to
perceive is to perceive something as something (Waldenfels 2000, 93). In the “as something,” there
is an encountering familiarly, which is a type of seizing something perceptually—the occurrence
of a certain configuration of sense that cannot be traced back to a sensory, non-perceived
moment. What allows this encounter—this seizing of sense and being seized by it—is the
necessary relation between expression and perceiver. Thus, the fundamental relationality of
meaning is evinced in expression, for expression requires someone for whom something is
expressive (Gély, 3).25 This, in turn, entails that the nature of the perceiver (in the case of
perception-related expression) is constitutive of what is expressed in its concreteness. This
constitutive relation is this way partly because expression could not be beyond the limits of
what can be meaningful for a perceiver, but also because expression, in its concrete shape within
those limits, is also a function of who the particular perceiver is, the social groups whose
practices she partakes of, her immediate pragmatic horizon, and her personality. Further, the
23 Expression includes both (relatively) fixed products and ongoing processes. The product case can be a painting, or a political constitution that is expression of certain relations in a political community. On the other hand, processes (including activities), are like games (as they are played), or the courting phase of a romantic relationship. Other instances of expression include a poem, a facial gesture, or an interpersonal interaction. My understanding of expression follows the orientation given to it by Husserl and Merleau-Ponty. See also Arango (2014) and Flynn (2009, 67). 24 In a sense, these dynamic relations should be referred to as the aesthetics of perception, in the sense that it is the internal logic of the sensible—a non-cognitive logic—that pertains to embodied, animated beings. 25 I thank Lisa Guenther for suggesting the dual possibility of “to seize” in this case.
45
concept of expression is appropriate because it is attuned to the non-input, non-inferential,
affective, bodily engagement that characterizes Wittgenstein’s (as well as Husserl’s and
Merleau-Ponty’s) take on perception that I explained above.
As a fundamental characteristic of perceptual practices, expressivity further specifies the
way the Social Enactive View is an embodied, non-cognitive, contextual, and practice-based
theory. Defenders of representational views of perception reject the idea that perception is
something other than input. In the economy of perceptual representationalism, representation is
the currency that grounds (and partly defines) the activities linked to perception—identification,
recognition, comparison, assessment of veridicality of possibly mistaken perceptions, and even
action. To talk of perceptual familiar encounters with reality (as I have been doing) is, in the
representational view, to talk about an enchanted nature akin to the Myth of the Given (as
Sellars or McDowell would put it), that assumes that meaning is inherent in the outer world
(which SEP also rejects), and does not originate on internal representations. Since in the
representational view it is axiomatic that we only have true, rational access to the inner, the idea
of a familiar encounter smells like magic. Representationalists do not see the denial of the inner-
outer distinction, and the rejection of mind as inner as rational alternatives. Perception is
treated, as both Taylor and Putnam have elaborated, as a meditational or interface tool (Taylor
2005; Putnam 1999). Whether it remains strictly meditational or is internalized in mental
tokens, naturalizable or not, the basic point is still that “We can’t get outside” (Taylor 2005, 26).
Chapter 3 is devoted to exploring this problem in great detail, but it is fitting to connect it here
with expressivity at the level of practices.
We can begin to see how this is the case if we look at expressive communication in
perceivers that do not have the inferential and conceptual capacities that representational
theories assume are necessary.26 What makes the case relevant for our purposes is that in these
cases we should be able to distinguish between communication and action-reaction, and between
26 I am not interested in reductionist theories that define every behavior in sub personal mechanisms—i.e. a matter of mere brain functioning—, as some brute naturalisms wish to do, because perception is a personal level phenomenon.
46
perception and action-reaction. In the case of communication, it is normally thought that the
distinction lies in that genuine communication employs an intentionalistic background on the
part of speakers and inferential capacities on the side of hearers. In the case of perception, it is
normally thought that perception requires inferential capacities on the side of perceivers, so
recognition and like processes are possible. In both cases, it is as if we want to understand the
difference between understanding a command and getting a sunburn, or between perceiving
that a steamy soup is perhaps too hot to drink and, again, getting a sunburn. Thus, is it true that
the distinction between communication and action-reaction is a matter of intentions plus
inferences?
Dorit Bar-On has argued that human communication shares some features with animal
expressive behavior—behavior that expresses pain, fear, aggressiveness, excitement,
playfulness, etc. (2013a, 4). Instances of expressive behavior are “growls, teeth-barings, tail-
waggings, fear barks and grimaces, lip smacks, ground slaps, food-begging gestures, ‘play faces’
and play bows, copulation grimaces and screams, pant hoots, alarm, distress, and food calls,
grooming grunts, open-mouth and ear-flap threats” (Bar-On 2013a, 26). In her view, treating
these behaviors as symptoms or physiological indications begins to acknowledge their
complexity. For instance, in the case of play fight, the same gestures that are used in a real fight
are displayed, so understanding their playful nature is entirely a matter of the context in which
it happens (Arango 2015). Through these behaviors, Bar-On argues, animals are able to share
with other meanings about “how things are in the world and how things are with them” (Bar-
On 2013b, 25). What is crucial here is that the comprehension of this behavior does not make
use of intentional, propositional, and inferential capacities on the parts of speakers and hearers.
Rather, expressive behavior exhibits to “suitably attuned” observers something about our
mental dispositions or attitudes about things, without necessarily assuming intentions to
communicate something on the part of the “actor,” or an inferential process on the part of the
observer (Bar-On 2013b, 18). The determination of a “suitable attuned observer” will naturally
47
depend, in the case of contextual and normative practices, on those who participate in the
practices themselves. Thus, expressive communication “is a form of social, intersubjective,
world-directed and overt communicative behavior” that shows a subject’s relation to the world
(Bar-On 2013b, 24). Lastly, expressive communication is behaviorally meaningful—it is a bodily
engagement—because that is, in fact, the only clue that we have to affirm that hearers
“understand” the significance of the others’ behavior. The reason we tell that an animal has
understood another’s signal as playful is that it has responded in a playful manner—and in fact,
the signal is understood also as playful because it is normally taken behaviorally to be such by
other individuals.
This comparison allows me to articulate embodiment and expressivity, as a feature of non-
representational SEP. In contrast to representationalism, SEP argues that our perceptual
engagement with the world is structured according to social practices and based on perceivers’
bodily attunement or responsiveness to worldly things. In this sense, SEP is an embodied
theory. To understand perception as a matter of bodily engagement with the world that we
encounter is to deny that perception occurs in an inner domain. To take embodiment as
fundamental for perception entails that both perception and action are part of the same continuum
of our bodily engagement with the world. If perception is not to happen internally, inferentially,
a certain attunement with the world is required in which worldly oriented perceivers encounter
a meaningful world—an expressive world. Let us not forget, though, that perceptual bodily
engagement is a matter of degrees: the stillness of the enjoyment of silence is as much a bodily
engagement, as it is the disgust of eating some badly spoiled piece of food.
Perceptual practices reflect their expressive nature in their perspectival nature, both
(intra-) modally and multi-modally. First, the world is for a perceiver a wealth of objects, events,
and states of affairs that appears always aspectually. Due to the physical nature of the world, the
embodied nature of perceivers, and the temporal extension of interactions, aspects are, first of
all, perspectives—a terms which that shall refer not only, or even mainly, to spatial perspectives
48
but to the varying ways in which the same objects appear to perceivers in virtue of the
physicality of the objects and the perceptual explorations of them. For instance, a smell reveals
two different perspectives when it is smelled casually and when it is smelled intensely.
Relatedly, the world is a potentiality regarding perceptual modalities. The perspectives in which
the world reveals itself are also modally rich. The world comes to be meaningful for us in modal
configurations and combinations: we not only see the world—perhaps not even mainly. We
touch the world, listen to it, smell it, and taste it. We are able to discover the richness of the
world through our different sensory organs. Each organ, Merleau-Ponty said, “interrogates” its
objects in its own way (Merleau-Ponty 1945, 268). On top of this material and physiological
facts constituting perceptual interactions between things and perceivers, individual perceivers
employ their organs in specific ways, guided by social techniques.27 Our ways of looking,
touching, and smelling are not simply biologicall fixed. In their fine granularity and fine-tuning,
perceptual interactions enact social ways of exploring the world that allow for individual
styles.28
As mentioned in the performativity section, practices are adapted to the richness of the
world. As techniques, practices are skilled ways of exploring the world in its perspectives, both
intra-modally and inter modally. The world of food—the experiences of smell and mainly of
flavor—is perhaps one of the best illustrations of this skilled orientation of social practices to a
many-faceted world. Since, as said before, the experience of flavor includes smell, taste, touch,
temperature, and even sound and vision (think of crunchy warm food sold commercially, just to
highlight the importance of visual appearance for the experience of an edible item),
gastronomies evince how different communities have historically devised ways of interacting
with the world so as to interact with it in manners that are satisfying as nourishment and
27 This mastery of perceptual techniques is built upon natural capacities and, in this sense, part of our skillfulness lies in anatomical and physiological capabilities, such that we are able to perceive things within certain ranges of stimulation and under certain conditions. Only someone able to hear in the first place is able to explore sounds as such (different than sensory related phenomena, like the vibration of instruments due to the physics of sound). 28 Chapters 2 and 3 elaborate the perspectival nature of perceptual experience in detail, and chapter 4 and 5 elaborate on the implications of those aspects for issues of content and the normativity of content.
49
considered enjoyable. In this sense, perceptual practices exhibit an attunement to the
geographical world, in that those practices have been developed according to the availability of
products and other relevant circumstances, such as cooking methods. It should not be difficult
now to see perceptual practices as performances in expressive contexts. Due to the meaning of
practices within people’s lives, it is now easier to see how perceptual practices configure forms of
life, ways of inhabiting the world.
To go back to the interdependency between the expressivity of the world and our bodily
engagement with it, think of a plaintive melody, or of how someone’s handwriting can be
childish, or of a timid bodily gesture (Wittgenstein 1982, §§735–776; See also §§713, 906).29 A
person’s bodily reaction to a cry for help, a lover’s encouraging reaction to a lover’s body’s
readiness for sex, are not separate from the perceiving of a voice’s intonation or the perceiving
of arms’, lips’ and torsos’ intense movements. The “appropriate” response to one of these
perceptual occurrences characterizes the perceptual occurrence as such. The caress is inviting
because it is responded to as such. A person whose caresses were never taken to be inviting, whose
caresses would always turn a lover away, would change their ways, realizing that the
perceivable movement does not express what they want.30 For those who play the game of
kisses, reacting invitingly may include the evident offering of the neck in a manner that makes
one recall of vampires. Offering the neck is then not just a reaction but an invitation, and there
is no clear or useful distinction anymore between actor and acted upon.31 In a perceptual
29 These cases show one sense in which perceptual practices are expressive, namely, in the sense that perceptual practices directly tell something about the people whose behavior one is acquainted with. The phenomenon of the perception of others adds a thick layer to perception of the world in general. The difference is that in the perception of others—and the argument could extend to other minded beings—the perceptual object is not simply a material object but a behaving body, a living body, whose activities and the domain of those activities also define the being itself. I somehow limit myself here to the expressivity of the world in general, with only some mentions to the perception of others, but I will not offer an exhaustive study of the richness of the perception of others because its complexity merits being treated in greater length that this work allows. 30 This is a rich analog to having always seen the duck-rabbit as a rabbit, based on having always treated is as such (Wittgenstein 1982, §472). 31 In a different key one might say that in the perceptual situation, a perceiver can modify the location of her sensory receptors so as to improve in one way or another the sensory aspect, eventually causing an attuned partner to modify the movements that were situated in a feedback loop, which in the present example would be acting as the causal side. Since the kisser would feel the movements of the kissed one, the kisser would also be touched, and the kissed one would be the one touching.
50
interaction, the interaction itself expresses something about the perceiver and the thing
perceived, but the perception cannot be singled out as the receptive moment.
The complexity of social relations and structures features in the suitable attunement of
perceivers that is part of the mastery of perceptual practices. Far beyond the sensory, perceptual
practices are expressive of complex forms of life featuring political structures, relations of
domination, dynamics of oppression along the lines of race, ethnicity, or class, romantic
relationships, playful encounters, etc. The perceptual is not a naturally defined domain. In its
social nature, perception is malleable. In its everyday course, it becomes dyed by the activities in
which it is involved. And in becoming a matter of intersubjective commerce, other social
practices are constantly perceptualized. The romantic is perceptual, so it is the oppressive and
the hateful.32
To conceptualize perception in terms of socially structured practices of interactions with
the world reflects the idea that there is no proper theory of perception that does not entail
substantive commitments about what perceivers are and what the world is. As foreshadowed in
the Introduction, a proper theory of perception is a partial account of what it means for
perceivers to be in the world, and what it means for the world to be the home of perceivers. The
characteristic of expressivity is one of the ways in which this is achieved.
32 I now wish to highlight a necessary characteristic of perceptual practices and their expressive feature. The perception of objects, events, and states of affairs is not a matter of inputs, and this means that it is not a matter of isolated chunks of information. Likewise, the meaningfulness of perceptual occurrences is not to be found in pieces of actions, or in actions disconnected from a social framework that grounds their meaningfulness and significance. We can see this by looking at G.H. Mead’s account of gesture. A gesture must be located within the broader framework of social acts of which the gesture is a part (Mead 1967, 42ff.). The ground meaning for perceptual engagements with the world is the “matrix or complex of attitudes and responses constituting any given social situation or act” (Mead 1967, 72). We can see this is exemplified in the case of the type of animal social play known as play fight or sparring, which features complex social interactions—part of the usual repertoire of perceptible occurrences. Play fight appears in in pronghorns and in several other species of mammals and marsupials. It involves “the use of species-specific patterns of agonistic behavior in a non-serious context” and the fighting bouts are combined with non-fighting behavior and context-dependent signals (Pellis and Pellis 1998, 116, 122–123; Burghardt 1998, 21). It is characteristic of play fight that isolated actions are very often, if not always, ambiguous (Watson 1998, 69). Pellis and Pellis argue that threat signals are oftentimes present in play fight in most species that display this social behavior (1998, 122). Their ambiguity disappears in virtue of the context in which they occur. Since the same action could be performed by the same organism in different contexts, and the potentially dangerous reaction depends on another organism’s perception of a certain signal, the development of play fight as play—the perception of certain movements as play fight and not as fight—depends not just on what the individuals do, but on the shared meaning of certain actions within contexts. This is a case in which perceptual practices’ expressivity is holistic.
51
In this mutuality perceivers-world we find the form of life of perceivers, and that amounts,
to an extent, to finding out what perceivers are. At the bottom, there are only concrete systems
of practices or forms of life and our philosophical search for explanations ends there. Perceivers
are not detectors of ideally univocal properties, inhabiting a world of such properties. Rather,
perceivers are agents, inhabiting a world by means of active bodily engagement with it, in which
perceptual possibilities continuously unfold. It is an engagement with a world that is never
offered in identical ways to others—sometimes in very similar ways, sometimes in different
ways. Our world is a rich, unfinished, endless, expressive world. Our engagement is an
engagement with a world where, by means of differences in modes of exploration, we even at
times seem to be in contacts with different worlds.
1.2.4 Normativity
Practices are normative because they exhibit a dimension of successfulness and pragmatic
significance. The normativity of perceptual practices consists in the patterns that guide a
practitioner’s mastery of things perceptual.33 This mastery is a knowing about perceptible stuff,
such that we are familiar with perceptual properties and their aspects and interactions (sensory
properties, combinations of those properties, social and behavioral significance of those
properties), we respond appropriately to them, we explore them, and we manipulate them
skillfully. More precisely, this mastery consists in being able to situate perceptual interactions in
relation to expectations and possibilities. Pragmatic normativity is grounded in the processes of
training by which new practitioners are brought into the community and by which the
community continuously develops and transforms itself (Medina 2002). This means that a social
practice is normative in that it exhibits a consensus of actions that is transmitted to newcomers.
33 This section only addresses one aspect of the normativity of perception, namely, the normativity of perceptual practices. In broader terms, both the how and the what of perception are subject to normative relations: how perceptual practices and individual interactions hold together (normativity of perceptual practices), how practices and interactions relate to thought, awareness, action and emotion (normativity of perceptual intentionality), and how the contents of perceptual experience hold together (normativity of perceptual content). Chapter 5 will be fully devoted to the last two specifications of normativity—intentionality and content. They are central in the synchronic treatment of perception, that is, in the treatment of perception as instantiated in individual interactions with perceptible stuff. Notice also that a full treatment of perceptual normativity must link normatively the what of perception, that is, the contents of perception, to its how. This is partly done in this section and partly in chapter 5.
52
Wittgenstein gives normativity the meaning of mastering a technique. To master a
technique is to have a skill; it is also to be part of a community of practitioners. In a given social
formation, there is a consensus of actions, such that members act “in the right ways under the
appropriate circumstances” (Williams, 182). “The right ways,” “under,” and “appropriate
circumstances” are all determined by a transmitted consensus. Now, how far does the scope of
actions and reactions to perceptible stuff extend? What falls under the perceptual skills?
First, it applies to the whole domain of application of the technique. The one who is a
master in an auditory practice knows about sounds: she knows what a sound is, what loud
sounds and low sounds are like, the meaningfulness of sounds in speech and, perhaps, in music,
sonic dynamics—sonorous things moving away or coming towards, occurring close or far—, as
well as how to produce a loud sound by contact with an object, and, in the case of people that are
able to speak, how to speak loud or low. Perceptual skills can be understood as a type of baseline
knowledge: the knowledge of things that we simply assume and operate on. This is the domain
of the seemingly given, in relation to which we act in an unreflective conforming ways.
Specifically, I refer here to the levels of familiarity we have with certain ranges of flavors,
sounds, smells, and colors. Someone who partakes in a perceptual practice has a greater
familiarity to some ranges of perceptual properties, as well as to possible combinations.
Notice that these skills are based on states of affairs of different kinds: physical,
anatomical, and physiological. Since these facts are behaviorally relevant, they configure
dispositions. On the basis of these dispositions, skills develop, and those skills acquire the
fullness of socially structured ways of doing things. The tactile perception of a volume carries
the expectation of regularity in the way volumes display themselves: their sides are situated
spatially and contiguously in space and one can tactilely feel one surface before another surface
follows. In other words, there is an enactive expectation, since some actions are part of the
bodily engagement in which perception consists. These expectations are partly built upon the
53
stability and regularity of the world—on facts about the materiality of the world and the
constitution of our bodies.34
The interactions start being more evidently multi-layered as we deal with interpersonal
interactions. For instance, the “inspection” of a seemingly familiar face is partly a function of the
visual nature of the object, of its sensory properties, such that one must alter a point of view in
order to better engage with the object. This means, specifically, to move one’s head to get a
better look at the person’s face, and perhaps come closer. Notice, however, that one cannot
explore a person’s face the way one explores a painting in a museum, since both types of
interactions have an element of social propriety, which a child needs to learn. One may need to
engage with the person and see if she is who she seems to be from afar: if the gestures and her
voice are those of an old acquaintance. Some soups, for example, require that they are served
within a range of temperatures. The requirement of their being hot has to be squared with the
tolerance of the human receptors and with social practices of propriety. As to the exploration, a
hot soup requires that the person approaches the liquid in ways that allow a “diagnosis” of
temperature while keeping in with certain norms of etiquette in which, for example, sounds are
or not allowed. If found delicious, one may engage with it in involved ways that may include
sounds, more intense movement of the mouth and tongue, all the while keeping with the social
limits of what is considered acceptable (or not). If the soup is rather cold, one may have the
chance to warm it up or have it warmed up—or would simply have it, as it is, partly disliking it.
The normativity of perceptual practices is exhibited in the actual practices that, as just
described, range from our encountering perceptual properties to socially rich modes of
interaction with the perceptual world. More abstractly, practitioners are able to situate perceptual
34 Notice however that, as animals, we have certain basic dispositions towards perceptual properties, which each form of life develops into specific configurations. There is nevertheless a basic level of familiarity with the perceptible world, with a corresponding skill, that pertains for instances to the basic phenomenal feeling of sensory properties. Our skilled bodily engagement with the physical world is also evinced in our knowing what a smell feels like in the first place. The social character of our perceptual engagement with the world extends to the the fact that other beings also manifest a familiarity with smells as smells, with strong smells as strong, with sweet smells as sweet. Along these lines we could find a commonality with seeing beings, smelling begins, tasting beings, auditory begins, touching beings, etc. Perception is in this sense evidence of the fact that all humans and other non-human forms of life inhabit the same world and have, in a significant sense, similar types of life.
54
interactions in relation to expectations and possibilities. On this basis I argue that normativity of
perceptual practices is a matter of successfulness and significance, and not of correctness and
intelligibility. This position entails that there are no unsuccessful perceptions, nor entirely
meaningless ones. It also entails that our perceptual engagement with the world is a matter of
degrees in which a notion of “best,” “normal,” or “customary” is operative.
Expectations and possibilities are tied to our acquaintance with a stable world, which is
stable in different degrees in its physical and social aspects. To situate an occurrence in relation
to expectations is partly to have a sense of what has come before and what is to come, of what
can be done, or of whether the present occurrence is normal, uncommon, or excessive. It is a
matter of having a sense of how a situation can unfold. Think for instance of drinking a regular
cup of coffee. All goes as expected. It may need some sugar or already have too much, it may be
too cold for our taste or too hot—all of these, starting with the flavor of coffee, are determined
by social perceptual practices. Now think that this cup of coffee is a prank—a bad one of
course—and someone has put so much salt in it that the liquid is saturated. I take a big sip and I
spit it. It is so terribly salty that I react automatically and spit it. It is not an incorrect
perception. It is a successful perception in the sense that I am able to relate to it on the basis of a
system of expectations: I spit it and know that I cannot (or do not want to) drink more, and that
there is nothing to do about it. We can modify the prank. Serve an ice-cold coffee on a freezing
evening to someone who is expecting a warm coffee. She takes a sip and laughs about it, but
takes the coffee and warms it up—perhaps adds a little sugar before having her much-desired
coffee. Let’s modify it again. Instead of salt, add a spice entirely unknown to the drinker. Say it
is turmeric. The drinker is surprised, and, arguably, not positively. The flavor is probably
disgusting, but unknown. She may not spit it for whatever reason but certainly will not drink it
anymore. She cannot identify the flavor, but knows it is a flavor and, perhaps, that is on the
bitter side of things. The perception is not incorrect—it is perfectly successful and pragmatically
significant.
55
Take now the case of an avid concert-goer selecting a location at a venue where one of her
favorite musicians will perform. They know that music is not best enjoyed behind columns that
block the sound, nor right next to speakers or cabins, since the sound does not all come out of
one single speaker. Suppose they pick a good location (a good location relative to their styles,
their abilities, their preferences, etc.) and move around after one or two songs in order to better
listen to it. Whatever the final location of the concert-goer is, the idea I want to convey is that
expectations and possibilities govern our perceptual interacting with worldly stuff, in ways that
involve determinations arising from contextual practices, which also provide “tacit norms (or
normative expectations) that are exhibited in the behavior of the participants” (Medina 2003,
262). Lastly, in a visual case where everything goes as expected—like when I look at the tree in
front of me, and it looks nice and green and tall and moves with the wind—expectations are
always at work. This normalcy is also an expression of the normative domain of our perceptual
interaction with the world.
Perceptual practices are malleable and fluid. Normatively, the expectations and possibilities
are present and also change at all the levels of our perceptual interaction with the world—at the
level of sensory properties, of our handling of things, and also of the characteristics that have a
social meaning. Perceptual practices adjust continuously within the social groups that share
them, and these adjustments can be a reflection of characteristics proper of human groups. For
instance, traditionalistic societies may have little variation in their perceptual practices: in their
clothing customs, in the colors they use to decorate their place of habitation, or in the food they
eat. The cultural products of marginal groups within a society can sometimes be seen as sort of
imitations of mainstream practices, that is, as an institution of alternative practices. Kinds of
music and foods that once belonged to the elites are adopted and transformed by marginal
groups—instruments and ingredients may change in order to adapt to the limited means of the
56
marginal group. In this way new practices are established, where new expectations and
possibilities are set in place.35
Expectations and possibilities of perceptual practices are a type of baseline knowledge.
They make use of the notions of the “normal,” “best,” or “customary,” and these notions acquire
their meaning in the social formations in which they are used (except, perhaps, for the notion of
normal that depends on physical laws). Within social groups, expectations and possibilities
change, and new groups or social formations come to life when a new way of interacting with
perceptual stuff comes to be a way of doing things for some practitioners. On top of the
normativity of practices, individuals in specific situations interact perceptually with the world in
manners that also reflect their personal styles and preferences. Individuals also bring about
changes. Personal preferences can turn into group practices. Such seems to be the simple case of
the inventor of a recipe.
Medina has argued, in the case of discursive practices, that “normativity is not the kind of
thing that can be monopolized at all and, a fortiori, it cannot be monopolized either
individualistically or socially” (2010, 2). While it cannot be monopolized, the social domain
manifest in perceptual practices enjoys an epistemological primacy over the individual, since it
sets the domain of the perceptible and it first brings individuals into ways of interacting
perceptually with the world.
Normativity does not arise out of the consensus of actions, but out of the transmission—the
training and acculturation—by which perceivers come to be part of a social group. We learn to
perform practices in the right contexts, in the right ways. Thus, Wittgenstein says: “We learn
how to arrange objects according to their colours, how to report the colours of things, how to
produce colours, compare shapes, measure, etc., etc.” (1982, §483). Echoing Merleau-Ponty on
truth, of perceptual practices we can say that we have learned what is it to taste, to smell, or to
hear through socially situated practices (see also Williams 1999, 166).
35 I am thankful to Melinda Hall for this suggestion.
57
The whole techniques of commerce with perceptible material are not biologically fixed.
Having a sensory apparatus that responds to a certain range of stimuli and under certain
physiological constrains is only the basis upon which the practices are built. Consider the case of
research in social cognition that shows that two different culturally defined groups of
individuals see the same visual scene differently, because one group focuses on focal points of the
scene and the other group focuses on the whole scene, as judged even by eye movement (Chua,
Boland, and Nisbett 2005; Masuda and Nisbett 2001; this evidence will be analyzed in detail in
section 2.3.3). The biological configuration of the eye and of the neural correlates of vision do
not account for the actual phenomenon of visually interacting with visual scenes, even at a basic
level.
As explained in section 1.1 above, the view that normativity arises out of processes of
training entails that there is no use for the distinction between acting guided by a rule and
according to rule, because it is not possible to single out rules independently of contextual
practices. In contrast, acting within perceptual practices is done blindly, and it is precisely the
mark of a skilled practitioner to act correctly without engaging in inferential, cognitive
processes that are supposed to be necessary for there being a properly “acting guided by a rule.”
Once again, the notion of embodiment at work in SEP that takes perception to be a matter of
bodily engagement is at odds with views that, in order to meaningfully separate causes from
reasons, which they see necessary, require that we reason about causes—that is, that we act
guided by rules (see Crowell 2013, 28).36 But once again, the division between causes and
reasons, such that causes are responded to automatically whereas reasons are justifiable, is part
of a picture that separates inner and outer and sees normativity in perception as in need of
justification. In contrast, the primacy of practice means that one is situated within the normative
space when one acts in accordance with a practice, even if one is not aware of why things are
done thus or so. Practitioners rely on the seemingly given—a domain against which “bare
challenges” are not in order. In perception, the seemingly given is the familiarity with certain 36 Chapter 5 will elaborate on the relation of this aspect of normativity to perceptual content.
58
ranges of sensory properties, the meaningfulness of certain perceptual interactions, and the
naturalness of certain perceptual explorations and combinations. Because of this, the “as” in the
fundamental character of the perception of something “as something” seems hidden: it seems to us
that we see things simply as they are in themselves and for everybody else, whereas we are
interacting with them, in their own materiality and from a perspective that is spatial, temporal,
and pragmatic.
1.3 From Practices to Experience
The extension of Wittgenstein’s account of social practices to the perceptual domain is the
broad framework for the Social Enactive Theory of Perception. The finely grained analysis of
perception that I began to offer with the four characteristics of perceptual practices draws from
all sensory modalities and accounts for the diversity of objects and modes of exploration of the
different ways of perceptual interaction. Most philosophy of perception is biased by vision, and
wrongly so. Wittgenstein does not entirely escape this tendency, notwithstanding some
remarks dealing with other sensory modalities.
SEP is deployed both diachronically and synchronically, according to whether the focus is
on social perceptual practices, or on the more shortly temporally bounded interactions of a
perceiver with worldly things, respectively. The pragmatic is at work on two different levels.
The distinction is between a system of social practices in which bright colors are favored in
clothing and house decoration according to social notions of appropriateness (diachronic aspect),
and specific interactions of a perceiver with clothing where certain shades of color are actively
discriminated (or not) and judged as matching a different color (or not) by a perceiver (synchronic
aspect) situated pragmatically (deciding what to wear for a social occasion). In this chapter, I
have taken the diachronic approach to perception.
A central implication of the main thesis of this chapter—that perception is best understood
as a type of social practice—is that the diachronic conditions the synchronic, i.e. that social
practices condition individual interactions. This occurs in two senses. First, it means that the
59
configuration of the activity and the ways of acting are dependent on shared ways of doing
things (without precluding individual variations). In the second sense, even seemingly
independent, traditional basic perceptual concepts used in the philosophical discussion, such as
recognition and discrimination, individuation of sensory properties and phenomenal qualities,
are constituted by social practices in relevant ways. What ranges of smells we enjoy, seek, and
actively combine with others; what sound combinations we find harmonic and use to dance
originates constitutively in the social practices in which those perceptual properties occur.37 In
these two senses, practices carry over into the synchronic analysis.
Chapter one dealt with the diachronic and social practice-level, whereas chapters two
through five deal with synchronic and individual aspects of perception, where perceptual
practices are instantiated in individuals’ perceptual interactions. It would be wrong to say that I
deal first with the social and then with the individual because the individual is constituted by
social ways of doing things, even though it features the particularity that comes from being in a
meaningful way an individual interaction. This is why SEP is a social theory of perception.
The reader will certainly feel a change of register, of tempo, between chapter 1 and
chapters 2 through 5. The shift is perspectival within the theory itself. This dual perspective is a
matter of two necessary and complementary takes on the same phenomenon. It is justified by
the complexity of perception as to its location in the lives of communities and subjects, and, as
to the aspects, it reveals when it is instantiated in individual interactions. The perspective of
individual interactions allows a fruitful engagement with standard and contemporary views in
the philosophy of perception. Specifically, chapters 2 through 5 deal with perceptual experience,
perceptual content, perceptual recognition and discrimination, sensory properties, and primary
and secondary qualities, among others.
37 There is a different type of pragmatic dependence, a non-social pragmatic dependency, which I will explore in chapter 3 (section 3.3.1). The latter refers to patterned links between actions and sensory stimulation, whose mastery is constitutive of our perceptual experiences, and that are not socially constituted but belong to the physicality of the interaction.
60
I would now like to offer a coarse parallel and some links between social practices and the
individual perceptual interactions of the following chapters. In relation to the idea that
perception is contextual, the reader may look at the spatiotemporal and dynamic nature of
perception (chapters 3, 4, 5). In relation to the performativity of practices, the reader may look
at the interactional nature of perceptual experience (chapters 2, 3). In relation to the
expressivity of perception, the reader may look at the essentially perspectival nature of the
objects and contents of perception (chapters 2, 3, 4, 5). In relation to the normativity of
perceptual practices, the reader may look at the normativity of perceptual consciousness and
perceptual content of the last chapter (chapter 5). Lastly, I have begun to argue for the
differences between standard sensorimotor enactivism and social enactivism by showing the
distinction between motor actions and practices, that is, as a function of the performativity of
perception. Further arguments for the differences between the Social Enactive Theory and other
enactivisms can be found in chapters 3, 4, and 5.
Non-skeptical readers of Wittgenstein aim at dissolving philosophical problems that arise
from some fundamental misconceptions about the objects of inquiry. In some cases, the
philosopher’s task is not only undoing the confusions but also showing how the phenomenon
should be conceived. I think that perception is one of these cases. In addition to objecting to the
representational views, I continue with the task of presenting SEP as an alternative to them,
now by shifting gears and supplementing the practice-based perspective with the socially
constituted individual interaction perspective.
Chapter II
Perceptual Experience as the Basis for Perceptual Content
What do I perceive when I taste a meal, when I smell the park in the early morning as I ride my
bicycle through it, or when I hear a car coming towards me from my left. Do I perceive the
meal, the park, the park in the morning, the car, the car coming from my left? Do we perceive
chemical compounds and airwaves? Or do I perceive bits of worldly events, only to be later
connected inferentially or otherwise cognitively? Do I perceive chunks or sequences? Do I
perceive moving and changing things? Or do I perceive static objects and some other cognitive
processes fill in the blanks between transitions and transformations? But wouldn’t we need to be
clear first about what it is to perceive in the first place before we talk about what we perceive?
What is it to perceive that is common to my smelling the park in the morning and my hearing a
car coming toward me? Is it to be impacted by sensory impulses? Is it the matching of an inner
impression with an outer occurrence? Is it to interact with the park and the car such that in each
case I am in contact with an aspect of the world? Or may it be the case that the nature of
perception and the objects of perception are constitutively interrelated?
This chapter offers a focused analysis of perception as perceptual experience and lays out
the connections between experience and content, which will be further explored in chapters 3
and 4. Specifically, I will argue that perceptual experience is sensory-based interaction with
physical objects, events and states of affairs in the world.1 In this view, the world presents itself
or is presented to the subject, or the subject makes the world present to her. It is not the case
that the subject re-presents the world, or that the world gives rise to re-presentations of itself.
On this basis, Social Enactive Theory of Perception (SEP) holds that perceptual experience and
perceptual content are mutually implicated issues of aboutness. Questions about what we
1 While all perceptual experience is socially constituted in the sense that it is dependent on perceptual practices, as presented in chapter 1, I will not repeat this qualification here and in the upcoming chapters.
62
perceive--questions of content--depend on what it is to perceive in the first place, and the nature
of perception depends on the type of objects perception deals with.
As this chapter begins to explore the connection between experience and content, I will
situate the discussion of this chapter in relation to two broad ways of looking at perception:
representational and non-representationalist accounts of perceptual experience and perceptual
content.2 Representational views hold that representations are constitutive of perceptual
experience and perceptual content. Non-representational views assert that what is fundamental
about perceptual experiences is a specific type of direct interaction with the world such that
perceptual experience and content are constituted by the surrounding world (Taylor 2005;
Putnam 1999; Logue 2012, 212; Campbell 2002).
In addition to these concerns, belonging somewhat narrowly to the philosophy of mind, I
will also keep an eye on the epistemological concerns that McDowell has called the two
“distinctive anxieties of modern philosophy,” and to which both representationalist and non-
representationalists try to respond (1994, xvi). McDowell’s rendering of the opposition between
what he calls ‘bald naturalism’ (of which the Sellarsian Myth of the Given is protagonist) and
Davidson’s ‘coherentism’ explicates the tension (akin to what Hurley has called the Myth of the
Giving (1998)). Philosophical thinking seems torn between a pole that takes reality to be given
unmediated to subjects and a pole that, haunted by skepticism, claims that contributions from
reality are so raw that they every sense of reality must be entirely added by the mind. The
2 The representationalist side dates back to traditional accounts of mind (Descartes, Locke, Hume) and extends to computational models prominent in the cognitive sciences. On the non-representationalist side, we find, on the one hand, varieties of realism, naïve or direct, as well as some versions of intentionalism, disjunctivism about perception, and some relationalist (Crane 2001; Husserl 1983; Husserl 2001a; Campbell 2002; Snowdon 2008). On the other hand, we find a strong version of non-representationalism in the phenomenological traditions, particularly in non-idealist interpretations of Husserl, Merleau-Ponty’s philosophy of perception, and some of the contemporary situated accounts of cognition (enactive, embedded, extended, embodied). It is important to clarify that while Phenomenology is an intentionalist philosophy in the sense that it takes intentionality as a central feature, it is not, in my view, a representationalist theory. That identification I reject because it suggests, wrongly, that any view that privileges ‘intentional’ aspects of perceptual acts (or of mental states, as used in a different register) is committed to the existence of separate entities from objects called ‘representations’ of objects (Logue 2012, for example, makes this mistake). I do not agree that the intentional character of mental acts entails the existence of representations in any strong sense. I do not have the space to discuss this issue in any more detail here. (See Crane 2001, 6–33 for an interesting discussion.) For my purposes here I agree with Drummond in saying that all representationalism is a variety of intentionalism, but not all intentionalism is representational (Drummond 2012). I do not take sides on the details of Drummond’s proposal.
63
tension between these poles reveals the anxiety of being between the lure of each position and
their felt dangers.
The beginning of the solution to the epistemological concerns is that we liberate ourselves
from the apparent demand for a decision for one or the other. In continuity with the perceptual
practices view inspired in Wittgenstein’s non-skeptical readers, the view of experience here
offered is doubtful of the assumptions on the skeptical side, and correlatively on the seeming
need to move to the other extreme. If the cries of the skeptic are not really pressing, let alone
urgent, the coherentist side is not as alluring. On the other end, we start overcoming the
tension when we see as intellectually respectable to pause at and doubt the call of Zeitgeist’s
scientistic intellectual climate that assumes we can find objectivity in the physical world.3 SEP
tries to carve out a middle-way position that shares the spirit of these two rejections: the spirit
of the skeptic’s cries and of the scientist’s belief in an objective answer to our questions about
perception. SEP aims at reconciling and overcoming both these epistemological and philosophy
of mind worries.
In this chapter, I will first address the phenomenal character of perceptual experience, and
its mutual connection to the objects of perception. I then will present the view that perceptual
objects only present themselves to perceivers in appearances, profiles or perspectives, and that
there is no tension between objects and appearances, as the philosophical tradition has wrongly
thought. To this end, I find support in the simplicity of Augustine’s view of the materiality of
perceptual objects and properties. Objects are perceived through appearances or perspectives
that depend on the materiality of objects and the active relations with subjects. I finish the
chapter by offering three more arguments that build on top of the appearance-based view, by
highlighting that the perspectival appearing of objects of perception is a matter of an active
3 Merleau-Ponty’s attack on both ‘empiricism’ and ‘intellectualism’ (2002) offers a different perspective on the same tension. Other not very successful constructions of a similar kind can be found in the more recent literature. See (Logue 2012), who misguidedly and not so faithfully to the philosophers features ‘Kantianism’ on one side and ‘Berkeleian realism’ on the other.
64
engagement with the world, whose everyday texture is revealed in perception—as it fits
perceivers like us.
Lastly, I would like to point out that methodologically I now switch from the broad,
diachronic framework of social perceptual practices of chapter 1, to the individual, synchronic
interaction perspective of chapters 2 through 5. Since the two perspectives are theoretically
complementary, the discussion of this chapter follows and is compatible with the preliminary
analysis of experience offered in chapter 1, in discussing the way Wittgenstein departs from the
input, receiving-only conception of perception.
2.1 The Felt Quality of Perceptual Experience
In the most basic sense, perception is the fundamental form in which the world presents
itself to a subject, as the subject is engaged with the world by means of sensory systems attuned
to it, that is, able to relate to physical aspects of the world in ways that serve the purposes of
living. More precisely, the world appears perceptually in spatiotemporal happenings (material,
chemical, temperature-wise, mechanical, visual, etc.) falling within the different ranges of things
perceivable for someone, and that are taken up by a perceiver by means of the senses of smell,
taste, the experience of flavor, hearing, vision, and touch, as well as proprioceptive capacities,
the ability to feel temperature, and some inter and multi-modal interactions. The world presents
itself in particulars (objects, persons, and other living beings), events, states of affairs, some
relations, natural and artificial kinds, as well as some of the parts and properties of all these.
Experience has a mental connotation. Experience is usually understood as the “feeling,” the
“phenomenal” aspect, the “what it is like” of certain interactions. Such a view has been also held
by some phenomenologists who insist that the reality of the object does not matter for the
relation with the object, whose essence is part of the domain of consciousness understood, again,
as a mental entity. For SEP, experience is not the appearing of things alone, if this appearing
means the way things look, smell, hear in my mind, in my head. For SEP, experience is a lived
65
occurrence. Perceptual experience, specifically, is a type of sensory-based occurrence in which a
perceiver interacts with an object, event, or state of affairs. As such, experience includes the
physical exploration of things, the actual spatiotemporal relating to things and its development
through time. In the experience of flavor, for instance, the perceptual experience is the actual
touching of food or drink with my tongue, in my mouth, and not just the feeling I get when
something is in my mouth and touching my tongue. The experience of touching is, to add one
last example, about my moving my hand over a dog’s coat, touching its hair, its thickness, and
its direction as I move my hand, also in response to a body that is not inert. This conception of
experience is one of the cornerstones of the Social Enactive View. In this section, I emphasize
the felt quality of experience—which is part of experience but to which experience is not
limited, because it is an interaction.
Perceptual experience is characterized by originality and bodily immediacy: it is an
originally presenting of something in the flesh [leibhaftig] (Husserl 1997, 12, <14>4). It is the
presenting of an object or aspect of the world to a subject in immediate and absolute givenness as
the object being there, present, in propria persona (Husserl 2001b, 137; 1983, 245, <205>). To
say that it is an original presenting means that perception is an original way of being
consciousness of things (Husserl 2001a, 40, <4>).5 The originality accompanying the perceived is
best contrasted with the felt source of recollection: whereas in the reminiscence of a piece of
food I used to eat in my childhood there is the sense that the flavor came first from a direct
experience, perception carries with it the sense of being a direct and original acquaintance with
4 Given the importance and wide presence of Husserl in this dissertation, I offer pagination according to the Husserliana edition (save for Experience and Judgment) additional to the English edition references. Non-enclosed numbers correspond to the English translation cited; page numbers of the German edition are given within angle brackets, where available. 5 Internalists about phenomenal character, like T. Horgan, also argue that intentionality involving phenomenal character –every mental state in which there is a what-it-is-like– is the only original one. On this basis, Horgan denies the possibility of robots of having consciousness (2013). For this original sense of perception see (Loar, n.d.; Mohanty 2008, 378–79; Noë 2012). For a similar implication for consciousness see loci classici for this type of claim (Nagel 1974; Searle 1980). Perception (“sensory-perceptual phenomenology,” in Horgan’s terminology) naturally counts as a paradigmatic instance of phenomenal intentionality.
66
a perceived object (Husserl 1983, 244, <210>).6 In chapter 1 I described this phenomenon of
perceiving something as a familiar encounter.
By means of direct contact with things in the world, we become conscious of the way
things actually are precisely in the manner that sensory acquaintance presents things, and not in
the manner an encyclopedia or a television news show does. Perception is consciousness of
realities, of actual states of things (Husserl 1983, 216,220 <183,187–88>; 2005, 26,<24>).
“Consciousness” does not mean here phenomenal awareness. Rather, things are conscious if the
belong to the whole of our conscious life, which includes the engagement itself with things. This
means that perceiving something comes along with the sense or “root certainty” that the
perceived is actually there and is thus-and-so (1997, 118, <140>; See also 1983, 250, <214–
15>). In Husserl's terms, it is of the essence of perceptual experience to be incompatible with
"disbelief and doubt" as to the manner in which things appears initially to a subject (1997, 21,
<22>). It may be the case that I eat greens, and am doubtful about whether it is spinach or kale.
Although I entertain doubts about the exact nature of the object perceived, the specific character
of my perception—its unclarity and indetermination—comes with certainty: I am eating some
‘greens,’ with a flavor and texture that could be this or that. Perception is certain of its
phenomenal character but implies no necessary knowledge of objects neutrally defined, and
there is no reason to think that such knowledge makes perception less direct.
Perception is always perception of something, and its character is partly determined by the
type of things it is of. The archetypical ‘object’ of perception is a time-extended continuum, in
which we might or might not find “smaller” units or aspects. When available, smaller unities
and aspects (a leaf in a plant, a surface on a table, the red of my pants) are also objects of
perception, but not autonomously, and only under extensive qualifications (despite the common
usage, philosophical, scientific, and popular that takes them to be the only objects of perception).
6 This is important because a traditional reading of Husserl’s phenomenology implies a disregard for the actuality of the object of a mental act when considering what is essential to the mental act. In the Husserl-inspired view I am proposing, the reality of the perceptual object is essential to perception. As a matter of fact, Husserl contrasts perception with other mental acts that may be thought to share pictorial or presentative elements with perception, namely memory and phantasy, in order to delimit the nature of perceptual experience (See Husserl 2005).
67
The objects of perception are objects, events, and states of affairs, and also features or aspects of
those objects, events, and states of affairs.
Within the perception of continua, perceptual experience grasps unities, or rather, is
directed towards unities—the cake, this fabric, that sound, the texture of some pastry, the top of
that tree (Husserl 1997, 28–30, <33–36>). The grasping of this unities, which I will discuss at
length in chapter 4 (for it fits better in relation to content rather than to experience), is implied
in some of the things we do perceptually, such as discrimination, recognition, the finding of
similarities or differences (Husserl 1997, 29–30, <35>). However, perceptual experience is not
limited to such grasping of unities, because perception is also about what is not yet unitary,
about the transitions between units, or about the whole continua we are discussing.
Thus, a total perception can be initially thought of “a chain of resting perceptions, unified by
transitional phenomena, in which various sides and parts of the thing present themselves in a
stable way” (1997, 83, 76, <98,89>).7 Consider the following sequence:
If we observe an unchanging object at rest, for example, a tree standing before us, we
pass over it with our eyes, now we step closer to it, now back away from it, now here, now there, we see it now from this, now from that side. During this process the object is constantly given to us unchanged, as the same: we see it as such; and yet a slight turn of attention teaches us that the so-called perceptual images, the modes of appearances, the aspects of the object constantly change. In a constant variation of modes of appearances, perspectives, that is, during a constant variation in the actual lived-experience of perception, we have a consciousness that runs through them and connects them up, a consciousness of the one and same object. (Husserl 2001a, 34, <374–75>)
This example features variations in perceptual experience that consist in the interaction
between subject and object. There can be changes in the object, either because of intrinsic
changes (like a balloon as it’s inflated) or because of movement (like the sound of the ebb and
flow of the ocean); changes in a medium on which perception depends (a silent our loud
environment in the perception of someone’s speech, or open space that gets foggy); changes in
the perceiver, physically speaking (sensory fatigue for someone trying several different
7 A full qualification of the sense in which the perceptual object is a sequence or a continuum is presented in chapter 4.
68
perfumes, a hand that grows numb, a finger that gets a bit burned but is still able to touch);
changes in the perceiver, psychologically speaking (as mood affects perception, in a Sartre’s
Nausea-like way, or simply as attention changes); and changes in what the perceiver does.
The perceived object tells us something about the activity of perception. Perception is what
it is partly because it relates to certain objects and not to others. In perceiving a given object as
it changes, or as the relational position of perceiver and object changes, such object is placed in a
context that partly determines what it comes to be for a perceiver. In turn, this pragmatic and
spatiotemporal context underlies our relation with the perceptual world. For instance, the
relationship between specific perceived objects and the total field of things perceivable at a given
moment— the way the background colors the possibilities of perceiving those objects—must be
thematized into perceptual experience.8
2.2 Phenomenon, Appearances, and Relationality: The Real Object When Perceived
SEP’s take on content is one piece with a perspectival understanding of the perceptual object. In
other words, the idea of content depends on the idea of appearance. A perceptual object is an
object of the world, which in virtue of its physicality or material-dependency, and in virtue of
8 In talking about this relation, Husserl says that each separate, partial moment that “remains in continuity with the underlying total apprehension, is brought along with the latter into the synthetic unity of the consciousness of identity,” that is, with the conscious perception of one and the same object or unity (Husserl 1997, 77, <90>). Compare with Heidegger criticism of Fichte’s suggestion to “think the wall, and to think the one who thinks the wall.” Heidegger goes on: “In our natural comportment toward things we never think a single thing, and whenever we seize upon it expressly for itself we are taking it out of a contexture to which it belongs in its real content: wall, room, surroundings […] Sitting here in the auditorium, we do not in fact apprehend the walls—not unless we are getting bored.” And further along: “If we are actually thinking the wall, what is already given beforehand, even if not apprehended thematically, is living room, drawing room, house” (1988, 162–64). The ‘underlying total apprehension’ of which Husserl talks in perceptual, epistemological terms is part of what Heidegger calls the ontological presuppositions of handiness [Zuhandensein] and of worldliness [Weltlichkeit] (Heidegger 2010, 53–87). I agree with Husserl in thinking, however, that a rich lay of the perceptual land—and not only in the sense that we do not perceive noises but a creaking wagon (Heidegger 2010, 179), or that the farmer does not perceive an objective meteorological wind, but the south wind as an omen (Heidegger 2010, 79)—in perceptual terms must be secured.
It seems to me that the ontological flavor Heidegger gives in Sein und Zeit (1927) (or in his Basic Problems of Phenomenology, from a 1927 lecture) to these themes certainly amounts to a difference between Heidegger and Husserl. However, Husserl addressed these themes since his Untersuchungen (1901) and more explicitly in this Ding und Raum lectures (1907), or later in Ideen I (1913) and Ideen II (1914). We will encounter later in this dissertation more of these Heideggerian appropriations-with-a-twist of Husserlian ideas. In particular, the deeply developed system of indications or references [Hinweise] that forms the core of Husserl’s theory of fulfillment is later appropriated by Heidegger under the idea of a context of references (Verweisung) that underlies the notions of relevance and significance (Sein un Zeit), or the idea of functionality contexture in Basic Problems (See also Heidegger 1988, 161–170). The pragmatic-centered reading of Husserl that I offer contains these features.
69
the modes in which a perceiver encounters it, is presented itself to a subject or a community of
subjects in manners best referred to as ‘appearances’ or ‘aspects.’9 We could also refer to the
manners in which the object is present as a matter of ‘perspectives’ or ‘profiles.’ This
understanding is the coupling of two ideas: (i) the perceptual world is a materially-based reality,
and (ii) the world presents itself to perceivers never at once, but in spatial, temporal, pragmatic
or otherwise perspectival or aspectual configurations.
Thus, appearance does not entail distance between object and subject. By the same token,
appearance does not entail distortion of the object. The appearances of an object are the way the
very object exists as a perceivable entity, in the conditions in which it appears to a thusly-
determined perceiver. This means exactly this: it is of the nature of straight sticks to appear
crooked when they are placed in the water, and an observer sees the stick through the water. Its
appearing crooked in the water reveals something about the world: the interaction of a medium
like water and the visual appearing of something—the manifesting of something through
reflected light. By the same token, it is of the nature of spatiotemporal objects placed on earth to
grow bigger or smaller according to relative distance to subject. A spatial object is precisely the
type of thing that presents itself to perception (that is perceived) in such variations. Were such
variations not to take place, our confidence in the reality of the object and, with it, our
confidence in our actions about such object would decrease. An ‘impartial’ and ‘full’ definition of
objects, or the idea of knowledge understood as adequacy between an object impartially sizeable
in its entirety and the seizing of such object, are unfit to understand perception.
Most theories of perception commit a category-mistake that bears a close resemblance to
Ryle's attack on dualism. Particularly, to insist that the perceptual object is nowhere to be seen
if we only have appearances is like the person that visits a university and, after seeing students,
professors, buildings, classrooms, libraries, etc.m is still looking for the university. It is about
looking for the “wrong type of thing" (Ryle 2002, 35).
9 Nothing at this point commits me to a description of objects in the world as natural particulars or kinds, partly because I do not limit ‘world’ to the sum total of naturally existing objects. I use the term “object” in a loose sense—and include properties, events, and states of affairs. I do also consequently with the term “world.”
70
The fundamental mistake I am pointing to is that we lose perception if we focus on the
narrowly conceived epistemological role of perception. It is an epistemologist saying: “I don’t
care what perception is, for whatever it is, it deceives us: deception defines perception.” There is
more to perception than knowing something adequately, and that to call perception deceitful is
not only misleading but is also wrong. It is not even entirely clear that the accusations brought
upon perception are not accusations about the structure of the world itself, namely, that
vagueness and lack of certainty are a feature of the world and not of perception.
Let me now spin this line of though in a different direction. My interest is not an ontology
of the world—objects, events, states of affairs—but a theory of perceptual content, which
subscribes to the presentational character of objects in a direct realist context. What I am
interested in is this: What type of contact with the world does perception afford? How does
perception relate us to objects and objects to us? What are worldly objects or happenings for a
perceiver?
A habit of thought, to borrow Hurley’s expression, about the relation between objects and
perception is clearly captured in this passage from Hume: “The table, which we see, seems to
diminish, as we remove farther from it: But the real table, which exists independent of us, suffers
no alteration: It was, therefore, nothing but its image, which was present to the mind” (1977,
104).
From the unwarranted conclusion that only an image “can ever be present to the mind,” a
bolder one is derived, namely, that the senses are on the hither side of a cleft between mind and
objects. The thrust of the argument is the inadequacy between the object (which doesn’t change)
and our perceptions (which change). Inadequacy is an objection to the natural sense of direct
contact that perception affords, to the natural trust and confidence in our dealings with the world
based on perception (it is not, to be sure, an objection on our trust on the ‘deliverances’ of
perception, for this framework of perception as deliverance of the senses is already part of Hume’s
picture). It is an objection only because adequacy or correspondence is thought of as a criterion
71
of valid acquaintance. Valid acquaintances between minds and objects are those in which strict,
objective co-variation obtains. But where does the idea of a valid acquaintance as
correspondence get its validity? What is it that makes so prevalent this centuries-old objection
so that it grounds such a wide lineage of arguments from error or illusion that try to
characterize perception’s nature from precisely this ‘defect’? More precisely: What type of thing
is the table thought to be, so that our seeing it would only give us remote images of it? Does it
even make sense to say that perceptions are inadequate?
I now suggest we look at Augustine’s understanding of the materiality of the perceptual,
which he arrives at by a comparison with the nature of truth and true knowledge.10 Although
Augustine may sound like an unlikely choice (certainly a strange one), methodologically, there
are two advantages that make him a useful source. First, he does not share the modern
“commonsensical” division between the inner and the outer, and yet he allows for talk of
subjective happenings that are not representations or intermediary images between things and
consciousness. Augustine takes perceptual objects to be objects in the world and not images or
individual impressions: "You would not say that what the eyes of two persons see belongs to the
eyes of one or the other of them. It is a third thing towards which both direct their regard"
(Augustine 1953, 156). Second, the subjective aspect of perception has a sense of interaction
between the perceiver and the world that is not the detached view of the epistemological gaze,
but instead is very much anchored in the transactions themselves with the world. Thematically,
we’ll get two things from this analysis: a sense of what perceptual objects are and why their
nature entails that their modes of appearance are essential to them, and a sense of how the idea
10 There is a trans-historical terminological difficulty here. What is the genus of truth? Is it only a property of thoughts or propositions? Or is it an object-like proposition or intuition, or the set of all these thoughts? While for the Modern rationality truth is a property of thoughts or propositions, for some ancient philosophers (clearly the Platonists and friends) truth is more a type of object that one can possess, and that equips one with an understanding of the essential nature of things. (Notice that in a certain mindset this does not mean that the one who “possesses” truth actually understands things or acts accordingly, whereas in a different mindset one cannot know the truth and not act correctly). This ancient way of looking at things lends itself to talk about the truth as something one possesses, or lacks. One could give a formal account of truth in general, regardless of content. I do not have the space to expand on this here, nor it is relevant to the use I make of Augustine here. My purpose with Augustine is not exegetical. I just intend to present a contrast between two formal ontological regions: between things that are public, unitary and persistent (like “Truth” and true knowledge) and some that are not (like the objects of the senses), because this type of category mistake is at the basis of common confusions about perception.
72
of truth is so easily understood through the senses but how it dramatically departs from them.
My goal is to suggest that we can start feeling at ease with appearances, and to elicit some
surprise about the seeming validity of Hume’s analysis of our perception of the table, hence
softening the confidence in that outlook.
In De Libero Arbitrio Augustine debates over the nature wisdom and truth. He does so by
contrasting true knowledge with the objects of the senses (1953, Book II). It can be said that
three criteria characterize true knowledge: publicness, unitariness, and persistence. True knowledge
has the property of being public: many can be related to it, that is, someone’s access to truth does
not limit anyone else’s access. True knowledge is unitary in two senses: in being related to the
(so to speak) same piece of true knowledge, the many get the same one thing; and, second, that
to know a part of something is eo ipso to know the whole. This unity-character of true
knowledge is unity in the archetypical sense of a geometrical point: it has no dimensions, it has
no aspects—to get it would amount to get it all. True knowledge is persistent: it cannot be
changed, used up or depleted. A conjunction of the three concepts defines true knowledge: it is
public without restrictions, unitary without restrictions, and persistent without restrictions.
Publicness is that which the objects of touch don’t have, but that the objects of sight and
hearing do: “But you cannot say that each of us has his own private sun or moon or stars or the
like, though each of us sees these things with his own particular sense of sight?” (1953, 145).
Objects of touch aren’t public in this sense (actual availability, at a given moment, for everyone
desiring and able) for my touching something impedes others from touching it, that is, we both
can touch the object but not the same ‘side’ at a given moment (1953, 146).
Unitariness is a characteristic of the objects of sight and hearing, for they seem to have no
parts—‘part’ including here parts, sides, and aspects in general—, so that if they are perceived,
they are perceived in their totality. This is not the case for the objects of smell, taste, or touch.
They are not unitary in the sense that parts ‘of air’ carrying a smell enter someone’s nose, but
cannot enter simultaneously two noses. Because of this, smell is only seemingly (or potentially)
73
public: for as soon as someone draws a good breath, it restricts others’ access to smells
associated with that air (1953, 145). This case is structurally analogous to taste.
Persistence is predicated of objects of sight alone. It is not predicated of sounds because they
disappear as time passes; not (generally) of smell because air (normally) takes it away; not
always of touch, because materials normally wear out. The contrast is nicely reached through
the objects of taste, whose associated property, the taste itself of something, depends on
physically consuming food: “It is true that nurses give infants food which they have chewed, but
the part which has been squeezed out and been swallowed, cannot be recalled and used to feed
the child. When the palate tastes something pleasant it claims a part, even if only a small part,
which it cannot give up, and does with it what is consonant with corporeal nature” (1953, 147).
(The fact that the ‘matter’ is ‘preserved’ sets this example apart from the case of taste not being
unitary.)
The idea of the palate ‘claiming’ a part of flavor underscores (i) the physicality (or material
dependence) of the perceptual object (Augustine’s “corporeal nature,” corporalia), (ii) the
dependence of properties perceived on such physicality, (iii) the dependence of the perceiving
such properties on a specific interaction between perceiver and object.
It is precisely this line of thought what gives Augustine resources to set true knowledge
apart from sight, the only sense that from a snapshot point of view is public, unitary, and
persistent. One can see, once again, the seduction of the visual (quite related to what Augustine
himself called the ‘lust of the eyes,’ or what Rorty has referred to as “the Platonic quest for that
special sort of certainty associated with visual perception” (2009, 181)).11 I want to focus on two
arguments Augustine offers.
11 The point is certainly epistemological and not moral, as we read in Confessions, X: “For seeing belongeth properly to the eyes; yet we apply this word to the other senses also, when we exercise them in the search after knowledge. For we do not say, Listen how it glows, smell how it glistens, taste how it shines, or feel how it flashes, since all these are said to be seen. And yet we say not only, See how it shineth, which the eyes alone can perceive; but also, See how it soundeth, see how it smelleth, see how it tasteth, see how hard it is. And thus the general experience of the senses, as was said before, is termed "the lust of the eyes," because the function of seeing, wherein the eyes hold the pre-eminence, the other senses by way of similitude take possession of, whensoever they seek out any knowledge” (Augustine 2009, 303). The thrust of the remark applies mutatis mutandis to the bulk of contemporary philosophy of perception.
74
The first argument (trailing (i) above) is based on the corporeal nature of perceptual objects
themselves and is perhaps best directed towards sight: “however small the object may be, it has
at least a right-hand part and a left-hand part, an upper and a lower part, a further and a nearer
part, one part at the end and another at the middle. We must admit that these parts exist in any
body, however small, and accordingly we must agree that no corporeal object is a true and
absolute unity” (1953, 148). The objects of sight aren’t like truth-objects (in Augustine’s
conception), for they have parts.
The second argument (see (ii) above) is based on the perception of perceptual objects and
presents what appearances are: “Truth, therefore, is less like the things we touch or taste or
smell, and more like the things we hear and see. For every word is heard as a whole by all who
hear it and by each one at the same time. And every sight offered to the eyes is exactly the same
for all who see it, and is seen by all at the same time. But although there is a similarity there is
also a great difference. A whole word is not spoken all at once. It is extended over a period of
time, one syllable being pronounced first and another after it.” And then he goes to turn things
inside out, for it is of the nature of such objects to be encountered in precisely certain ways:
“Every visible sight varies with the place from which it is seen, and is nowhere seen in its
totality. And certainly all these things can be taken from us whether we will or not, and there
are difficulties in the way of our enjoying them” (1953, 158). And what he means by “difficulties”
is only salient over against the desire for full apprehension, as people desirous of hearing the one
who sings “sweetly for ever” but even getting closer only affords them “transient fugitive
sounds”; or as the one who wishes to eternally see the sun and is yet disappointed at sunset.
In contrast, the beauty of truth and wisdom “does not pass with time or change with
locality. It is not interrupted by night or shut off by shadow and is not subject to the bodily
senses. To all who turn to it from the whole world, and love it, it is close at hand, everlasting,
bound to no particular spot, never deficient” (1953, 159). Over against the background of
publicness, which is always available depending only the an act of the will (in contrast with
75
difficulties of enjoyment derived from the bodily senses), unitariness is here spelled as the
absence of spatiality, and persistence is tied to uninterrupted continuity, to ever-fullness, to
everlastingness.
Augustine’s business is not to discredit the senses. He very much values them in their
idiosyncrasy. Furthermore, it seems to me that Augustine’s spelling out of truth’s
characteristics in perceptual terms touches upon a deeper point, to wit: that one of our central
ways of knowing, full stop, is perception; and that one of our central ways of understanding
what knowledge of truth is, full stop, is based on understanding perception.12 Perception is,
following Merleau-Ponty, the way how we learned what it was for things to be thus-and-so: to
be thus-and-so is the type of thing you encounter when you see something, when you hear
something, when you touch something.13
Let us leave behind us this half-anecdotal, delightful and greatly informative episode in the
history of Philosophy--where the love of truth has often harvested the delights of perception
and discarded the limitations of those delights: the perspectival, temporal, spatial character of
the objects that we perceive.14 When truth is demanded of perception, there is a disregard for
the essential characteristics of the perceptual field: it is Hume accusing the table of being a 12 Merleau-Ponty has said that “there is indeed one human act which at one stroke cuts through all possible doubts to stand in the full light of truth: this act is perception, in the wide sense of knowledge of existences” (2002, 40). Merleau-Ponty even defined perception as “ access to truth” (2002, xvi). There is a deep connection between this notion and the thick notion of ‘world’ that Husserl came to develop in his late years and which Merleau-Ponty elaborates in the Preface to his Phenomenology of Perception (2002). 13 To be sure, I am not making an argument for the usefulness or uselessness of everyday visual or tactile perception for the purposes of developing a scientific theory of the universe, or a body of knowledge that responds to the scientific idea of truth. Those favoring the type of theories I’ve been attacking would possibly reply saying that the insistence on the possibility of perceptual deception is an indisputable fact. They would say they are not being ‘unfair’ to perception. Whatever way you define perceptual experience, they would say, the case is that we sometimes fail to see things the way they are: we jump as if a certain distance was shorter, we smell food at home and get excited about dinner, only to discover that the meal was other than we thought, we thought we heard a friend talking but it was a stranger. Perception can deceive us, and the more powerful we think perception to be, the greater the possibility of deception (See Silins 2013). 14 Consider the following outstanding passage in Confessions, X: “But what do I love, when I love Thee? Not beauty of bodies, nor the fair harmony of time, nor the brightness of the light, so gladsome to our eyes, nor sweet melodies of varied songs, nor the fragrant smell of flowers, and ointments, and spices, not manna and honey, not limbs acceptable to embracements of flesh. None of these I love, when I love my God; and yet I love a kind of light, and melody, and fragrance, and meat, and embracement when I love my God, the light, melody, fragrance, meat, embracement of my inner man: where there shineth unto my soul what space cannot contain, and there soundeth what time beareth not away, and there smelleth what breathing disperseth not, and there tasteth what eating diminisheth not, and there clingeth what satiety divorceth not” (Augustine 2009, 261). In conjunction with the passages from On Free Will, we can now appreciate that the idea of taste such that it doesn’t diminish with eating captures the denial of the materiality of things, in which the idea of truth and the denial of the senses consist.
76
spatial object; it is Descartes complaining about the susceptibility to heat of wax, or about
spatial nature of tower and large statues; it is Russell concluding that that which is not
‘inherent’ in the table is not conducive to any kind of knowledge of the table. This has been to a
great extent the origin of skepticism about perception, and we now start to see why it is possible
to dismiss that skepticism: it is based on a misunderstanding about perception.15 Demanding
truth in perception is like complaining that a visual object cannot be seen and cannot be known
in the darkness, and criticizing perception on that basis.
We are now in the position to see the insight in the following passage by Husserl:
When we view the table, we view it from some particular side, and this side is thereby why is genuinely seen. Yet the table has still other sides. It has a non-visible back side, it has a non-visible interior; and these are actually indexes for a variety of sides, a variety of complexes of possible visibility […] But this thing is not [merely] the side genuinely seen in this moment; rather (according to the very sense of perception) the thing is precisely the full-thing that has still other sides, sides that are not brought to genuine perception in this perception, but that would be brought to genuine perception in other perspectives (Husserl 2001a, 40, <4>)
As I read Husserl in this respect, there is a difference between (a) objects as they would be
defined in some sort of all-encompassing abstraction and universal language, and (b) the
perception of an object (Levinas 1963, 88; Drummond 1990, 143–44; Zahavi 2003, 59–60). The
reason for this distinction is that perception has a perspective on the object, which is of the
object but is not the object.16 In my Husserlian view, the status of the object as an object of
perception is understood through the notion of appearances [Erscheinungen], that is, as that
which presents itself in appearances. Consequently, no idea of adequacy or correspondence that
15 For more on the dismissal of skepticism see Snowdon (1992), who argues for a direct realism that simply does not answer the skeptic, and McDowell (1994) and Putnam (1999), who recommend a philosophical dismissal of skeptic worries. 16 Objects are both nominatives and accusatives—prolonging a clever metaphor of Zahavi. Worldly objects and events are only neutral—in the nominative—when we name them and as the intentional pole of our acts—as reference for predication and, in a sense, for action—, but when we observe them, when we interact with them, they’re in the accusative. When we perceive, objects come as accusatives: they are appearances. Insofar as the world appears, we ourselves are “datives of manifestation, as those to whom objects appear” (Zahavi 2003, 51). Appearances would be genitives of the world. To put everything in the nominative (or rejecting doing otherwise), to keep the analogy, amounts to a stubborn flattening of the philosophical discourse. The allergy to modulation—like the modulation of grammatical cases—is sometimes thought of as proof of sophistication.
77
is not constrained by space, time, and the other perspectival determinants of perception could
have any positive role to play in addressing perception.17
We begin to be at ease with this tension between being and appearances, by insisting that the
tension is not a contradiction fundamental to both terms. My claim is indeed that some things
are of such a nature that their presenting themselves to perceivers is essentially a matter of
appearances. For perception, the question about the being of objects in themselves is of little
avail, for whatever determination is furnished there (e.g. the diameter of a planet), it is a
determination that, if perceptually meaningful (I could see such planet), would enter into the
perceptual field eo ipso as an appearance of the object to a perceiver situated here or there,
perceptually constituted in this or that way. This position is both entirely realist and entirely
perspectival, and that there is no philosophical conflict whatsoever in this pair.
Further, there is a difference between the physical qualities of objects and a perceiver’s
take on those qualities. A physical property, like a frequency in the electromagnetic spectrum,
within such and such ranges, is a color only for some seeing beings. Alien non-sensitive-to-light-
at-all scientists, with a science somewhat similar to ours, would detect the range of the
electromagnetic spectrum that is visible for us, but would not refer to colors. By means of
advanced imaging techniques (sophisticated spectrographs), these scientists even engage in
discriminative behavior based on the frequencies that we call colors. Although they detect such
frequencies they don’t perceive them—it is not just that they don’t feel them, it is that they
don’t encounter them in the immediacy and familiarity that characterizes perceptual experience.
Along the same lines, it may very well be the case that gamma radiations or radio waves—above
and below the range of the spectrum we call visible—have a direct perceptual payoff for a
certain class of perceivers. This is not an ontological point about the perceived objects, but
about the objects’ appearance in perception.
17 This applies directly to what were called the primary qualities: extension, shape, solidity, gravity, motion, and rest. However, I do not take a position about the correctness of this category, but my inclination is that it is not very useful anymore, since even the secondary ones can be correlated to physical concepts.
78
Individual perceptions are partial, underdetermined in relation to the objects of which they
are appearances, and are always open-ended. There is no absolute knowledge of an object
through perception: not only can objects and events be present to a subject in a potentially
infinite number of ways, but those individual perceptions cannot be held at the same time by the
same subject.
But just as the perceptual object is the one that exists in space and time and is related to in
perspectival determinations, it is of the essence of perception that, as a whole, we find a
continuous “braid of partial synthesis of increase and decrease [of the relative givenness of sides
and parts of things], in which, to be sure, the individual strands of the braid have and can have
no autonomy” (Husserl 1997, 95, <113>).18
We are directly acquainted with objects, events, and states of affairs in their perspectival
appearing, because we could not be related to them otherwise. I will now offer a broad analysis of
aspects and properties in which we perceive worldly things: as relational, as including high-level
properties, and as pragmatically dependent. This initial analysis will be supplemented in chapter
3 by a fuller relational account of the fundamental ways in which the appearing of things is
conditioned by facts about the perceivers and the specific interaction in which an experience
consists.19
2.3 On Appearances, Aspects, and Properties
All the aspects or appearances we perceive, insofar as they are the take of a perceiver on an
object, and not simply a determination of the object in isolation from a perceiver, are a function
of the specific relation between perceiver and object, such that the object is only presented in
18 This braid constitutes the whole over against which each appearance “refers to possibilities of fulfillment” of perceptual acts (Husserl 1997, 105, <125–26>). I referred to these possibilities in chapter 1 as playing a role in the field of perceptual interactions, and with specific relevance for the normativity of perceptual practices (section 1.2.4), and I will take them up again in chapters 4 and 5, in the discussion of perceptual content and its normativity. 19 These are the three types of dependencies of perception, namely, idiosyncratic (facts of personal and species embodiment, and otherwise idiosyncratic), non-socially pragmatic, and socially pragmatic, which are discussed in chapter 3 (section 3.3.1).
79
appearances or aspects to a perceiver. Ontologically, appearances or aspects are not on the side
of objects, but on the side of relations to perceivers. They are relational.
More than offering conclusive arguments for the view that experience consists of
interactions in which objects appear perspectivally, I have started to delineate a realist and
relationalist way of looking at perception. The initial arguments, relying importantly on
Augustine’s view of the materiality of perceptual objects, had the purpose of beginning to soften
our confidence in the commonsensical incompatibility between being and appearance that is at
the heart of the philosophical tradition.
I examine now three specific argumentative lines that show that objects, events, and
states of affairs are only perceived in appearances, that is, that there is no internal contradiction
in the one-many relationship between object and its appearances. These three arguments,
although of different in character, have something in common and fundamental for SEP:
perception is an active engagement. These arguments are also meant as a way to populate the
stage of perception as the scenario of rich interactions with the world that express what the
world is and what we, worldly inhabitants, are.
These three arguments are of different character: that some aspects we perceive depend
on the pragmatic engagements of subjects with things perceived; that the quality of the
perceptual world in everyday life is such that it requires that we perceive high-level properties
attributable only to perception, which show the interaction between a contextually situated
perceiver and the world; and that since the human perceiver is who she is and perception is what
it is in a perceiver’s life, objects have to appear in appearances and in concrete pragmatic
contexts.
2.3.1 From Relationality to Activity
Of all the aspects, properties or qualities objects, events, and states of affairs that we perceive,
some can be predicated of spatiotemporal objects, events, and states of affairs neutrally defined,
80
but some cannot. We can attribute a texture to a surface, but we cannot attribute a reflection to
a body of water in which the reflection occurs.
Notice however the ambiguity we have here, which has been a source of confusion: In
perception we are indeed acquainted with objects, but only through aspects or appearances.
Since we are indeed acquainted with objects directly we are led into thinking that the aspects we
perceive are features of the object. That is correct. But we are often led into thinking, rather,
misled into thinking, that those aspects are features of the object in an unqualified way: that they
belong to the object, not matter who perceives, under what conditions, from what position, for
how long, etc. That is incorrect. That is the ambiguity that makes Hume puzzled about a table
having a size, and appearing both of size S, smaller-than-S, and larger-than-S at different times
to a moving perceiver.
A good deal of what we perceive depends evidently on the way a perceiver relates to what
she perceives, that is, on the pragmatic engagements of subjects with things perceived. These
are essential aspects of the quality of the world as we perceive it.
I first want to put pressure on the often-implicit assumption that in perception we are
passively impressed by the world—a perspective that is easy to fall in if one limits the perceiver
to their perceptual organs, and which is very much reinforced when we focus excessively or
perhaps uniquely (as most philosophers do) on vision.
Let’s start with an argument about texture issuing from the mechanical interaction
between a perceiver and an object. Texture requires a sort of action on the part of the skin that
touches, that is, it requires a mechanical event (pressure, with or without movement) in order to
make itself be felt.20 One can attempt at a physical description of the conditions that give rise,
for instance, to a texture: the product of an object-surface topography in a mechanical relation
with such and such sensory receptors having certain thresholds (ranges of stimulus energy)
20 For instance, orientation- and direction-sensitive neurons (e.g. Meissner's corpuscles) are precisely excited in the event of the presence of direction or orientation, which requires movement (Kandel and Schwartz 2000, 466, 432). Texture-sensitive neurons (Merkel disk receptors) are subject as well to a mechanical input (Kandel and Schwartz 2000, 432–33). The case is even more clear in the face of neurons that are activated when the hand is manipulating an object (Kandel and Schwartz 2000, 469).
81
such that mechanical force (a specific pressure vector) is needed in order for such receptors to
“feel” this or that texture as such. Perceiving is a matter of doing because, without the stimuli
that come from the doing, there would be no perception—without a type of action or movement,
there would be no touching.21
This reference to the way touch depends on mechanic interaction is an indication of how
many of the properties we perceive in things are not properties that could be obtained of objects
neutrally defined, or properties that only depended on the condition of an organ (in the manner
vision requires the capacity to ‘see’ certain frequencies of the electromagnetic spectrum).22
There is one additional step here and that is that a specific type of interaction is needed in order
to obtain certain tactile experiences. The sensory contact of the sense of touch requires specific
action on the part of the perceiver to be individualized: if one touches two similar yet different
surfaces (for example, two kinds of paper) just as gently, one may not perceive any difference
between them. One may need to touch both papers in some detail, applying more pressure, or
moving one’s fingers more extensively over the surface of the paper.
Let’s now extend the argument further, in order to show how these pragmatic interactions
are socially defined. As we just saw, a mechanical vector (combination of movement and
pressure) is a feature of the interactions of our fingers, hands, feet—our skin and even our
tongues—with things. But if we reflect on the type of tactile properties that we perceive, we
would notice that many of the tactile properties we perceive in everyday life (texture, shape,
etc.) are correlated with specific activities: with the pressing of our feet over rocks, with the
moving of our tongues around food in quite specific ways. The movements required to feel the
21 A virtue of my account is that it lends itself to the idea that sensory organs are the product of biological evolution responding to a world of physical forces a living being needs to interact with in order to carry on with the activity of living. Thus, we came to be sensitive (and selectively so) to a range of, in this case, textures, that are relevant for our type of life. 22 There is more to vision that the relational character of colors. One may initially think that all that there is in vision is a sensory contact with something visible. This is an all-or-nothing scenario, such that the seeing person’s having their eyes open cannot help to be presented with images. But this is incorrect. I will postpone a discussion on vision to section 2.3.3 below, where I will argue that vision is indeed more similar to touch as has just been described than to the traditional view of vision.
82
texture of objects as they are experienced and for the purposes of the activity in which they are
immersed are defined by the practices of touching as it happens in context.
While the idea of texture, in general, can be conveyed in physical terms (as suggested
above: object-surface topography plus types of receptors plus a mechanical vector), the reality of
the perceived texture—the texture of the bark of a tree, of velvet, of gravel in the ground, of a
banana in the mouth—requires a description of a “movement” that is highly dependent on the
specific way of touching things. Specific textures are oftentimes individuated by specific
interactions. The perceptual experience of gravel, for example, is tied to the activity of walking
or standing with my feet, or even perhaps sitting, over a certain terrain. While I can feel the
texture of silk of a scarf with the skin in my neck when I wear it, I could not feel the texture of
gravel in the way I feel the silk, and I could not feel the silk in the way I feel gravel. Ranges of
movement and intensities of pressure are a function of an activity happening at the pragmatic
level.
The fineness of grain of our tactile contact with the world is dependent on specific tactile
interactions. It is properly specified by reference to interactions that are pragmatic in kind, of
which their physical description is only an incomplete description. A beginner tailor that learns
about fabrics and textures learns how to touch, that is, learns what movements to make and
what pressure to apply. So does the beginner printer that learns how to compare papers and
decide which one is best for a given job. Thus, there are aspects of the action that exceed this
physical description: what the tailor does when he compares two fabrics. We can see here an
individual interaction that instantiates a social practice: the mere mechanical interaction lacks the
determination that the practice offers, and lacks the normative social aspect that determines the
correct modes of exploration, as well as the possibilities and expectations that are in place when
encountering the world haptically.23 Certain practices—certain surfaces and certain textures—
are more defined than others, like the textures encountered in the verification of softness needed
23 This argument here is a specification of my argument for perceptual practices of my first chapter, where the primacy of practice was established.
83
in some wooden-crafted pieces such as in the craft of the highly sophisticated luthier, whose
violins or guitars are subject to the standard of the learned touch.
The experience of texture often requires a combination of movement and pressure (a
mechanical vector), which consists not on a passive perceiving but on an engagement between
subject and object, in ways that are not fully defined by a physical description of a mechanical
interaction (however informative those can be), but to a practice-based engagement with things.
By suitable modifications of the type of activity or interaction that is required in the sensory
acquaintance with perceptible objects, according to each sense, it is possible to see how this
argument applies to other modalities. The argument has been here defended for the case of
touch, but situations that fall within this framework have been offered in chapter 1 (the section
on performativity featured cases in the auditory and olfactory modalities) and will appear
continuously all throughout this dissertation (section 2.3.3 will present a case for vision where
the characteristics just exposed can be found).
2.3.2 High-Level Properties
The question about high and low-level properties is about how rich our perceptions are. On
SEP’s view, we do not only perceive low-level properties (shape, color, size, hardness,
illumination, motion, depth, location sound) but also high-level properties (particulars, natural
kinds, defined objects, agents performing actions, processes, relations like harmoniousness or
causation, among others).24 Other cases of high-level perception include emotionally loaded
situations like seeing someone is angry or hearing someone’s cry as urgent, or more basic cases
like perceiving speech and written language immediately as meaningful linguistic expressions.25
This means, for instance, that when I interact with another person perceptually, I am actually
perceiving a person, say, a woman, and not just a volume, surfaces, movements, and colors. Do I
perceive a person in the person, a woman in the person? Do I hear meaningful words?
24 I do not put much weight in a technical definition of properties. I rather take a minimal, nominalist approach: property is a placeholder for the things that can be said are proper of an object. 25 So far I am casting my discussion in terms of objects, see also (Hopp 2011, 60). My discussion in the next chapter makes clear why this talk of objects fits with talk of content.
84
In what follows, I provide phenomenological evidence for high-level properties, backed by
research in other social cognition, social psychology, and cognitive anthropology. While it
seems to me that the way things appear (this is what some people call “the phenomenology of
x”) provides evidence enough to establish the higher-level content positions, the illustrations
that follow are meant to be compelling in an additional sense, namely, that what is perceived
cannot be adjudicated to something else than perception, i.e. that it cannot be conceived as
issuing from inference, judgment, or other cognitive processing.
The view of perceptual experience I have been presenting has as an essential component
the direct perception of more-than-low-level-properties. The quality of the perceived world
requires it. To hold, as I do, that in perception we are directly related to worldly stuff, means,
among other things, that the texture, the flavor, the specific tone of the world as we perceive it
is partly constituted by the world itself. Thus, the properties we perceive are at least partly
constituted by the world as it appears perspectivally to perceivers suitably ‘situated,’ and this
means situated spatially, here or there, or enactively, that is, perceivers interacting in this or that
way with the world.26
The chemical senses count perhaps among the clearest evidence that perception is of more
than low-level properties. Specifically, the experience of the two senses of smell and taste, along
with the combined experience of flavor (which stands experientially on its own), include as
intrinsic to them the phenomenon known as hedonics. Smells or flavors are experienced not only
as sensory qualities (bitter, sweet) but in terms of an affect that accompanies them, a liking or
disliking (Barthosuk 1991; Stevenson 2009, 159–161).27 Hedonics are thought to be present at
birth in the case of taste but not in the case of smell, and to be subject to change in both cases
depending on biological development, behavioral history, and physiological specific states. As a
26 It is possible to read this section as an entailment of the relational view I backed before (Campbell 2002, 116), or as a corollary of disjunctivism about experience (Haddock and Macpherson 2008b; Byrne and Logue 2008; Logue 2012). 27 A difference is made between liking and preference. Preference is referred to intake (which features other evolution-based nutritional aspects, as well as perhaps some cognitive conscious operations, as in the case of a person that wishes to lose weight), while liking refers to a positive (or negative) affect accompanying the sensory quality, which may be related to a desire for it or an aversion to it (Zellner 1991). For the topic of hedonics, the collection of studies in (Bolles 1991) features a wide array of studies surrounding the phenomenon.
85
matter of fact, previous theories of hedonics tried to place the ‘liking’ factor in the object itself—
in the case of food, its orosensory properties. Further studies showed that the phenomenon can
only be explained by recourse to a “dynamic interaction” between properties of the food (its
sensible properties and its nutritional ones) and attributes (historical and contextual) of the
perceiver (Sclafani 1991, 60). Further, it is worth noticing that the phenomenon of hedonics of
taste, smell, and flavor features a neural counterpart that even features separate systems for
approach and acceptance and for avoidance and rejection (Schulkin 1991, 98–99).
Along similar lines, the experience of creaminess in food points in the direction of a high-
level property. For one, creaminess, like the experience of flavor in general, is understood as a
“preservative emergent property” (Stevenson 2009) that only takes place as it is experienced in
the mouth, even though visual influence sometimes occurs. 28 Now, creaminess is interesting
because unlike several other specific flavors, it cannot be neatly analyzed into a specific sensory
interaction—different senses can contribute to it. Also, creaminess is a good case of
“information redundancy,” a type of multiple realizability for flavors: the presence of the
property is perceived even with variation in “single or multiple physical features of the stimulus”
(Stevenson 2009, 70). What makes it special, and the reason why it is a great example for a
high-level property, is that these two features make the experience of creaminess immediate
available for identification, detection or appropriate response in the moment (Stevenson 2009, 4,
69–72).
Object recognition seems to imply that we are immediate and directly acquainted with
specific objects (my desk) or kinds of objects (a desk). Haptic object recognition is everywhere:
“When we dress, we do not have to fixate on buttons to fasten them; we can find the button and
buttonhole by touch. When we drive a car, we can shift gears and adjust knobs without
bothering to look” (Klatzky and Lederman 2003, 106). In the perceiving of an object, several
material properties of objects (texture, shape, temperature, surface (dis)continuities) can lead to
28 The phenomenal experience of flavor includes sensation in the olfactory, gustatory, somatosensory modalities (tactile and chemaesthetic aspects, i.e. chemical stimulation plus temperature) —the interoceptive flavor senses— and in the exteroceptive senses of vision, audition, and (orthonasal) olfaction (Stevenson 2009).
86
recognition (Klatzky and Lederman 2003). Similarly, visual object recognition seems to be able
to be singularized into a single neurophysiological system, which would further support the
point that not only low-level properties are perceived (Tarr and Cheng 2003; Logothetis 2000).
Further, recognition of objects is also dependent on task, experience and feedback (Tarr and
Cheng 2003, 29), such that these extra-perceptual factors influence the tuning of object
recognition capacities.
The case of speech perception is quite telling. Evidence to the effect that we perceive speech
as meaningful from the beginning is abundant. In the auditory experience of a language we
know, we perceive the meaningfulness of words and utterances (Butterfill 2011; Smith 2010;
Mole 2010; O’Callaghan 2007; Heidegger 2010, 158; Husserl 2005, 26,<25>). In speech
perception, we perceive rhythms in languages familiar to us, and this phenomenon is crucial for
hearers to understand speech (Cutler 1994).29 Regardless of whether the motor theory or
another theory about how of speech perception takes place, the what seems clearly established:
we perceive words and not sounds.
We visually perceive words as wholes (of languages we know) and not just ink or chalk
traces later to be inferred to be words. Further, there has been identified a specialized ‘visual
word form area’ in the visual cortex, specifically in the fusiform gyrus (McCandliss, Cohen, and
Dehaene 2003). The fact that changes in size or shape of letter or some changes in orientation in
written text do not affect visual word recognition offer additional support for a form of high-
level content.
Both speech perception and visual perception of words furnish a great case for the idea that
we directly perceive things in the world. Many philosophers find unpalatable the idea that
29 Seen from the point of view of a theory of sensible qualities, which in the case of sounds are pitch, loudness, and timbre, it seems unlikely that an objective physicalist account of such qualities is possible: “contemporary psychoacoustics researchers commonly reject the identification of pitch with frequency or periodicity. The received scientific view thus holds that pitch is a subjective or psychological quality that is no more than correlated with objective frequency (see, e.g. Gelfand 2004, Houtsma 1995)” (O’Callaghan 2009, 33; O’Callaghan 2007). It is common among philosophers to take some scientific bits of information and develop wrong folk-educated-scientific views about, for example, sensory qualities. Many philosophers take the uninformed, pseudo-scientific view that for every sensory quality that is theorized, there has to be ex hypothesi, a physical configuration independent of perceivers that allows for such quality to exist. Somewhat careful examination in olfactory, gustatory, or auditory perception, among others, dispels those common views.
87
meaningful speech is in the world and not projected or inferred by hearers. While I have no time
to discuss the issue in length, the contours of the debate are quite those of the polemic on
appearances in general. The traditional view thinks that, either, properties are in the objects
themselves, neutrally described, or they are a subjective construction of perceivers. As I have incessantly
remarked, the dilemma is to be rejected. Things can be in the world itself and yet specific
properties may not be there independently of a perceiver’s interacting with them. Once the
perceiver (and in the case of speech, the producer of the sounds as well) is such that the
interactions with the world are culturally informed, the world itself is able to present itself in
ways that are precisely dependent on such interactions. To say that in a person’s utterance
meaning is in the utterance itself is not to say that those sounds are ‘intrinsically’ meaningful as
if their meaningfulness didn’t depend on a language. But they are not merely a projection of the
hearer on the sounds. It is the interaction of a suitably situated (not spatially but culturally)
hearer with sounds that become words. I treat the case of illusions as in the case of visual
illusions, that is, like the disjunctivist does: real utterances constitute perceived speech, whereas
the illusion of speech is not constituted by real utterances. There is no common core between
them. The treatment is similar to accidental shapes that may resemble words. The opposite
views seem fated to take a good deal of the intersubjective quality of the perceived world to be a
massive illusion, and to reduce the perceptual to the sensory, in a way that, if pursued carefully,
will make the sensory a mere brute impingement on sensory endings that can do nothing alone.
These past four cases (visual and haptic object recognition, and visual words and speech)
have in common the influence of familiarity or background knowledge. We can derive from this
a further argument. In that respect, both Peacocke (1992) (although in a strictly conceptual
fashion) and Siegel (2006, 490) have argued that the fact that an experience’s phenomenal
character changes before and after acquaintance or knowledge entails that there is something
that is new in what is perceived. The difference between the before and the after cases has then
88
an unmistakable perceptual payoff. This differential also shows that such high-level contents are
part of perceptual experience.
There is another case that I will treat in some detail in the next two chapters, and which
suggests as well that perception is of high-level properties. This is the case of sensorimotor-
dependent aspects, which I will put in the broader category of non-socially pragmatic
dependencies. Some properties we perceive are not properties of the objects by themselves, but
properties of the objects or situations as they can be acted upon. For example: when riding a
bicycle, a curve is perceived as a curve that requires a certain turn (of the handle bars); a soccer
ball in movement towards oneself is perceived as a ball that calls for a certain kick; and touching
a knife’s blade in order to check for sharpness is not only a detection of a material feature but
also a behavioral implication, namely, the limit at which one would cut oneself if too much
pressure is applied. In these cases, it is the immediacy, automatic, and continuous/feedback-loop
character of the action-perception interaction that makes the case for such aspects being
perceptual and for being not just aspects of the objects (hence, not a low-level property).30
Lastly, I would like to briefly mention the visual perception of causation relations between
objects.31 At least in some cases, it can be argued that we perceive causal relations between
objects, e.g. when a billiards ball hits another, the movement of the second one is percevied as
caused by the first one. We also perceive things like a bird making a branch bend by descending
on it (Butterfill 2011; Siegel 2011b). Considerations of space prevent me from examining these
aspects in more detail. I am here however only interested in reviewing illustrations of high-level
content.
30 This interactive intuition is compatible with Gibson-style ecological formulations (see Gibson 1979), as well as enactive insights particularly akin to Hurley’s (1998; 2006). 31 Inter- and multi-modal interactions furnish plenty of cases of high-level aspects that are perceived, as in the perception of music aspects like duration are products of visual plus auditory clues. I have not time to discuss these cases at this point, but a full theory of perception must be sensitive to the idea that perception is not only an intra-modal affair.
89
2.3.3 Pragmatic Dependence
I have been urging a relationalist, realist understanding of perceptual objects, events, and states
of affairs in which appearances or aspects are essential to perception. I have offered a few initial
arguments for these appearances to be understood as correlative to specific sensory-based
interactions between perceivers and objects. I have also argued that high-level properties are
appearances or aspects of objects, events, and states of affairs. Perceptual interactions between
objects of the world and subjects do not happen statically, but in the nuanced interactions
between worldly occurrences (temporally extended continua) and perceivers, which interactions
are constituted, for the most part, by socially constituted practices.
A central aspect of the arguments so far deployed is the view that in perceptual
experience we are presented with objects belonging to our everyday world, or as Husserl had it,
belonging “to the sphere of culture, the sphere of actual life” (Husserl 1989, 243–59,<231–47>).
We smell colognes as we walk by someone, we hear cars as they pass by, and we see animals and
plants. We also see an angry friend as he evades us, or our pet in distress when treated by a vet.
The world of experience is the scenario “which furnishes the ground for all cognitive
performance,” in which perception is linked to action and judgment. In the case of perception,
individuation of perceived objects, events, and states of affairs “can take place only in practical
activity itself” (Husserl 1973, 41; see also 65).
In this section I offer a philosophical anthropological account, in the spirit of second nature
naturalism of the fact that the objects, events, and states of affairs that we perceive appear in
configurations pertaining to persons in their everyday pragmatic engagements with the world.32
This explanandum involves higher-level properties, for which a different argument has already
been offered, but the scope of pragmatic determination goes beyond: it includes the
individuation of objects, events, and states of affairs. To talk about the individuation of, say, a
perceived tree, is not to talk about what makes the tree a tree in itself, but about the way in
which the tree is presented to me in perception as I relate to it in determinate pragmatic 32 For an extended and more specific treatment of the second naturalism position see Arango (2014).
90
dispositions: as I climb it, or as I contemplate it, or as I feel its trunk’s bark). The argument is
philosophical anthropological because it articulates the notion of person and the structure of
perceptual experience through the idea that a person is essentially, in part, a perceiver.33 In order
to understand what a perceiver is is essential to understand what it is to perceive, and in order
to understand what to perceive is, it is essential to understand what a perceiver is.
This argument is phenomenological. It is an articulation of Husserl’s treatment of the idea
of person in his Ideas II. Because of this origin and style, the argument comes with
methodological and content commitments that many readers may find difficult to accept
without further explanation, or simply not at all. SEP does not depend on this section’s
argument. It is one more argument among the many that I have already offered and others that
will come in following chapters.
Further, I think that the connections between a pragmatic orientation in the world, on the
one hand, and higher-level properties and object individuations, on the other, holds good
independently of the ontological account of “persons.” In that sense, the interpretation I offer in
this section of social cognition research (i) debunking the Müller-Lyer “illusion” and (ii)
showing that seeing in terms of attention and eye movement can be culturally constituted,
should be of interest for any reader. This section can be read in a fuller or in a deflated manner:
as arguing for the pragmatic dependence of perception with or wihout considering it a matter of
a phenomenological conception of person.
The Husserlian Argument. I follow somewhat closely one of the ways Husserl thinks
about the relation between perception and everyday life. I purport to offer a deeper grounded
argument—an argument cast in a philosophical anthropology key, that is, an argument that
takes perception to be a basic component of (and grounds perception in) the life of a person. The
33 Interestingly, a similar type of strategy has been recently utilized in contemporary contributions to the way traditional philosophical debates can inform contemporary discussions on cognition. Patricia Kitcher’s Kant’s Thinker (2011) purports to examine Kant’s theory of the cognitive subject by reflecting on what type of subject Kant’s is, namely, a thinker (Kitcher 2013). Ginsborg has recently offered a compelling reply, entitled Kant’s Perceiver. In Ginsborg’s view, “we cannot understand Kant’s thinker without considering her also as a perceiver, given that thought, for Kant, is operative not only in self-consciously rational judgment but also in perceptual experience” (Ginsborg 2013, 222).
91
experiencing subject is a being that is a perceiver, a thinker, an emotional being, as well as a
social, historical and biological being. The Husserlian line of argumentation I will follow is that
of Husserl’s Ideas II (1989). The central idea is that perception is to be understood as a function
of a more basic category, position-taking [Stellungsnahme] and its related comportment
[Verhaltung]. This line of thought proves to be compatible with recent research in social
psychology and cultural anthropology on the nature of cognition and perception.
In order to investigate the lived experiences of a subject, we start with an inquiry into the
constitution of the experiencing subject—this is the thrust of Husserl’s theory of constitution.
For Husserl, the subject is constituted by multiple ‘levels’ (or ‘dimensions,’ if the reader so
wishes to read) which are different Ego-formations, ranging from, roughly, a mostly bodily
level, to the theoretical-transcendental pure Ego, to the empirical, intersubjective Ego of
everyday life (Husserl 1989).34 All these abstract formations (which to be sure do not ‘act’
isolatedly or modularly) are Ego-like in that they carry with them or entail a sense of mineness
or for-me-ness—whether it is the actional affirmation of a bodily contact with the world (i.e.
avoiding fire) or whether it is the pure transcendental Ego performing a thought experiment of
doubt, or whether it is the social empirical subject, feeling compelled to make a value-loaded
decision. This concept of mineness (a certain sense of the first person) at work here is not plain
awareness. It is a sense of things pertaining to one’s self, or being about oneself, that is not only
revealed in waking awareness, but also in the structure of experience itself.35
Of special interest for us is the case of the basic dimension of the sensory body, which
Husserl calls the aesthetic body. The sensory body is a system of psychophysical conditionalities
34 For the purposes of this section I do not pay much attention to the details of the different subject-formations (pure Ego, Ego, empirical Ego, and subject) that Husserl conceptualizes. In the present case, the level of the empirical Ego is the appropriate one to bring on for a discussion on the dependence of perception on the pragmatic. It is important to bear in mind that the empirical Ego —the subject, as we normally understand it—is a formation with a thick underlying multi-level basis always operating in it, and not a given, ready-made singular independent stratum. 35 In this, as in other places, are the differences between phenomenology in the phenomenological tradition sense, and ‘the phenomenology of X,’ in the sense of descriptions of lists of appearances. By investigating the structure of experience itself, a thicker account of the first-person domain is available, one that belongs to the structure of experience (a variety of the conditions for the possibility of experience) in manners other than awareness, and is either revealed in another phenomenon like attention or by means of phenomenological analyses of phenomena. Considerations of space prevent me from expanding on this issue.
92
that pairs sensory occurrences (or objects understood thereof) with subjective occurrences in the
body. The body determines in an important sense "what it is that, as world, stands over and
against the subject" (Husserl 1989, 70–80, <65–75>). For one, this purely sensory sense of the
body, the corporeal self [Ichleib] has the particularity of being a center of reference in relation to
which perceptual happenings take place: perceived things are above, to the left, or near; they are
disgusting or agreeable; actable upon or not, etc. (1989, 61, <56>; 1997, 124). In fact, every
experience of a perceived object or event, in its being perceived as a spatial one, carries with it a
sense of mineness in the sense that it is indexically situated in relation to me.
Further, the very possibility of coherent perceptions lies in the sense of normality intrinsic
to the experience of one’s own body, and its contrastive abnormalities. Husserl proposes the
following example: “touching something with a blister on my finger, or if my hand has been
abraded […] all the tactual properties of the thing are given differently” (1989, 66, <61>). And
yet, in many such cases, it is possible to navigate the world and use a burned finger, being able
to successfully deal with the way things feel. The point is that the mere sensory system, not
getting yet to higher-level objects and events, configures a domain in which it has authority by
virtue of being the sensory body.
There is certain continuity between this line of thought and the analysis offered above
about the nature of haptic mechano-receptors. While the previous section examined how the
nature of the sensory organ determines part of what can be perceived, Husserl’s reflection adds
to it the element of mineness that makes part of the corporeal self [Ichleib]. The sensation of
pain through specialized receptors—e.g. thermal nociceptors that excite fiber groups Aδ and C
(Kandel and Schwartz 2000, 432, 442)—is often invoked as primal evidence of what it is like to
have a first-person perspective. Keeping up with the tactile case I’ve offered before, it is plain
that whatever sensory configurations a person has, they determine the range of possibilities for
a perceiver, and such ranges feature in more nuanced activities: this is why sensory practical
expertise is obviously partly an exercise of the basic level of sensory thresholds coupled with
93
“efferent signals that contribute to motor control,” which in turn constitutes a feedback loop
between action and perception (Gallagher and Zahavi 2008, 133). Thus, the skilled tailoring
activity of comparing fabrics is partly constituted by the more basic bodily dimension of feeling
the fabrics’ thickness. In sum, the workings of the simpler, more basic bodily dimension are
constitutive of the activities of 'higher,' more comprehensive levels (Husserl 1989, 70–71, 269,
292–293 <66, 257, 280>).
It is fundamental to notice that I am not claiming that the perceptual is only the bodily
dimension. Instead, the point, so far, is that the perceptual is partly constituted by the sensory,
bodily level. The perceptual is, in general, determined by the pragmatic level, in which it is
nested. For the tailor sensing a piece of fabric, the perceptual element is guided by the pragmatic
activity of precisely evaluating a fabric, which is more than a mere touching of a surface. 36
Nor do I claim, that the sensory or bodily is only biological or physiological. In the
perceptual interaction with the fabric, there are at work determinations belonging to the
sensory aspects of touch. But they are not limited to the physiology of touch, for personal or
cultural constraints also shape a person’s sensitivity or a person’s way of using the sensory
apparatuses. Notice, however, that to invoke intersubjective (cultural and otherwise) influences
in the use of the sense of touch, as belonging to the sensory, bodily level (sensitivity, modes of
touching, that is, of applying pressure to the skin), while at the same time claiming that the
pragmatic domain (the domain where the subject acts, perceives, values, judges, etc., and which
is evidently intersubjectively constituted) determines the workings of perception, makes difficult
to regiment what belongs where. What this difficulty shows is precisely the mutually
constitutive relation between perceptual and non-perceptual pragmatic aspects.
36 Studies in cognitive anthropology, such as Lave and Wenger on learning (1991), or Lave on apprenticeship (2011), are geared towards a different level of analysis: the social organization of the learning process, which includes the activities apprentices are put to as they learn a craft or occupation. Particularly, Jean Lave has studied the case of Vai and Gola tailors in Liberia. In Lave and Wegner we see how apprentices start observing masters do their job and are progressively given tasks, from sewing a button, hemming a cuff or pressing clothes, to more complex activities like cutting and sewing entire garments. While the authors do not speak of the processes of sensory learning, we can safely assume that part of what apprentices learn is a perceptual expertise that becomes one with a social, productive one (1991, 69–72). I regard the continuity of my view with socially rich processes as a strong advantage of it, for it shows the relevance and relatedness of philosophical reflection to sociological and anthropological concerns. I have also shown how my approach is entirely compatible with biological and psychological studies of perception.
94
Take the Müller-Lyer (so-called) illusion. To this day, the Müller-Lyer case is taken by
most philosophers of mind as a proof of the representational character of perception and of its
modular character (one can’t see the lines of equal length despite knowing they are so). As some
social psychologists have shown, however, there is nothing universal or necessary about the
perception of the drawing. Some people, the San foragers of the Kalahari, do not see the illusion.
Further, the differences in perceived length between the two lines varies, with American and
South African-European populations occupying one extreme of the distribution (Henrich, Heine,
and Norenzayan 2010, 62). The results are explained thus:
[…] these findings suggest that visual exposure during ontogeny to factors such as the “carpentered corners” of modern environments may favor certain optical calibrations and visual habits that create and perpetuate this illusion. That is, the visual system ontogenetically adapts to the presence of recurrent features in the local visual environment. Because elements such as carpentered corners are products of particular cultural evolutionary trajectories, and were not part of most environments for most of human history, the Müller-Lyer illusion is a kind of culturally evolved by-product (Henrich 2008) […] this work suggests that even a process as apparently basic as visual perception can show substantial variation across populations. If visual perception can vary, what kind of psychological processes can we be (Henrich, Heine, and Norenzayan 2010, 62).37
Whether it is specifically the exposure to carpentered corners or other complex social
influences, what is key here is the illustration of Husserl’s claim that the bodily dimension,
however important it is, can be influenced by intersubjective constraints. The perceptual
element is not simply about what sensations follow what sensory worldly occurrences. It is
about ways of encountering, taking in, and relating to worldly occurrences. As this interaction
is pragmatic I now turn to the pragmatic experiencing subject who is the perceiver.
37 As scientists start to recognize the possibility of skewed results based on methodological problems, namely, on the fact that brain imaging and psychological experiments are done in more than 90% of the cases on WEIRD populations (Western, educated, industrialized, rich and democratic), the explanatory seeming scientific uniqueness of the biological is rightly called into question (See also Jones 2010). It is impressively telling, to say the least, to see the wide agreement across disciplines that followed Heinrich et al.’s The WEIRDest people in the World? in Brain and Behavioral Sciences. Commentaries (published in the same issue) by Astuti and Bloch, Boesch, Ceci et al., Chiao and Cheon, Fernald, Fessler, Gächter, Karasit et al., Khemlani et al., Kesebir et al., Konečni, Lancy, among others researchers in social psychology, cognitive anthropology and other behavioral sciences, provides scientific support to the idea of cultural variability in broadly speaking cognitive processes. Particularly for my purposes, the seeming ultimate status of the biological and physiological in discussions of perception seems quite dubious and considerable support is found for the type of mutual constitutive relation between the pragmatic and the perceptual I am arguing for.
95
a. The subject is an active position-taking. The subject, for Husserl, is not a substance but rather
an active being in which a complex underlying basis is in action and is made manifest in the
way things are dealt with, and even in the things that are dealt with. The subject takes position
in relation to things, goals, persons or situations, and exercises faculties and habits that
determine relational stances regarding things (Husserl 1989, 265, <253>). This position-
taking of the person is the pragmatic, actional ‘thematization’ of a relation of the subject
with aspects the world—themata are posited and acted upon them (Husserl 1989, 119–120,
<112–113> See also 265ff., <253ff.>).
b. The subject’s being in her position-takings is at the level of the full person. This notion of subject is
one that we find in the “fullness of the person,” i.e. concrete human beings in their
idiosyncrasies. This is why what is proper of the subject, its business, or what it has a stake
in, is to take position according to motivations. Motivations, which Husserl call the
“lawfulness of the life of the spirit,” are like reasons, and are opposed to causes. (Husserl
1989, 231, <220>). Thus he says:
[The fullness of the person is] the Ego as human, the 'I take a position,' the I think, I value, I act, I complete works, etc. Then there also belongs to me a basis of lived experiences and a basis of nature (“my nature”) that is manifest in the play of lived experiences. This nature is the lower psychic layer, but it extends even into the sphere of position taking: the position-taking Ego is dependent on its substratum insofar as I, in order to be motivated in my position taking, must have precisely the motivating lived experiences, which stand in an associative nexus and under rules of associative dispositions. (Husserl 1989, 293, <280>)
c. The identity that can be accorded to full person is a function of the consistency evinced in her position-
takings and comportments. It is part of the idea of a subject that the subject is the same in all
her position-takings, and that in all her position-takings the subject is the same: “As long as
I am the one I am, then the position-taking cannot but ‘persist,’ and I cannot but persist in
it” (Hua IV, 118–119, <111–112>).
This is an identity thesis between the subject and its activities, that is, between the subject
and its positioning itself pragmatically over against things and events: “My thesis, my position-
96
taking, my deciding from motives […] is something I have a stake in” (Husserl 1989, 119,
<122>).38
The identity of the subject is presupposed conventionally but never fully actually
determined. Constitution is an ongoing business, which reveals itself in continuous position-
takings and comportments of the subject. Thus, we must rather speak of an interactive
correlation between a subject and the activities (and objects and situations proper of such
activities) pertaining to it, such that the subject determines the character of those activities and
is at the same time influenced and further shaped by those activities themselves (see Husserl
1989, Supplements VII, X). In this correlation we find an explanation of a more general idea
according to which "the subject develops by living" (Husserl 1989, 264, <252>).
Summarizing, the person as an active, position-taking is “expression” or the “blooming” of
lower levels always acting “in” it. We find in person a style of being, a mode of acting, a manner
in which things are done, a host of tendencies and preferences, of likings and dislikings. Because
of this, it is possible to say that individual positionings and ensuing perceptions or actions are
gathered together under the idea of comportment [Verhaltung] (Husserl 1989, 226-238, <215–
226>). The perceiver that we are trying to understand in order to understand her perceiving life
is or has a mode of comporting herself in the world—which is really nothing other than saying
that she has—that she is—a way of regarding, relating to, an acting upon realities.
Let’s us now focus back on the perceptual aspects of pragmatically informed interactions
with the world, so as to illustrate and provide some additional arguments for the dependence of
the perceptual on the pragmatic that I have been arguing for.
In the view I have been advancing, the ‘workings’ of perception are not only the contact
with already individualized objects, events or state of affairs. The reason is that the focusing on
a given particular, with such and such spatial and temporal boundaries, is itself a perceptual
happening. When listening to a favorite song, listeners may find themselves paying more
38 “Meine Thesis, meine Stellungnahme, mein auf die Motive hin Mich-entscheiden […] ist meine Sache” (Hua IV 1989, 119, <122>).
97
attention to the voice or to the drums, or to the melody itself. This focusing on a specific aspect
or unity is already perceptual and naturally underlies the more specific perceptually interacting
with it. Let me illustrate this.
Research in social cognition has shown differences between the way some Americans
visually perceive and the way some East Asians do. Measurements of eye movements when
confronted with a visual scene in which focal objects and background can be distinguished yield
differential results. “Americans fixated more on focal objects than did the Chinese, and the
Americans tended to look at the focal object more quickly. In addition, the Chinese made more
saccades to the background than did the Americans” (Chua, Boland, and Nisbett 2005, 12629).
Another study by Masuda and Nisbett (2001) presented American and Japanese subjects with a
drawing of an aquarium, which included focal objects (mainly fish) and background objects (a
section of ground and water bubbles). As reported by Winerman, “Americans were more likely
to begin by recalling the focal fish, while Japanese were more likely to describe the whole scene,
saying something like "it was a lake or pond." Later, the Japanese participants also recalled
more details about the background objects than the Americans did” (Winerman 2006; Masuda
and Nisbett 2001; See also Watters 2013). What these scientific studies show is that basic
aspects of visual experience can be culturally constituted, and can’t hence be assumed to be
universal: “eye movements can differ as a function of culture” (Chua, Boland, and Nisbett 2005,
12631).
Thus, the subject plays a role in the specific thematization of objects and events she faces—
whether in observing a copper bowl it is the entire bowl that is the object of perception, or
rather parts of it, or even the scene in which the bowl is placed (Husserl 1973, 117). Not only
the singling out of objects and events is the product of a position-taking of the subject; both the
span in which attention is paid to things, and the specific interaction between perception and
action are also influenced by the positioning of the subject vis-à-vis aspects of reality. Chua et al.
conclude also that “Easterners and Westerners allocated attentional resources differently as
98
they viewed the scenes” (2005, 12631). Well-known change-blindness cases well illustrate that
perception is not about the passive receiving of ‘the way the world is,’ but is rather a take on the
way the world is. As a matter of fact, one thing in common to the experiments I just reviewed
and to the view that links perception and attention is that they entail the falsity of the claim that
perception is a one-one reproduction of sensory impulses.39
Further, in Husserl’s view, we perceive unities (objects, events, states of affairs) and not
isolated properties of mere bundles of them. Oftentimes, though, unities are perceived as also
having other aspects or properties of different sorts (importantly parts), which allows for
switching of attention between aspects (Husserl 1997, 28–30, <33–36>; Husserl 2001b, 116–
119).40 For Husserl, unities are not simply grasped, but rather 'posited,' that is, objectivated or
individualized in the very grasping of them. It is not that we create the unities that we perceive.
Rather, in our perceiving determinate unities, we are active in focusing on such unities: “The
activity of perception, the perceptive orientation toward particular objects […] is already an
active performance of the ego” (1973, 71–72).41
39 Cognitive anthropology research is a burgeoning area of research in which evidence for the pragmatic-dependence of perception can be found, but only after such research is subject to critical analysis. Part of this research program focuses on inference-based reasoning in decision-making contexts, and on categorization and conceptualization between different communities shows such cognitive processes vary across cultures, depending on a variety of factors (See Atran et al. 2002; Atran, Medin, and Ross 2005). These researchers mostly work within theoretical frameworks of modularized minds with impenetrable perceptual modules (Medin and Atran 2004, 963). However, the findings of their research, when subject to a careful conceptual analysis partly using the view of perception I have been putting forth, would instead imply that perception does not only feed cognitive processes but that such cognitive processes influence perception. Upon careful analysis, it seems difficult to hold that communities that are more aware of ecological relations between living beings are only conceptually and inferentially aware, and not that part of their awareness has to do with a perceptual sensitivity, perhaps similar to the structure of vision of East Asians and Japanese people I reviewed above. As Bang et al. note “Recent research, however, shows that content and process cannot be neatly segregated, because cultural differences in what people think affect how people think. To achieve a deeper understanding of the relation between process and content, research must integrate the methodological insights from both anthropology and psychology” (Bang, Medin, and Atran 2007, 13868). A somewhat close reading shows that their research is not only about what we think, but about what we deal with, that is, with pragmatic objects in which perception occupies a central role. And, in fact, philosophy can also contribute to such deeper understanding. 40 Affordances, that is, opportunities or impediments for action afforded by the object-in-context to the individual, are also part of these perceived unities. They will be treated in terms of content in the next chapter. I urge the reader to not yield to the temptation to equal the talk of unities or objects with talk of content. A clear construction of the idea of content requires a different strategy that I do not employ yet. 41 One last piece of evidence for the pragmatic dependence of perception on research on what’s called the cognitive penetrability of perception, namely, that perceptual experience is can be affected by other cognitive, extra-perceptual aspects of the actions one is involved in. For a related discussion see (Deroy 2012). A recently published study, Rituals Enhance Consumption, found that participants that engaged in “ritualized behavior” regarding consumption of chocolate, experienced chocolate much more positively than those that didn’t engage in such behavior (Vohs et al.
99
Think of a tree. Looking at the tree as a whole or focusing on one branch of it is not a
process that depends exclusively on the nature of an external reality—as if to one scene only
one perception could belong. Rather, the grasping of the tree, or of a branch of it (or even of the
landscape of which the tree is a part) is an accomplishment of perception, which is properly
described as a ‘positing’ or establishing of unities (Husserl 1983, 278–282, <241–245>).42 To
put it in terms of appearances, each of these cases is about taking in one or another of the many
ways in which the tree appears. And this is, I have been urging, entirely direct and realist. The
tree is just as real as the branch. Perceiving on one or the other, or switching between them is
clearly our doing, but is not an invention—it is a take on reality. Lastly, as I have been arguing
in this section, this focusing on different aspects that are perceived as unities is dependent on the
pragmatic level. The possibilities for attentional and actional changes over time (in the
temporally extended perceptual nexus we have been focusing on, instead of snapshot perceptual
instants) are also pragmatically delineated depending on what I want to do with something,
even if I just want to contemplate an object.43
SEP holds that the right account of perceptual content must accurately reflect the
complexity of our perceptual experience, their dynamism, and their objects’ nature. We also
want a theory of content that helps us understand how all these elements hang together, from
basic sensory contacts in with the world to higher-level perceptions—chapters 3, 4, and 5 will
deal with these desiderata. Thus, on the basis of this account of perceptual experience, I now
turn to the relation between experience and content. In the following chapter, I will look at how
a conception of experience entails requirements and desiderata for a theory of content. I will
2013, 1714). In this case, researchers highlight that ritualized behavior increases engagement in the action, hence causing a heightened, and more pleasant, perceptual experience. 42 For Husserl, any intentional act whatever “even emotional and volitional acts—are objectivating, constituting objects originally [and are thus] necessary sources of different regions of being [Seinsregionen] and (with them) their belonging ontologies” (1983, 282, <242>). Perception is one instantiation of this ‘archontic’ character of intentional acts. 43 In chapters 4 and 5, I will have occasion to flesh out this idea. Specifically, I will show how focusing on certain objects in specific ways is intrinsically structured in terms of content, both self-referentially and in relation to other relevant aspects of the environment. This means that internal and external horizons of possible fulfillments are already at work in the objects we perceive, such that they determine the possibilities and impossibilities of perceptual nexuses (See 1973, 103–106, 122; Husserl 1970, 165; Husserl 1983, 322–23, <279>; Drummond 1990, 150–151).
100
analyze the representationalist take on that connection and will articulate the way the Social
Enactive View deals with that problem.
Chapter III
Perceptual Experience and Perceptual Content
An important difficulty for theories of perceptual content issues from the multiplicity of
discussions in which perceptual content is invoked, dealt with, used for or against. It has a place
in theories about the nature of perception and perceptual experience (Husserl 2001b; Husserl
1983; Merleau-Ponty 2002; Snowdon 1992; Logue 2012; Schellenberg Forthcoming), the
relation between perception and action (Hurley 1998; Noë 2004; Hutto and Myin 2013;
Schellenberg 2007; Thompson 2009), the relation between perception and environment (Gibson
1979; Almäng 2008; Heidegger 2010; Hurley 1998), in discussion about the use and need (or
lack thereof) of concepts in perception (Tye 2005; Bermúdez 2007; Toribio 2007), and,
prominently, in discussions about the connection between perceptions and epistemological
justification, that is, about the specific justificatory role perceptions ought to have in regards to
belief and action, mostly in conceptualist frameworks (McDowell 1994; Peacocke 1992; Hopp
2011; Brewer 2005; Schellenberg 2011). This diversity seems to pull the concept in every
direction, making it difficult to offer a comprehensive, stable account of it.
Let’s start off with a common (but useless) definition of content: perceptual content is what is
contained in the perceptual act. This is far from clear, for, what would it mean for the objects of
perception to be contained in such container? If what is at stake, as I have been arguing, is the
general question of what perception is about, i.e. it is not clear what and how should be contained
in the mind, and not at all clear that, as to their content (not to mention others aspects),
perception’s contents are common factors with other mental states such as beliefs or
hallucinations. If perception is about the direct acquaintance with sequences and transitions, and
not just with static objects, how would exactly the container metaphor work? Does the mind
contain the world? Or is it perhaps a replica?
102
I propose that instead we begin with a minimal idea linking content with aboutness:
content is that which the perceptual experience is about—the what of the perceptual aboutness
relation.1 We start with perceptual experience as I have described in the previous chapter.
The previous chapter’ account of perceptual experience makes some headway in treating
the problem of content. Perceptual experience, I argued, is not an inner occurrence, product of
external interaction, although it is ‘accompanied’ and partly characterized by the phenomenal
character or ‘what-it-is-like’ of a thing perceived. Perceptual experience is of spatial and
temporal extended occurrences in the world—objects, events, and states of affairs, each of which
I referred to as perceptual continua. I argued too that each of these continua can be understood
as “a chain of resting perceptions, unified by transitional phenomena, in which various sides and
parts of the thing present themselves in a stable way” (1997, 83, 76, <98,89>).2 I have proposed
to understand these “sides and parts” of things according to the basic insight that, in perception,
perceivers are presented with aspects or appearances (perspectives or profiles) of real objects;
such appearances being the way in which physical occurrences are presented, and can only be
presented, in perception. Physical occurrences—material objects but also smells—cannot be
experienced by perceivers but in perspectival sequences: not even a God, Husserl has said,
would perceive material objects in their fullness (and unless God enjoyed an embodied existence
it would not perceive at all) (Pietersma 2000, 62); the idea of a full, immediate, total grasp of a
spatiotemporal event is a misleading fiction. Lastly, I argued that the aspects we perceive in
things are dependent on interaction with perceivers—they are relational properties; perceivers
are situated over against things not only temporally and spatially but also pragmatically.
The account I propose conceives of content as constituted by, and methodologically derived
from, perceptual experience. Experience is the actuality of the aboutness of mind of minded 1 I follow Husserl in the basic definition of intentionality that puts it at the core of our mental life—which is not the same as “inner” life. “Every conscious process is, in itself, consciousness of such and such […] intentionality signifies nothing else than this universal fundamental property of consciousness: to be consciousness of something” (Husserl 1999, 33, <71–71>, emphasis is Husserl’s; See also Husserl 1983, 73, <64>). Although Brentano can be credited with bringing the notion of intentionality into philosophical psychology, I follow, though critically, Husserl’s treatment of it. Husserl was a student of Brentano. 2 A full qualification of the sense in which the perceptual objects is a sequence or a continuum (already mentioned in chapter 2) is presented in chapter 4, section 1.
103
beings and content is a type of specification of aboutness, thus, content is constituted by the
actual experience of things. For SEP, content is partly constituted by, not just supervenes on,
perceptual experience. 3
I will thus start clean of a commitment to perceptual contents as inner structures. This can
be called a version of intentionalism without representationalism. It could also be referred to as
a type of externalist relationalism that conceives of relations as practical engagements, as
interactions, instead of the more general relation. In particular, it is a type of externalism as to the
contents of intentions that could be called interactive externalism. I prefer, however, the
denomination enactivism, because of the explicit emphasis on the active aspect of perception and
its positioning in contrast to the orthodoxy in philosophy of mind. Because of the constitutive
role I assign to intersubjectivity at multiple levels of analysis (practices, experiences, properties,
and contents), the appropriate label is social enactivism (that would be a social interactive
externalism).
In this chapter, I develop an account of the constitutive relation between experience and
content. Whatever roles content may play in relation to a theory of perception overall—to the
relation between perception and action and behavior, to the role of the environment, to the need
for concepts, or to epistemological justification—it depends on what perceptual experience is.
While in this chapter I will talk some more about experience and will start discussing content in
particular, but my focus is on the relation between these two concepts.
I situate my positive account over against representationalism, the main and longest-
standing line of thought in the literature. This view keeps mind and world separate, mind inner,
and perception mostly a matter of a detached acquaintance of a mind with a world, in which
reason is called to sort out the contingent results of perception. These elements resonate at the
level of perceptual content in the shape of an intellectualistic concern for ‘veridicality’ that
operates in the distinction inner/outer, in the role of reason, inference and judgment in
3 It is worth noting already that on this view, the objects of perception are also contents, pace (Hopp 2011), but not every aspect, part or property that counts as content is an object.
104
perception, and in the extension of linguistic analysis of content to analysis of perceptual
content.
I take Chalmers (2006) to be a representative example of standard theories of perception.
The way of thinking he represents takes the notion of veridicality (roughly understood as
correspondence) to be central to perceptual experience and to perceptual content. I attempt to
reveal how this concern for veridicality synthesizes a wrong way of addressing perception.
Continuing the line of thinking I began to craft in chapter 2, I will offer further arguments
against the supposed epistemological incompatibility between the reality of perceptual objects
and the multiplicity of their appearances on which the central concern for veridicality depends.
As I will show in chapter 5, SEP has a proposal to offer regarding the narrow concern for
veridicality of representational theories. Normativity in SEP is not about confirming whether
our perceptions correspond to the world but about the placement of perceptual things in the
system of possibilities and expectations that I first presented in chapter 1. This account is not
intra-perceptual but rather pragmatically nested, and sensitive to intra-modal and multi-modal
relations.
This conception of the relation between experience and content furnishes one more element
for the social enactive theory of perception I am building—a conception of perception that feels
at home in the actual world. SEP is a theory that finds our contact with the world neither
mysterious nor deficient, as Chalmers does, and thus need not resort to extra-perceptual inferences
from appearances to reality in order to get by, or to hypothetical perfect worlds to understand
the intrinsic consistency of the world.4
4 This social enactive account of perception aims at dealing with not only technical aspects of the philosophy of perception but with key epistemological issues regarding the relation between mind and world—it is not only about the details of our perceptual engagement with stuff in the world, but also about the way in which our perceptual engagement with the world constitutes the basis of our knowing, full stop, and of our knowing the world. In this way, I express the belief that a philosopher’s theory of perception certainly marks her epistemology. This is undoubtedly the case in Husserl, and in Merleau-Ponty as well, who have been a great influence on the account I offer. The social enactive view of experience I am arguing for is sympathetic to realist (naïve and direct), relationalist, and disjunctivist views of perception (Sellars (2000), McDowell (1994), Cussins (1992), Snowdon (1992; 2008), Martin and Campbell (2002), among others).
105
3.1. The Relation between Perceptual Experience and Perceptual Content
Experience constitutes itself the ground on which perceivers are able to be in perceptual relation
with the world, and which explains the diverse connections between world and subjects in terms
of perception, action, and thought. The dependent relation between experience and content also
justifies my constant looking at experience in order to derive insights about content. Experience
determines the content of our perceptions, both thematically and phenomenally. It is not
possible to talk about perceptual content without deriving it from the specificity of perception as
experienced.
It is hard to overestimate what is entailed by the conception of experience as interaction I
am offering and its relation to content, for it stands in a diametric contrast with standard
theories of perception. It is an extended view among philosophers, both classical modern and
contemporary, that experience in general —not just perceptual—is an inner occurrence
endowed with content. Content is thought of as abstractly detachable from the experience,
propositional in structure (even if not always conceptual (See e.g. Tye 2005)), and accompanied
by (perhaps sometimes constituted by) a certain what-it-is-like to be in such state, what-it-is-
like to possess such content (possessing such content being determined by being in such state).
The experiences themselves are mental, inner states—to experience something is to be in a
mental state—, and the contents themselves are abstract entities—propositions—essentially
modeled after the manner of beliefs, indicated in that-clauses. Because of their propositional
nature, contents are in a way common currency for different types of mental states. On this
view, experiences of different kinds are (at least partly) individuated according to their contents,
and perceptions, memories, or desires may have common content.
In representationalist views about perception, to perceive an object is thought to be having
an inner experience that is caused in a sensory appropriate way by the object perceived. The
perceptual experience itself is a mental state with content, composed of representational and
phenomenal aspects. Representational content represents the world to be a certain way; and
106
some take it that the phenomenal content is representational content that is determined by
phenomenal character (Chalmers 2006, 50–51). Content is a “condition of satisfaction of the
experience,” and philosophers hold different opinions about the details of these contents: they
feature objects and properties (Russellian content) or modes of presentation of objects and of
properties (Fregean content), or mixes thereof. The content is a ‘condition of satisfaction’ in that
it can render the experience veridical, in case it corresponds to the world, or non-veridical, if it
doesn’t. In other words, contents are partly derived from their inferential role in the life of a
rational subject (See Chalmers 2006, 100). A perceiver is guided, on this view, by rational
patterns of judgment about what they seem to perceive.
The representationalist view requires a greater analysis, to which I now turn. I will use
Chalmers’ Perception and the Fall from Eden as a foil. I do find Chalmers’s account of content to
be profoundly illuminating in a number of ways—albeit illuminating in virtue of the ways in
which it is wrong. I can anticipate two reasons why I chose Chalmers. The first one is that,
while he tries to sort out different representational views, he is still committed to the general
tenets of representationalism. The second reason is that he does not simply assume the truth of
such a view (which he does). He also tries to account for its main features, by mean of the
rhetorical strategy of a myth. In my view, this mythologizing strategy allows us to lay bare the
ideal character of representationalism about perception, especially as seen in the concern for
veridicality.5
3.2 The Polemics with Chalmers: Visiting the Garden of Eden for The First Time
I am going to be using Chalmers’s account as a foil, thus, let’s state in a few lines the main
theses of his account of perceptual content (2006). Chalmers’s position is that the content of
perception is a propositionally structured content, satisfying two central desiderata, namely,
veridicality and presentational phenomenal character. Following these two desiderata, Chalmers
5 In this sense SEP is a non-ideal theory of perception since it does not idealize its objects, or its modes of exploration, or its goals. The engagement with Augustine in the analysis of the materiality of the perceptual object done in chapter 2 also has the purposes of showing this contrast between ideality and non-ideality.
107
concludes that content should be understood as a combination of Fregean content and of Edenic
content. Edenic content (featuring perfect instantiation of ideal perfect properties) deals with
the phenomenological adequacy desideratum, or presentational desideratum, that is, with the idea that
perceptual content must account for the presentational sense in which objects and properties
look to us.6 Edenic content carries the idea of perfect veridicality: an experience is perfectly
veridical when it instantiates a perfect property in a perfect world: “The perfect veridicality of
color experience would require that our world is an Edenic world, in which objects instantiate
primitive color properties” (2006, 69). Fregean content (featuring ways of presentation of
objects and properties) deals with the veridicality desideratum, that is, with content being a
condition of experience, such that the experience is veridical iff the world turns out to be the
way perceptual experience (re)presents it to be. Fregean content veridicality, though, is
imperfect veridicality: “it is plausible that imperfect veridicality is the property that our ordinary
term ‘veridicality’ denotes. We speak truly when we say that a phenomenally red experience of
an ordinary red object is veridical. It is just that the experience is not perfectly veridical” (2006,
70). The idea is that the veridical aspect of an experience is determined by content that needs
only to match perfect properties, that is, “to play the role that perfect redness [properties] plays
in Eden” which is to normally bring about red (property-specific) experiences (2006, 72). The
content of the veridicality desideratum is an (imperfect) veridicality derivative of a true
veridicality, which is captured Edenic content captures. On Chalmers’s view, only one type of
content is unable to explain both salient aspects of perceptual content, so we need to be
‘pluralists’ about content. Chalmers’s investigation, to be sure, centers on visual perception, with
a special focus on color perception. Despite this narrow focus, he contends that this model can,
without substantial modifications, be extended to all other perceptual modalities.
6 Chalmers rules out Russellian content (featuring objects and properties) as phenomenal content, on the grounds that it would treat identical phenomenal experiences as having different contents, that is, there would be, for instance, “no Russellian content that is shared by all phenomenally red experiences” (2006, 57), which seems to Chalmers an intuitive must-have of phenomenal content. Edenic content though would be a pseudo-Russellian content that takes perfect properties as the properties it is associated with. Siegel (2011a, 29–30) reads Chalmers’s Edenic content plainly as another type of Russellian content.
108
But what exactly, and how, is wrong with the view that I take him to represent? And why
is it incompatible with the view I propose? I want to explore some fundamental aspects of the
standard way of looking at perceptual experience and perceptual content, which I find quite
clearly exhibited in Chalmers.
Chalmers articulates his position through a myth of a perceptual Eden. Chalmers thinks
this myth helps us make sense of our perceptual situation, by understanding ourselves as being
engaged in a perceptually deficient manner with the world. Chalmers says that our perceptual
predicament is that of beings that were once in a Garden of Eden, directly perceiving object of
the world and perfect properties. We were acquainted with objects directly, and directly
perceived “gloriously, perfectly, and primitively” their perfect properties, the roundness and
redness of round, red apples. “Objects were presented to us without causal mediation, and
properties were revealed to us in their true intrinsic glory” (Chalmers 2006, 49. Emphasis mine).
Then we ate the fruits of two trees, the tree of illusion and the tree of science.7
We ate of the Tree of Illusion. After that, objects and their properties, which before
appeared as they were, now appeared with “different colors and shapes at different times.”
Perspectival differences in shapes or loudness of sounds, for instance, are to be sure a product of
our eating of this tree. After this change “we could no longer accept that visual experience
always revealed the world exactly as it is” (Chalmers 2006, 49).
We ate of the Tree of Science. After that, direct perception was not possible anymore, for
there was a “long causal chain,” from the microphysical structure of objects responsible for the
physical occurrences that affect our sensory endings, through a medium (e.g. air for sound or for
light on earth), to the anatomical and physiological structure on our part that ‘mediates’ the
7 Carefully observed these are the two strategies belonging to the well-known argument from illusion, called the phenomenological argument (corresponding to Chalmers’s tree of Illusion) and the causal argument (corresponding to Chalmers’s tree of Science), with which H.H. Price objects to naïve realism, in his classic Perception (1950). It is notable as well that while sense-data theory has long been discredited, the two varieties of arguments that were there actually heavily argued for, are now presented in this mythical way that requires of no justification. On the argument from illusion see (Price 1950 ch. 2; see also Ayer 1947 esp. ch. 1). For a contemporaneous critique to that view see (Austin 1962). As a matter of fact, the natural opposition between the argument from illusion and naïve realism in which Price frames his theory mirrors very closely in the contemporary discussion, for instance, in Chalmers and in Siegel (Siegel 2010, 28–29).
109
nerve stimulations ‘before’ we ‘experience’ the ‘qualities’ of objects and their properties. These
facts make the connection between our ‘experience’ and objects merely contingent, and motivate
the reasoning according to which “there was [is] no good reason to believe that objects in the
world had [have] these properties at all” (2006, 50)
The upshot of the narrative is that tree-eating gives us reasons to be worried about the
veridicality of our perceptions but still gives a sense to what it is like to perceive. Edenic pre-
tree-eating states provide notwithstanding philosophical substance to what we should rationally
expect from the contents of perception, as well as an account of the feeling that we have when
we perceive: they should satisfy a presentational and a veridicality desiderata. Eden is the
standard for both desiderata. Perception of the perfection of objects and properties gives content
to the idea that there is something like a veridical perceiving of things (of which our illusions
are but defects)—a veridicality desideratum; and the perfect, non-causal type of acquaintance with
objects in Eden gives content to the idea that in perception things are directly presented to us—
a presentational desideratum. Chalmers’s account will be a two-stage one: “experiences have two
layers of content, an Edenic content that reflects their phenomenology and a Fregean content
that determines their veridicality” (2006, 93).
Chalmers’s rationale connects ideality and veridicality and is specified in his case in terms
of both the presentational and the veridicality desiderata depending on the ideal of Eden. This
ideal presentation is as a matter of fact derived from the actual presentation of the world, but
idealized and then turned back against the real world and the perception of it, which are then
both labeled as lacking. Chalmers’s characterization the situation of perception is erroneous and
his use of this myth makes it easier for us to see how and why this philosophical outlook is
basically at odds with perception, both conceptually and in the everyday workings of perception.
If my argument is sound is should serve as a rejection of Fregean accounts of content, first,
but also of other specification of content, i.e. Russellian, that operates on the idea of a
veridicality desideratum. The reason is that I not only attack the specification of content but
110
mainly its original epistemological motivation. While Chalmers’s attempt at accommodating the
presentational character of experience is far better than Fregean-content-only accounts it is still
dependent on a conception of perfection with an epistemological aim, in the sense of a narrow
concern for things telling the truth. Thus, my objections are fundamentally against views that
articulate perception as lacking in relation to an ideal perception, perfect acquaintance with
objects or properties, or truthful knowledge of things. Most representational theories are of this
kind and so my objections extend to them.
3.3 Eating from The Tree of Science and The Presentational Desideratum
According to Chalmers, the presentational character of a perception, namely, that objects and
properties of objects appear as if they were presented to us “directly and immediately” must be
accounted for in a theory of content (2006, 65). This entails that we perceive things as if they
were in Eden: “the phenomenology of visual experience is the same in our world and in Eden”
(2006, 98). Lastly, in this ideal place, “visual experience presents a world where perfect redness
and perfect blueness are instantiated on the surface of objects, as they were in Eden” (2006, 66).
The seeming clarity in Chalmers’ claim that perception in Eden was direct masks a deep
confusion. Austin has rightfully noted that ‘directly’ is “one of the less conspicuous snakes in the
linguistic grass” (15). According to Austin, ‘directly’ only operates in contrast with ‘indirectly,’
both at home in the visual perception case. In vision, indirectly would mean, for instance, seeing
something with a periscope or a mirror. If this is the case, then the confusion is easily dispelled:
we are directly looking at the reflection and ‘indirectly’ only signals a certain strangeness about
the situation. Or it can be an extreme case we may not be perceiving at all as with the case of
someone that ‘hears indirectly’ could only be the case of that person being told something
(Austin 1962, 15–19).
Chalmers define directness first, and he does in reference to an ideal world: as lack of
mediation and as contact with perfect properties—which would allow for “appearance of directness,”
111
which we witness. In the analysis I am about to provide, I will argue that such a notion is
empty, because there is nothing that can back it up—it is the typical type of rationalistic notion
to which Berkeley’s Hylas would object. I will also show that the characterization of directness
in Chalmers’ terms is only compatible with the metaphysics of gardens of Eden, but not with the
structure of the material world as we know it.
In contrast, SEP begins with the phenomenological idea that for something to be direct is
to be experienced. Or as Husserl puts it: “Experience in the first and most pregnant sense is
[…] defined as a direct relation to the individual” (1973, 27), where relation is not simply an
inner occurrence. Although the burden of the proof is in the view that insists on indirectness, I
will show that the constraints Chalmers’ imposes on “directness” do not make sense in relation
to the sensory-based interaction between perceivers and world that we call perception. In
keeping with the theory of appearances I have been developing, we will be able to see that actual
perception is nothing but direct.
The burden of the proof lies in those that deny directness, for surely in their objection, to
borrow Austin expression, “perceiving indirectly wears the trousers” (Austin 1962, 15). So, can
Chalmers make a plausible positive case for what he thinks is real perceptual directness? Thus,
These are two points mixed up in Chalmers’s notion of the presentational desideratum and the
fruit of the tree of science, namely: one point (A) is about the idea that to directly perceive objects
and properties is incompatible with any form of mediation, and the second (B) is about a (confused)
notion of an ideal of the perception of objects and properties, embodied in the idea that to directly
perceive objects and properties is to perceive perfect properties, and that to actually perceive objects and
properties is to be understood in contrast to that ideal.
I start with the first point (A), namely, that directness is incompatible with mediation. The
rationale is that direct perception is not possible after the fall, for there is now a “long causal
chain” from the microphysical structure in objects responsible for the physical occurrences that
affect our sensory endings, through a medium (e.g. air for sound or for light on earth), to the
112
anatomical and physiological structure on our part that ‘mediates’ the nerve stimulations
‘before’ we ‘experience’ the ‘qualities’ of objects and their properties, to the actual experience of
those qualities. This is, in other words, that microphysical structure is not transparent, as it
were, and needs a decoding or deciphering, an anatomical and physiological structure on our
part that ‘mediates’ the nerve stimulations ‘before’ we ‘experience’ the ‘qualities’ of objects and
their properties, and a processing that underlies out actually perceiving.
In order to conclude from the existence of the causal chain that direct perception is not the
case for perception, Chalmers needs to have in mind something that does count as direct,
immediate perception, i.e. that which was the case in Eden. Roughly, it has to be something like
this: perception is the revelation to a subject of objects and objects’ intrinsic properties. These
objects and properties must be some non-reducible properties on the part of the object—let’s
call it a one-dimensional-property—that coupled with a one-dimensional-property-feeler (on the
part of the subject), ‘excitable’ in an all-or-nothing way by the presence, period (no intensities or
thresholds allowed), of the one-dimensional property. Such ‘excitation’ itself constitutes the
revelation-like acquaintance that Chalmers wants to refer to as direct, immediate perception in
Eden.
I object to the first point with two arguments: the first one (i) is about what it is to perceive
physical, spatiotemporally characterized realities—a more exclusively metaphysical argument,
although not exempt from epistemological implications—, and the second one (ii) is about the
phenomenal aspect of perception—also metaphysical but with more evident epistemological
implications.
My first argument (i) is about the most basic structure of this particular type of active
engagement with things in the world that we call perception. What idea of one-dimensional
property and its relative ‘feeler’ Chalmers had in mind? This notion may be found in something
as basic as the repulsive force of a negative and a positive electrically charged particles, one of
them taking the hypothetical place of the property and the other of the feeler, and their
113
perceptual interaction being simply the reacting to each other unqualifiedly in virtue of nothing
else than their nature, no process mediating, where the feeler is not only excited but where
there’s something that it is like to feel that property. Does this model apply somehow to
perception?
The closer we can get to such a revelation-like acquaintance with things would be
something defined as a case of one-dimensional signaling. Let’s consider the case of a tick,
studied by von Uexküll and reported by Clark, “which is sensitive to butyric acid found in the
mammalian skin. Butyric acid, when detected, induces the tick to lose its hold on a branch and to
fall on the animal” (Clark 1998, 24). While it is fairly clear that the tick is not able to entertain a
phenomenal experience so that we are actually witnessing mere behavioral response, let’s
imagine for a moment that there is something for the tick that it is like to detect, to perceive,
butyric acid. Details aside, Chalmers’s argument is that by definition not even this supposed
one-to-one matching of acid and detection can amount to direct perception because butyric acid
has a chemical composition (in this case micro-chemical, not microphysical, structure) and
certainly the tick possesses a detector-reactor system, a system that biochemically processes or
interprets the impulse at stake.
First, I just don’t see an argument for the presence of a structure or composition in both
objects of perception and the perceiver as a requirement on direct perception. If one understands
the world as perceivable in virtue of being a material world made of physicochemical stuff—as I
think we should conceive of it—, and observes that some living beings take heed of that world
in the manner that we call perception, which is precisely their being able to take up such
physicochemical reality, in ways that are idiosyncratic to them and indescribable outside the
perceiving relation, then we can only say that the perceivers’ experiences are constituted by both
object and subject sides and are the only possible way of defining what it is like to perceive
something. And this is the case because there are conceptual reasons to suppose, for instance,
that the stuff that we humans perceive as colors is not necessarily something that must be
114
perceived visually by every perceiver able to discriminate or react to that specific range of the
electromagnetic spectrum. By the same token, in the case of visual perceivers I see no obstacle
to the effect that two subjects, or communities, will experience, for instance, the same physical
reality in different ways. Inverted spectrum scenarios pose no problem to my view, as I hold
that perceiving a certain property is not only a matter of the physical existence of the thing but
about the interaction between perceiver and thing, provided a constitution is present on both
sides. Additional considerations of intersubjective coherence and consistency in ranges of
properties (in the case of systematic inversion) still at work in inverted communities (which I
have no space to touch upon here), rule out plain exceptional misperceptions. And yet, only a
full view of the way I conceive of the domain of normativity in perception as opposed to the
narrow concern for veridicality, which shall wait until the next chapter, will allow me to offer a
positive account of ‘misperceptions.’ These considerations should suffice for the moment to
explain my position regarding inverted spectrum-like worries.
And yet, for those perceivers equipped like humans in regards to this range of the
spectrum, to perceive frequencies within that range means to see them: seeing not having other
definition than that which is felt or perceived when we use our visual system and direct it, in the
broader context of our perceived world, to what is usable under it, that is, to reflected light, to
visibilia8—a domain physically described as a range of frequencies of electromagnetic radiation,
all of which is not visible; and some of which could be, for other living perceivers, perceivable in
manners that would be impossible for us to feel or describe.
Chalmers may object that I have not refuted the idea that the perceptual causal chain
forbids directness, which rests on a description of such causal chain that goes like this: emission
of physical events that would count as stimuli precedes their transmission through a medium,
which is prior to the arrival of such stimuli to sensory receptors, and the excitation of sensory
receptors is temporally previous to processing in the brain and its final perceptual output (which
8 For a view along these basic conceptual lines see (Aristotle 2001, 100 (418a25-418a30)).
115
may in itself feature a certain temporal sequence, say between centers processing the sensory
modal-specific information and centers enabling the awareness of such information in sensory-
specific manner). My answer to this is that, first, arguing that pre-neural temporal sequence
amounts to lack of directness is question-begging, for it is like saying that I don’t directly see
the paper in front of me because the light takes time, however infinitesimal, from its surface to
my retina, or that I don’t directly smell the freshly-baked bread in the bakery because smell is
transmitted through the air. Whatever the details we find in these pictures of perceptual contact
with the world, situations like those just described are what we in the first place call direct. This
physical aspect of the perception of things in the world is not what is philosophically relevant as
to the directness (or lack thereof) of perception. Mediation is not a sufficient condition for the
denial of directness, insofar as the presence of a medium for light or sound cannot be interpreted
in any important sense as preventing directness.
Further, there is a more significant answer, one dealing with the neurological aspect of it.
My answer to the possible objection that causality finds support in object temporality—that
there is a percept that is the end-product of a chain of events preceding it--is that while there is
an objective time dimension involved in the neurological processing that is a necessary
condition for perception to occur, this means neither that the temporality of perceptual
experience is that of objective time (so that the ‘final product’ is to be taken as ‘final’), nor that
objective time sequences of neural events somehow proves that experience is an inner event, in
this case identified with a brain event (so that we can speak of one perception finishing with a
mental event, i.e. a mental image, conceptually isolated from the next ‘perception’ or image). To
deny the identification between experience and brain event is not to deny that the brain event is
a necessary condition of having a perceptual experience.
For one, the point is definitional: that there is a set of neural events necessary for a complex
perceiver to have perceptual experience is not identical with saying that having a perceptual
experience is to be in one of those neurological states. As the discussion in chapter 5 about a
116
possible common factor between hallucinations and perception will make clear, perception
cannot be defined independently of the environment, and so, brain processes are rather “a kind
of complex adjustment that the brain has to undergo, in each context, in order that you can be
visually related to the things around you; so that you can see them, in other words” (Campbell
2002, 119, 131). To perceive, then, is not to be in a certain mental but to be perceptually related
to the environment, which brain activity partly enables a perceiver to do.
The point is not to deny that there is a causal aspect to perception. What I deny is the
characterization of this causal aspect as a sequence that starts with objects emitting impulses
and finishes with a mental, inner event identified with the experience of the property associated
with the objective impulse, that is, a representation in the classical sense. The causal aspect of
perception includes physical configuration on the part of the object as well as physical
configuration on the part of the perceiver, but this causal aspect—not perception itself—is a
confluence of causal-sensitive aspects rather than a matter of a linear chain ending with a mental
event.
A proper understanding of the causal aspect involved in perception does, in fact, contribute
to undermining the claim that there is a conceivable ideal of perception in contrast to which
perception involving a causal aspect is deficient, indirect, or otherwise distorting. Further, the
causal aspect is only necessary but not sufficient, for concrete perceptual experience requires
grounding in terms of the unity of consciousness that is necessitated by the idea of experience
itself, which we may call perceptual consciousness, and this consciousness is not to be found in
the causal sequence we’ve been discussing. These causal events enable perception to take place,
but what they enable is not a representation but a direct relation with object, events, or states of
affairs. Such relation or engagement, which we refer to as experience and that as such entails an
underlying structure of experiential consciousness, is what perception consists in.
This connection between experience and consciousness is supported when we look at the
issue from the point of view of the temporality of experience, that is, to the temporal structure
117
belonging to our consciousness of our experience. The main contention here, as it pertains to
our topic, is that the temporal structure of experience is not the objective temporality of linear,
sequential “punctual or instantaneous nows” (Thompson 2009, 318; See also Gallagher and
Zahavi 2008). In other words, the idea of a subject able to engage with the world in perceptual
experience requires a temporality that is not that of objective time. The issue of perceptual
consciousness temporality would be a matter of an entire book, so I will limit myself to outline a
couple of relevant considerations.9
As I have argued in the previous chapter, perception does not occur in static isolation, but
in enactive dynamic sequences of perceptual continua: to perceive an object is not to entertain
isolated snapshots (which in itself would not either speak necessarily in favor of inner
representations as their end-product) but a continuously perceiving oneself the same object over
time, either as one simply observes it (which in this view is still active) or as one more actively
interacts with it (Gallagher 2005, 173–205). This continuity is mutually implied with a
9 Kant’s Transcendental Deduction is an obliged reference in this issue, namely, the issue of the unity of consciousness that makes possible our cognition of objects—the transcendental unity of apperception—, and the question of whether such unity can be presupposed as existing independently from the activity of the understanding in which it is involved, or it only becomes the unity it is when it takes in such activity, or whether its structure features both aspects. Husserl, and specifically his philosophy of perception, makes the relationship between consciousness and experience a central concern of its philosophical project. Particularly, his “Lectures on Thing and Space”, the Studies on Constitution (partly of the subject), the analyses on active and passive synthesis and on the consciousness of internal time exhibit a careful treatment of the way in which an account of the idea of a consciousness is correlative with, and necessary to, an account of the idea of experience and its associated notion of meaning. It is worth also mentioning that this type of inquiry into the very possibility of knowledge of the world is for Husserl tried to a critique of reason. The issue appears as well in more contemporary literature such as (Hurley 1998, esp. Ch.2,3, and 6; Gallagher 2005, esp. Ch. 8; Gallagher and Zahavi 2008; Thompson 2007, Ch. 9 and 11). I agree with Hurley that working through issues of consciousness in relation to perception and action can actually challenge the traditional distinctions inner/outer or mind/word, perception/action, input/output that leave us estranged from the world, incessantly puzzled by perception. This agreement reappears here and there in my work and partly motivates the social enactivism of the theory of perception I am putting forward.
While the topic of the unity of consciousness and perceptual consciousness calls for an extensive treatment, I would like at least to insists that a careful treatment of the problems of perception cannot afford to pay no attention to it, and that, contrary to this, a good deal of contemporary philosophizing on perception is wrongly comfortable in dealing with perception and its conceptual associates (experience, content) somehow oblivious to the deep philosophical significance of the problems surrounding our being perceptually conscious of a world. Without this sensitivity, the ingrained tendencies of thought of Modern and Contemporary philosophy that I have arguing against, find support in popular scientific understandings of physical properties and brains, and unquestioned assumptions about what is conceivable and rational to expect in mind matters, take the place of serious epistemological reflection about the complex relations between perceivers and world. It is high time for a synthetic awareness of the broad philosophical significance of our questions and of the constraints such broad views place on us. The social enactive view of perception I am offering in this work intends to be well anchored in such traditional discussions, albeit with an eye to the intersubjective dimension of our lives—a dimension that has been latent in the tradition and must now be explored in disciplined ways able to grant it a status in discussions where a wrong-headed psychological individualism cum propositional rationality prevails. It is my contention that this shift is philosophically warranted, and much needed for the wider purposes of philosophy as a discipline with a responsibility to humankind.
118
perceptual experiential temporality that is not explained by recourse to objective temporality.
For perception to be continuous, and as such to account for object-continuity and for self-
consciousness continuity (as it takes place in our actual, pragmatic involvement with objects and
events in which perception consists), the temporal structure of perception requires that initial
impressions do not disappear immediately and are ‘active’ in the following ‘snapshot’ impression,
or in other words, that there is a lingering impression turned into anticipation towards
continuous perception of objects, for otherwise it would not be possible to experience objects as
continuous, and that we do and is at the very basis of a perceiver’s capacity to relate to the
world. This is what Husserl calls the temporal structure of inner consciousness—impression-
retention-protention— which is constitutive of our consciousness, not only of ourselves but also of
our being conscious of objects perceptually (and otherwise psychologically).10 In other words,
the way in which perception is original consciousness of objects and events is incompatible with
the absence of an extended temporality, where objects just-perceived do not base the now-
perception of the same object.
Husserl illustrates the retention-protention model with the case of the perception of a
melody, where the initial impression ‘stays’ as the basis on which following notes are to take
place. This puts the perception of the melody at the level of the constant interaction, and not
just as a matter of the initial moment and its simply following sounds. The temporality of
perception does not lie in primal impression but extends over time, into the sequence itself of
ongoing perceptions, and that is why perception is not experienced “as having a subject-object
structure, but instead as an immediate coupling or dynamic attunement to our environment”
(Thompson 2009, 326).
Chalmers has characterized Edenic perception as direct and immediate. The presence of a
causal chain is a charge against directness, and the temporality intrinsic to the causal chain is a
charge against immediacy. Insofar, however, as this extended temporality of perceptual
10 This is arguably part of what is at stake when Kant refers to the syntheses of “apprehension in the intuition,” “of reproduction in the imagination,” (these two being from him “inseparably combined” ) and of “recognition in the concept” (Kant 1998, 228–231 (A100–103)).
119
consciousness involves what we can still call a causal element, for it is built upon the continuous
existence of the world that is constantly anticipated and fed back, Chalmers’s ruling out
directness on the basis of causality (even if it was the wrong idea of causality), which involved
an element of temporal mediacy, entails the impossibility of perceptual consciousness itself in
the Edenic world. But given that what it is to perceive in the first place is impossible without
perceptual consciousness, Chalmers’s theory entails that the very idea of perception is not true,
Edenic perception—the true state we are to understand ourselves over against. Not only is then
actual perception deemed illusory, but it is deemed so on the basis of a state of affairs that
cannot be recognized as perceptual.
My second argument (ii) addresses the point of the upshot of knowing by revelation, by
asking how we would know or be acquainted with perceptual stuff in this ideal of revelation. It
seems that to know something by revelation is to know it in an intellectual or spiritual manner,
where the thing revealed appears in one’s mind with no relevant causal reason. For Chalmers,
only something like a hypothetical mode of knowledge by revelation would be able to present
objects and properties without causal mediation and “in their intrinsic glory” (2006, 49; see also
p.94). But it seems to me that every instance of perceptual experience of the world is unlike
revelation: surely I can close my eyes, turn my head, open my eyes again, and a scene is
presented there. But to the extent that I know full well that I can see the scene because I am
directed towards it and that it would not be there if I close my eyes, etc. it seems that the sense in
which it is presented to me is not like that of a revelation. The possibility of entertaining
counterfactuals evinces the causal dependence of the experience. What good does revelation do
for us when trying to understand perception then?
Chalmers may object that his point is about property qualia: that in perceiving, say, a
thing’s smell the thing’s smell itself is revealed to us, and not that what we call the thing’s smell is
just our take on the thing’s smell. I must confess I am at a loss about what to do with this idea. It
seems to me, though, that this revelation hypothesis is a sleight of hand devised to posit, at the
120
level of the phenomenal character of perception, the idea that there is a contrast between
perceiving the thing’s smell itself and just our take on the thing’s smell, and that the correct
description is one that fixes the referent at the thing’s smell itself. To put it in simpler words:
hypothetical revelation carries with it an objectivist idea about the existence of perceived
properties in the world.
But to the extent that this strategy carries substantial entailments for the presentational
character of experience, it is fair to demand a justification for the methodological device. So I
ask: what would it be for a phenomenal feeling of a property to be non-causally linked to the
property? What would it be for a perceiver to have a phenomenal experience that in its
phenomenality is directly related to the property perceived? There is no positive notion that
could support the complaint, and this makes the complaint and the revelation hypothesis empty
in the sense of the classical empiricists.
When I examine the presentational character of a thing’s smell, I talk about the thing’s
smell, but I talk about it insofar as it is the thing I smell. There is no reason to suppose that the
ideal construction of this presentation is to say that in perceiving a thing’s smell, there is a
thing’s smell that I just witness—that is, that I am affected by a smell without me bringing the
phenomenal character to it, but only encountering it. The reason why this is not the preferred
ideal description is because one can just as well describe the situation as one in which I smell the
smell of the thing. Notice that there is a contrast here between a way of looking at the
interaction as a matter of a given, fully pre-defined world, which in perception I come only to
witness, and a way of looking at the interaction as an interaction in which the subjective side
cannot be absent. The undecidability of these ideal scenarios, on the grounds of these “ideal”
constructions alone, points, I think, to two ways of radically conceiving the relation with the
world, which some may describe as a difference in “intuitions.” Insofar as the relation at stake is
a real one—that of beings perceiving things in the world—the right characterization depends
on taking a broader view and observing perception as it takes place and not just as a concept,
121
which on conceptual-only grounds, can be treated no differently than revelation. Such further
evidence, I will be arguing, takes us in the direction of conceiving perception as a taking up of
physical reality, such taking up defined at the level of experience, not at the level of object
property or sensible quality with independent existence, where causality has an essential role in
perception and revelation is empty concept.
Further, if revelation actually provided us with a notion useful for understanding
perception, one would have no more reason to call an actual perception perception than one
would have to call it distortion. As I said above, visible properties cannot be made sense outside
of seeing. This means that the perceived property cannot be made sense of, in its phenomenal
character, outside of the world of perceptual relations. This seems to block the road for
Chalmers’s view to maintain that a non-relational property behind the appearances of perception
is the true content of phenomenal presentation. Unless Chalmers is able to provide a satisfactory
account of such perceivable property as a perceivable property, and yet arrived at by extra-perceptual
means and conveyable in non-perceptual terms, then there is no reason to assume that we ate of a
tree of Science—that our perceptual situation is rather a predicament, to be understood in
contradistinction to an ideal that leaves our contact with worldly objects, events, and states of
affairs lacking. Science speaks in quite the opposite direction than Chalmers hears it speaking. He
may be, unbeknownst to him, hearing an echo or looking at a reflection.
3.3.1 Directness and The Three Dependencies of Perception
Chalmers’s myth of the knowledge acquired through the fruit of the tree of science is a way of
saying that such conception of perception is built upon a contrast with an ideal state of affairs.
Mysteriously that ideal state of affairs has normative force in his conception, and, for the present
case, it consists in the conception of ideal perception as direct and unmediated, in contrast to
actual perception as indirect and mediated. But as I have been arguing, it does not seem that
Chalmers’s mythologizing as a device to express conceivability about directness has enough
traction on reality. He has just assumed that the present state of affairs is indirect because it is
122
mediated, entailing that perception does not put us in true contact with the world, and so its
deliverances are always doubtful. The idea is that no mediation can be innocent. If there is
mediation we must be suspicious of what it has changes has the original reality undergone. If we
go back to the tick mentioned above we’ll see that even in this very simple case of detecting a
substance (butyric acid) and acting upon such input event (release from the branch) there is a
processing—a biochemical one in this case. By the argument that a process amounts to non-
directness, the tick’s relation to the mammal secreting butyric acid is not direct. If this is not
direct, then not even the tanning of our skin in the sun is direct, and I am at a loss at to what
interaction, if any, can be direct. This trouble in finding cases of directness, understood as
causally unmediated, points to the real, deeper problem for Chalmers’s account, namely, the
inability to give the idea of directness-in-perception content. Without such content, to say that
perception is indirect is an empty assertion.
There is one more conceptual point that troubles Chalmers’s picture of direct perception.
One might think that Chalmers’s denial of directness must have been about what he calls
nonrelational properties, that is, properties supposed to exist independent of the perceptual
relation; category where he places color. My objections up to this point have been about such
supposedly nonrelational properties. But even if I granted those nonrelational properties
existence, my objections would have massive consequence in regards to relational properties
(comparative properties as in a sound that is too loud, or in the size of objects relative to each
other in a regular visual scene), hence to perception in general.
Suppose we accept Chalmers’s characterization of directness. If Edenic content is correct,
how could we account for properties whose essence and description only make sense when
perceived from a specific point of view of a specific being? (Would there be one Garden of Eden
per species?) How would a touching being behave in relation to a coarse or smooth surface—
that is, on the tactile nature of this surface as it reveals itself to touch—without that behaving
depending on the nature of the touching being, on the sensitivity of its skin? How about
123
perceiving something as big or small? What would it be (except for synesthetic subjects) to
taste drink or food, such that this tasting would not depend on the specific interaction of the
mouth cavity with objects? Would relational properties be of a type that never occurs in Eden,
since they depend on the relation between perceiver and perceived as a matter of their essential
nature and can only be indirectly perceived? And if they do not figure in Edenic content, which
explains presentational character, does relational properties’ presentational character go
unaccounted? If all these gamuts of ‘properties’ are not Edenic but plain worldly, their
presentational character cannot be thought of as contrasted with some confused ideal of direct
perception, and the content associated with them cannot be Edenic content, for no Eden ever
was a possible home for them.11 And could a theory unable to account for relational properties
be properly called a theory of perception?
In this section, I will expand my argument that perception is a matter of normatively
structured appearances, by presenting the three constitutive mediations that determine our
concrete contact with perceivable realities. I will add that, by appealing to the constitutive ways
in which perception is dependent upon different facts and interactions, appearances are
explicated and more easily understood in their systematic, normative structure, and the question
of a threat to directness does not even arise. It is not that in perceiving a color we do not
experience a feature of physical objects relatable to a certain physical description. Rather, in
perceiving a thing’s color we are interacting with an object placed in determinate environmental 11 The physically and chemically defined aspects of the physical world that stimulate our sensory nerve endings are also causal determinants of perception, in relation to both the specific objects we perceive and to the environmental conditions in which we experience those objects. These material aspects determine perceptual objects in the most basic of senses. For example, only that which is able to reflect or interfere with light might be an object of vision, but also only on the condition that there is light. Chapter 4 will offers an account of this relation between perceptual intentionality and the specific materiality of the object. By a similar token, the use of capacities depends on context, so it must be stipulated that I am assuming standard environmental conditions. Take the case of audition. The presence of a certain level of background noise is part of the normal ecology of audition. This is clearly revealed by anechoic chambers, noise-insulated spaces designed to eliminate all echo (which normally contributes to a normal soundscape). (See the anechoic chamber at Binghamton University, 360-degree view: http://www.youvisit.com/360fullscreen.php?college=79868&pano=8404&&vhost=1&pl=v&inst=59850). In silent places like these, “auditory neurons in the brain stem increase the amplification of signals from the auditory nerve to compensate for the lack of external sound” (Cox 2014, 209). In very quiet places, a person would start to hear bodily noises such as the sound of circulating blood. Reportedly, it was after a visit to one of this chambers and the experience of sounds of his own body in that context, that John Cage composed his 4’33”, which, among other things, is ineluctably accompanied by some noise (Cox 2014, 212–213). By a similar token, continued patterns of low levels of sensory stimulation affect the stability and consistency of otherwise normally perceived objects, as Guenther shows in the case of solitary confinement prisoners (2011, 258–259).
124
conditions, such as surroundings colors and ambient illumination, and in a certain position
relative to a subject that is configured thus and so, and is moving in determinate ways,
directions, and speeds, and performing specific movements guided by pragmatic goals (Varela,
Thompson, and Rosch 1991, 161–162; Noë 2004, 125–132; O’Regan and Noë 2001, 952). This
example is still somewhat inappropriate because, as I have been arguing, there are properties
that we perceive that are not relatable to physical properties of objects. These mediations are
what I will refer to as the dependencies of perception: idiosyncratic, non-socially pragmatic, and
socially pragmatic. The specific objects we perceive, the specific ways in which we perceive
them, the sensory properties we perceive in them (including the length and intensity of our
perception of them, where applicable), and the possibilities of sequences, combinations with
other sensory properties—these aspects, among others, are constituted by these dependencies.
Counterfactually put, to say that these dependencies are constitutive of our perceptual
experiences means that such experiences’ phenomenal character, objects, contents, perceived
properties, concrete appearances and the structure of those appearances would not be what they
specifically are, weren’t we perceptually related to reality in the form specified by the
dependencies. While I have been talking at times about mediations, I will now exclusively refer
to them as dependencies in order to keep with the Enactive literature and to underscore that
these dependencies are constitutive of perception, i.e. that perception constitutively depends on
these mediations.12
a. Idiosyncratic Dependencies
By idiosyncratic dependencies I refer to the person’s concrete configuration, at the moment of the
perceptual interaction, of biologically based capabilities and dispositions and psychological
characteristics such as deep-seated attentional habits or habitual associations about things
12 Notice also that referring to these dependencies as mediations carries a sense of intervention, and that contrasts with things unmediated as to something without any intervention. It is a short distance between unmediated and pure or original. Perception being mediated sounds negative (as representationalism has always had it) and not positive (as Social Enactivism, realisms, relationalisms have it). In contrast, dependence is the opposite of independence. In the framework of SEP, independence is not desirable, for there is no way to account for interactions to be independent.
125
perceptual, that are constitutive of our perceptual experiences.13 These biologically based
capacities and dispositions such as the basic structure of our bodies, the structure of our sensory
apparatuses and their range of sensitivity develop and otherwise change in different ways, in
varying degrees, and through different influences. It is possible that someone’s olfactory
sensitiveness becomes overly sensitive to certain stimuli, due to psychological associations, but
it is not likely that the range of the visual spectrum expands, for reasons due to the cellular
structure of rods and cones. Other facts of embodiment are, for instance, the temporality with
which our nervous system is able to process continuous stimulation in different sensory
modalities, the thresholds for sensory overstimulation or sensory fatigue, personal sensitivities
or insensitivities to sensory stimulations, etc. Part of what distinguishes the everyday
experience of a florist’s smelling a flower from the random experience of a non-florist’s smelling
a flower, I categorize as an idiosyncratic dependency. The reason for this is that there are
habituations and relatively stable levels of sensory tolerance and fatigue that can be counted as
part of the workings of the olfactory apparatus. Idiosyncratic dependencies are constitutive of what
we perceive and the way we perceive it, not only in relation to specific perceived objects but also
in the possibilities of contextual relations with the same object over time and with others
objects.
Idiosyncratic dependencies are at work both in perceivers with average capacities
relative to the group to which they belong—those with, say, “good” hearing—, as well as in
perceivers with capacities lower or higher than average, by reasons natural or even artificial.14
The clarification of “good” hearing conditions is conceptually arbitrary, although statistically
significant, and it is only meant as a way of making clear that the average person in the average
13 Embodied accounts of cognition (Husserl 1989; Merleau-Ponty 2002; Gallagher 2005; Gallagher and Zahavi 2008) or some enactivist accounts examine in detail the dependence of perceptual experience on “the structure of our biological embodiment” in detail (Varela, Thompson, and Rosch 1991, 147–150). I initially categorize body schema and body image (Gallagher 2005) under idiosyncratic dependencies, but leave open the details of this categorization as well as the possibility of both schema and image to partake in non-socially pragmatic or socially pragmatic dependencies. 14 It remains undetermined to what extent prosthetic-like devices are still within the parameters or normal perception. It seems that a pair of glasses does not change the nature of perception, and it would seem to follow that neither would a microscope nor a telescope that rely on visual stimulation that the subjects report seeing.
126
situation also experiences things auditorially (or otherwise perceptually) in a way that is
mediated by personal physiological configuration and standard environmental conditions. But
for perceptual experience, the average way of perceiving the world has no intrinsic normative
value. Every type of perceptual experience has the same existential value, and each set of
idiosyncratic dependencies is constitutive of experience. In commenting on how El Greco’s
astigmatism was part of a lived world expressed in painting, Merleau-Ponty notes: “When
irremediable bodily particularities are integrated into the whole of our experience, they stop
having the dignity of a cause” (1942, 219; the translation is mine). This integration of perception
with experience is integration with our “way of thinking and being” such that it expresses a
necessary aspect of our nature, and not “a particularity imposed from the outside” (Merleau-
Ponty 1942, 219). This is why the way our physical and psychological idiosyncrasies relate to
our perception is in the form of a dependency of experience and not of a cause for sensory stimulation.
Since experience is fundamentally lived-experience, the significance of the perceptual is at the
personal, existential level, and should not be understood as a mere conditioning—a path that
was already precluded, though, since perception is not sensory input.
When these idiosyncratic dependencies are culturally influenced, what tells these
dependencies apart from the socially pragmatic ones is that these can be referred to the person’s
regular workings of their sensory apparatuses. Further, I do not assume that specific aspects of
perceptual experience can only be tied to one dependency. It is often the case, that experience
features influences from all three dependencies and that it may be impossible to tell the
contributing factors apart from one another.
In relation to the issue of directness, it is clear that the same object does not necessarily
appear the same to different perceivers, but this type of differences does not entail indirectness.
It would be wrong to say that a cave wall is indirectly perceived by a human and by a bat simply
because each perceiver is acquainted with it in a different way.
127
b. Non-Socially Pragmatic Dependencies
By non-socially pragmatic dependencies I refer to patterned links between actions and sensory
stimulation, whose mastery is constitutive of our perceptual experiences. These dependencies
include part of the traditional Enactive idea of sensorimotor dependencies, which is the idea that
we perceive they way we do because of the significance of our movements for sensory
stimulation (O’Regan and Noë 2001; Noë 2004). Of all sensorimotor dependencies, I put on the
non-socially pragmatic side, those dependencies that are cast essentially on spatial properties,
because only in relation to space it makes sense to talk of motor variations. These are non-
socially pragmatic, I contend, because the properties they are related to are perspectival
properties—P-properties—that could be objectively defined, in the following spirit: “P-
properties--the apparent shape and size of objects—are perfectly ‘real’ or ‘objective.’ Indeed, the
relation of P-shape and P-size to shape and size can be given by precise mathematical laws (e.g.,
the laws of linear perspective). Importantly, in order to characterize P-properties, there is no
need to refer to sensations or feelings. P-properties are objective in the sense that they are
determinate and that they do not depend on sensations or feelings” (Noë 2004, 83).
If we extend this relative objectivity argument to other actions, not just motor related, in
the sense that it is the change in location that determines the change in sensory stimulation, we
find that there are other sensory relations that hold a similar structure. It is the case, for
example, of the fact that the temperature of one’s hands influences the experience of temperature
of a thing touched. Relations of taste (eating a very sweet solid followed by a sweet beverage)
are of a similar kind: they hold a certain objectivity not in virtue of social habituation, but in
virtue of actions or manipulations on them or in relation to them, according to the modality. A
non-socially pragmatic dependency (that happens to be sensorimotor in kind) is at play in the
case of like looking at a pond.15 One can see through the pond when standing close to it but as
15 The sensory and the motor are here not only a matter of causal input and output at the subpersonal level but also feature in dynamic feedback relationships at the personal level (Hurley 1998; see chapters 7 and 8). Even then, it is important to notice that the perceptual is not identified with the causal sensory. Pragmatic dependencies (both socially and non-socially constituted) are built upon structural aspects of the embodiment of perceivers, so partly
128
one walks away from it, the surface may start reflecting the scene opposite to one, i.e. as one
reduces the angle of one’s line of vision relative to the surface of the water, allowing oneself to
‘encounter’ light reflected on the surface.16
It is important in SEP’s account to see that the split is not between sensorimotor and
other dependencies, but between non-socially pragmatic and socially pragmatic dependencies. It
is irrelevant for my thesis whether Noë’s Enactivism is strongly committed to the thesis that (i)
all P-properties are objective and definable regardless of sensations or feelings, as he claims P-
shape or P-size are, or whether his Enactivism claims that (ii) not all P-properties are real and
objective in the way P-shape and P-size are. It is clear that (i) would make his Enactivism
weaker, for reasons I explained in length at the end of chapter 2 and will expand on in chapter 4
(section 4.1.1). On this point, it is still the case that SEP offers a more comprehensive theory
than Sensorimotor Enactivisms since SEP identifies both non-socially pragmatic dependencies
that go unaccounted for in the Sensorimotor view, and socially pragmatic dependencies that
exceed what the Sensorimotor view accounts for. I have exemplified the first kind with the
dependency between some interactions between skin (or mouth) temperature and objects of
touch. Some socially-constituted attentional variations are of the second kind because they are
not sensorimotor. By the same token, sensorimotor dependencies do not cover either lawful
variations in smells and tastes, such as those a person brings about by customarily adding salt
to food. There is nothing sensorimotor in the common phenomenon that a certain dish tastes
better or that flavors are more noticeable if I add salt to it.
upon the facts figuring in idiosyncratic dependencies. In fact, autopoietic enactivists such as Varela, Thompson and Rosch (1991), and Thompson (2007) straddle the embodiments aspects of idiosyncratic dependencies with sensorimotor dependencies. But these dependencies are also built upon a history of perceptual interactions (Hutto and Myin 2013, 17). It is not only that we become skillful in certain pre-existing sensorimotor potentialities of human bodies and environment, but that we come to have the specific sensorimotor skills based on our own history of interacting, in sensorimotor terms, with the environment. 16 Similar analyses could be extended to the cases of reflection and refraction (including double vision illusions) that both Price and Ayer consider so telling as to the non-direct character of perception (Price 1950, 28–29; Ayer 1947, 3–4).
129
c. Socially Pragmatic Dependencies
By socially pragmatic dependencies I refer to the social practices and aspects of them that are
constitutive of our perceptual experiences, which I have called perceptual practices. As
accounted in chapter 1, perceptual practices are the finely attuned, contextual and normative
system of commerce of—production of and response to—meaningful perceptible material. These
are dependencies of perception because our perceptual experience of specific objects and the
properties we get acquainted with, etc. depends on socially constituted ways of taking in or
manipulating perceptible materials. For example, heating up or cooling down foods or
beverages according to uses (which de facto include preferences, tendencies, and dislikes) makes
the specific object of our interaction depend on something we do. As in the case of some foods
we heat up in order to eat, these interactions may even affect the perceptual object itself, its
specific perceptual properties (shape, texture, consistency, flavor, smell, among others) may
change along with temperature changes.
Some socially pragmatic dependencies consist also in very basic ways of ‘using’ the
sensory apparatus. For example, sniffing strongly or softly may be very specific ways in which
some people simply smell something, or in the way they enjoy a pleasant smell. We can also see
socially pragmatic dependencies in the absence of the distinction between blue and green in
some languages, such as Tarahumara (under a framework that links this absence of a difference
with actual discriminative and otherwise perceptual practices) (Varela, Thompson, and Rosch
1991, 171). Some socially pragmatic dependencies are sensorimotor.
Consider the following case: In looking for a dark grey sweater, which suits the
occasion, I may turn on the light, knowing that with poor lighting dark grey and navy blue may
look the same to me. In doing so, the interplay of light and color kicks in, as well as the spatial
disposition of visual non-transparent objects and my ability to sort those colors out. All aspects
are relevant here, and yet, in a governing sense, the intention to find a certain colored-piece
guides the process. All dependencies are in place. Chapter 4 will provide the opportunity for
130
further examination of the interplay of the three dependencies within the structure of content
(cf. section 4.1 and the Ambulance Siren case). It sufficed for the purposes of this chapter to have
explained the way in which these dependencies or mediations are understood not as a cleavage
between appearances and reality, but actually as the very way in which physical realities present
themselves and are perceived, in a way that cannot be called but direct.
3.3.2 Are There Perfect Sensory Properties?
The second point (B) in Chalmers’s conception of the presentational aspect of perceptual content
is the perspectiveless ideal of perception, such that to directly perceive objects and properties is
to perceive perfect properties, which are part of the Edenic content.
In Chalmers’s view, perceptual experiences have the phenomenology they do by virtue of
having Edenic content, that is, by virtue of having experiences that seem to present us with
perfect properties. “If we were to take our experience completely at face value” (2006, 70) it would
not seem that we were presented with perfect properties but we would actually be presented
with them. Presentationally, however, the distinction between being presented with and seeming to
be presented with perfect properties is self-effaced: ‘the phenomenology,’ Chalmers would say,
presents as with properties as if they were perfect properties, so the content that accounts for
‘the phenomenology’ is constructed in terms of the ideal garden of Eden where such properties
were real and we were really presented with them, directly, immediately, and unmediatedly, that
is, where such properties were revealed to us.17
Let us get some clarity here. Chalmers says “Eden sets the standard, and our imperfect
world can only match it” (Chalmers 2006, 111). On his two-stage view of content, while Eden
plays the strongest role, Fregean content only represents perfect properties imperfectly—it
matches them, that is, it picks up imperfectly instantiated properties and objects that normally
17 It is not altogether clear that debates in philosophy of perception have decidedly moved forward. Certain discussions seem just to have been repackaged and some distinctions rehashed according to the fancy of the moment. Here it is as if Rorty, in commenting on Ayer’s formulation of the argument from illusion (of which Chalmers’s tree of Science is a piece), were actually commenting on Chalmers’s strategy as the “sketching an Ideal Language whose undefined descriptive predicates would refer to directly apprehended characteristics of postulated entities called ‘sense-data’” (1992, 13). This impression brings a positive point, though, a certain unspoken reliance of Chalmers on a sense-data background, which the substantial proximity of Chalmers’s and Price’s accounts seems to support.
131
cause the experience that perfect properties and objects would cause in Eden. Our standards are
not those belonging to a perfect world, for “after the fall, we have learned to live with the
imperfection of perception” (2006, 95). And yet, our standards derive from the perfect
phenomenal veridicality of Eden and this is why the presentational content of our perception is
Edenic: it resembles imperfectly yet closely the perfection of Eden, which we can’t help to feel.
However ad hoc its role is, Chalmers is committed to perfect properties, even if all we have is as-
if perfect properties. I shall then take Chalmers at face value and argue against the idea that
there is such a thing as Edenic content in perceptual experience and that this content fulfills the
presentational desideratum.
So here is a point where Edenic content puts itself to the test of coherence and shows itself
to be self-contradictory and self-defeating: there are perceptual experiences in which we are
presented with non-perfect properties. All cases of finely grained perceived properties belong to
this category (unless Chalmers were to take the even more implausible view that every finely
grained property is itself a perfect property). These cases include the lack of definition of the
property perceived when an object is clearly perceived as not having a definite, sharply defined
property (like a mix of songs, voices, sounds, and conversations at a loud bazaar, or a complex,
new flavor for which we have no name yet), in both the situations in which properties presented
could be sharply acquired or in which they are not ameliorable; cases of transitions between
more defined states (like the sequence of perceived colors as it gets darker), and cases of
nonconceptual perceptual content that are not included in the previous categories, such as
perceptions of things as harmonious. As a matter of fact I hold that no perceptual experiences
present us with perfect properties, for they are all always, as Husserl has defended,
fundamentally indeterminate (both as the nature of the properties we perceive and as the
continuous, always-changing nature of its objects). My specific argument here, though, only
needs that some perceptual experiences have no Edenic content. (These problems will soon
reappear under the veridicality desideratum, and with a reason: if Fregean content derives from
132
Edenic content, it only makes sense that the problems of indetermination that we find at the
sensory properties level will mutate correspondingly into the representational level.)
The question is: Is Chalmers’s account of the presentational desideratum through Edenic
content able to handle cases like those described above, featuring indeterminate, finely grained,
and transitional perceptions? Naturally, an answer to this question entails an answer to a more
fundamental question, namely, whether Edenic content captures appropriately the
presentational desideratum. I will argue that the answer to both questions is no; we can safely
derive a negative answer to the latter question on the basis of a negative answer to the former
question. I want to examine the following specific case: How would Chalmers analyze finely
grained or transitional perceptual experiences, such changes in the property itself, for example, in
a surface due to illumination changes, or in shape due to our location in relation to the object?
Imagine you are looking at a tree at dusk, when it’s getting darker. Suppose sunset is at
6:17 p.m., and it gets darker from 5:53 p.m. to 6:41 p.m. Add a heavily clouded day, new moon.
A correct description of color behavior when darkening would be to say something like this.
Color X is visible at 100% of its ‘intensity’ at 5:52 p.m., at 75% at 6:05 p.m., at 50% at 6:17 p.m.,
at 25% at 6:29 p.m., and at 1% at 6:40 p.m. (X1, X2, X3, X4, and X5). At 6:40 p.m., I contend, color
X5 (say the brown of a tree trunk) would not appear to be the same color it was at 5:52 p.m., and
would seem to be the same as other colors, X4 and X6 (imagine a brown chocolate and a brown
mocha as ‘contiguous’ or close shades of brown). Both phenomena—at some point color X5 does
not look the same (color constancy breaks down), and color X5 is mistaken for X4 or X6—
suggests that there cannot be an instantiation of perfect colors at 6:40 p.m. In other words: to
say that the presentational aspect of the content of a perception of color X at 6:40 p.m. is
explainable as a perfect instantiation of it, the same that is instantiated, for example, at 6:05
p.m., seem not to speak of the what-it-is-like to have that color. Chalmers would agree that for
content capturing the way things look, to be unable to capture this difference is not plausible
(See 2006, 84–89 when talking about a shadowed white surface and a gray unshadowed surface).
133
Chalmers has suggested treating cases like this either as a conjunction of perfect properties
or as another sort of intrinsic property. While the case of a shadowed surface allows for the talk
of color+shadow, it is not clear what conjunction works for the ‘getting darker’ moment: how
would we factor the darkening aspect? As to the other type of intrinsic property, Chalmers talks
of a specific “mode” of brown that is instantiated when ambient light is such and such. The
problem with this last proposal is that it posits yet another perfect color property. It would start
resembling mere speculation to posit a perfect color for every shade that there is or there could
be. Extended to other sensory modalities, my point here is that it is not only implausible but
empty to try to capture presentational content as a matter of ideal perfect properties that are
just as finely grained as actual properties we perceive in the world. The appeal here is not only
to simplicity, but to the fact that the finely grained character of perceived properties derives
from the actual dynamic interactions of worldly, environmentally-situated objects, events and
states of affairs, with perceivers who are not just revealed the physical aspect of objects, but who
perceive them on the basis, partly, of their physical structure.
Let us insist for a moment in the case of color. Standard talk of color is sometimes too
fruity, too cartoonish—some apples are red, some apples are green, limes are green, and lemons
are yellow. Philosophers have rightly wondered about things such as the sky’s color. How about
the color of a water pond? One wonders, naturally, whether a water pond (or its surface) has a
color in Chalmers’s sense (although it, of course, does for all intersubjective perceptual intents),
that is, as a sensory quality that could perfectly be instantiated in Eden without being
experienced. The case is interesting because it paradigmatically shows how its color is very
much dependent on surrounding conditions (in this case, illumination and surrounding scene)
and on its position relative to the observer.18 The perceived color of a water pond depends on
the water itself, what is underwater, what is around the water, specific illumination (whether
cloudy or sunny), and one’s own position relative to the water (subtending angles, etc.), that is,
18 For a more detailed exploration of the metaphysics of colors in classic studies in the enactive literature see (Varela, Thompson, and Rosch 1991, 157–171; O’Regan and Noë 2001, 951–952; Noë 2004, 123–161).
134
to different ‘sections’ of water in the water pond: so that some sections reflect the surroundings,
some sections allow for seeing through, and some sections seem simply look to be of a certain
color, on which one could get a relative, satisfying-enough, interpersonal agreement with other
viewers. The difficulty for Edenic content to account for the color of a water pond depends on
the impossibility to single out one color that would belong to the pond, for in virtue of the
nature of the object at stake, any color would depend on a series of relations of which the
position of the observer is one, which entails that the color could not be perfectly instantiated, in
Chalmers’s sense.
Back to the case of getting darker, Chalmers is unable to provide an analysis of colors as it
gets darker. “Objects do not seem to change their colors, exactly, although the representation of
their colors may become much less specific, and it eventually becomes absent altogether (as does
the representation of objects, in pitch blackness)” (2006, 89). This is self-contradictory, for this
talk of “becoming less specific” is incompatible with perfect colors. They could become less
specific as to their imperfect veridical content—Fregean content, answering to the veridicality
desideratum—but not as to their perfect veridical content: the one that Edenic content is
supposed to capture. To say that in Eden things are presented in their perfection means to say
that presentation is an all-or-nothing affair. This is why the closest Chalmers gets to the issue
of darkness is with substitution: “in Eden, when things become dark, perfect darkness is present
throughout the relevant volume: of space, intrinsically altering that volume, although it need
not alter objects' colors. In Eden, when darkness falls, perfect darkness pervades” (2006, 89). But
perceptual transitions are not substitutions. In Chalmers’s Eden, there is darkness, but it doesn’t
get dark.
It should be clear by now that Eden is a non-starter. Either in Eden it doesn’t get darker,
moment by moment, although it is dark at times (at some point lights are just turned off), or
colors do not have the same lawful behavior they do on earth. The former option has no room
for perceptual transitions that abound in the perceptual world, perhaps more than perceptual
135
fixities do, and which are essential to perception; the latter option takes colors for what they are
not, making it impossible, once again, to account for perceptual transitions.
The consequence for Chalmers’s account is fatal: Edenic content is a poor account of the
presentational content of perceptual experience. Would not there be something wrong if colored
objects did not look differently (and yet the same) as it gets darker—particularly when it’s about
to get pitch-dark? Or if colored objects didn’t look differently depending on illumination
conditions? To make the point more basic: Consider an object whose size and shape does not
perceptually change while we move away from it, or about a sound that does not fade away as
we move away from it. What is wrong with these cases is that the continuous variations of
perceptual continua and the consistency of such variations are essential to what it means to
perceive objects, events, and states of affairs. If the perceptual world were like Eden, I contend,
we would not know how to act upon perceived objects that do not behave as worldly objects do.
Even more basically: in Eden we would not have the feeling of perceiving things, as things would
not change as we relate perceptually to them, and such changes are at the very heart of
perception. The perceptual Garden of Eden is just a wayward, wrong, fruitless view.
While talk of perfect properties offers Chalmers a way to theoretically accommodate
changes in the objects, the subject, or the medium that make for a change in what is perceived,
this happens only under quite artificial and implausible circumstances. Not only is the
adaptation to the specific case problematic, but there is an arbitrary reference to a supposed ideal
presentation of such property. However, insofar as perceived properties are essentially
perspectival, it is simply nonsense to say that there is such a thing as a perfect instance of the
property such that it is revealed in “all its glory” and that is independent of the experience of it.
A perfect presentation is an oxymoron, for perfect means perspectiveless and presentation is
essentially experiential and essentially perspectival.
For Chalmers, the ideal perfect perceivable property is one that exists independently of
perceivers experiencing it. In contrast, I have argued that the very idea of a perceived property
136
is such that its existence, as perceived, is indescribable and not-thoroughly-conceivable outside
of the perceiving relation. Just to make clear my position vis-à-vis the traditionally called
primary properties, my claim is that while things have a shape independent of the perceiver, the
perceived shape as perceived is not independent of the perceiver. That which is perceived, in the
case of shape, is not the shape as objectively defined by, say, a measurement, but the way such
shape looks from different points of view. To look at a square tower from afar and see it round is
to say that I am seeing a square tower from afar and it looks round because square objects like
towers look round when looked from afar.
Chalmers would object that there is no reason to think that properties are essentially
perspectival. As a matter of fact, the idea of perfect property he has in mind is a property that in
its perfect instantiation is independent of an experience of it: “we have no trouble conceiving of
an object being perfectly colored even though no one ever experiences its color” (Chalmers
2006, 114). The view I have been proposing is able to accommodate part of this state of affairs:
the idea of a colored object that no one sees. I am not saying that objects are only colored when
I look at them, but that to speak of their colors depends on our being able to look at them—at
least in the sense that we experientially know the domain of visibilia. What I am unable to
accommodate is the talk of the object being “perfectly colored.”
The notion of an ideal perfect perceivable property, let us recall, is one that exists
independently of perceivers experiencing it. When discussing in some more detail the possibility
of perceiving perfect colors, ‘representing’ perfect colors, as he’d have it, Chalmers resorts to
cases in which we actually represent uninstantiated properties (like perfect redness, or perfect
bitterness) in order to dispel our worries. He says that we can represent “the property of being
phlogistonated” or of “being a round square” (Chalmers 2006, 83). These examples are of no
avail at all in a discussion about the possibility of ‘representing’ or perceiving things with the
presentational character of perception. These cases are not real, they may be impossible, and it is
doubtful they are truly conceivable.
137
Chalmers says that he has no good theory of “how our mental states represent any
properties at all” (2006, 84). And yet, he concedes that the way we represent “requires a theory
of the roots of intentionality,” an understanding of which “will be closely tied to understanding
the metaphysics of phenomenology” (2006, 84). He further says: “I am inclined to think that
Edenic content may also give us an entry point for understanding the metaphysics of
experience. […] It may be that perceptual experience is fundamentally equivalent to the
presentation of an Edenic world. If so, then if we can understand how the presentation of an
Edenic world is possible, then we will understand perceptual phenomenology” (Chalmers 2006,
117). So here we have that we go from understanding the Edenic content to “the
phenomenology.” But if the Edenic world were about properties that may go uninstantiated,
such as “being phlogistonated,” our prospects for understanding perceptual experience and the
phenomenal character of perception would be dim if they depended on Chalmers’s theory.
And now things go in the reverse direction: from understanding “the phenomenology” to
Edenic content (75), for in a somewhat similar confused line of though he says: “A world with
respect to which our visual experience is perfectly veridical is an Edenic world. […] It is
natural to ask: what is the character of an Edenic world? A full answer to this question depends
on a full analysis of the phenomenology of visual experience, which cannot be given here” (2006,
75). Here we are told that understanding a non-existent world depends on an analysis of the
way things appear, but even Chalmers’s ‘phenomenology,’ we have seen, is quite distorted, for it
relies on a view of presentation that doesn’t allow for transitions and finely grained perceptions:
“Edenic content […] directly reflects the experience's phenomenology” (2006, 73). It does not
seem that we can rely on a ‘phenomenology’ about the way things actually appear and yet
structured in terms of perfect properties revealed in perfection. So what is the direction of
inquiry and of explanation? What is original, basic level of analysis?
And yet, Chalmers comes a bit closer to the idea of a perceptual property, when he
considers the case of pain. Pain cannot be perfectly instantiated because it cannot occur without
138
a subject experiencing it, and the notion of a perfect property is a radical mind-independent
existence. Yet he holds that pain exists as a property, even if cannot be instantiated in Eden, like
a round square, because “one has a grip on the property of perfect pain, based on one’s
experience” (2006, 114). My conception of a perceived property seems to be akin to what
Chalmers imagines pain to be. As with Chalmers’s pain, I hold that there cannot be a perfect
instantiation of a perceived property, if perfection entials the exclusion of experience. Whatever
notion we have of a like-perfect property, which I think we can talk meaningfully about, is
derived from one’s own experience.
Chalmers says his two-stage view of content is supposed to be strong in the account of
phenomenal character through Edenic content, and in the idea that even the Fregean,
representational content is grounded also in “the phenomenology of experience” (2006, 73). If I
am right in pointing to the fundamental confusion in the notion of a perfect property, seemingly
the basis of the ‘phenomenology’, then Chalmers’s Edenic content is, in fact, wrong and his
Fregean content does not have the good grounding it supposedly does. Chalmers’s attempt to
find phenomenological adequacy in a hypothetical world shows two things: that he is mistaken
about what it is for spatiotemporal objects to be perceived by beings capable of perception and
that he is hence not accounting for this-worldly perception, but for other-worldly perception.
Chalmers retains the feeling of presentation and explains perceptual changes as deficiencies in
relation to an ideal. It is mistaken to say that such hypothetical world can stand for what is
phenomenologically adequate, for precisely such deficiencies are the positive sources of the
actual characteristic ways of perception. In this connection one sees that an intellectualistic
conception of real objects, that is, of real objects modeled after an ideal world, tokened in perfect
properties that can never be instantiated, and which are thought to be analogous to being
phlogistonated or being a round square, are evidence of a profound disorientation in standard
philosophy of perception.
139
To actually perceive objects, events, and states of affairs directly and immediately means to
be engaged in coherent, systematic yet always-varying spatial, temporal, and pragmatic
interactions with objects, states of affairs, and properties, according to the materiality of objects
and the triple dependency of perception. The theory I have been accounting for does exactly
this. It goes to the roots of intentionality in general, and to the roots of perception as a specific
type of intentionality in particular. In the face of the foregoing objections and having in sight a
positive rich theory of appearances which offers a much thicker and richer phenomenology of
perceptual experience, backed up by and built upon the metaphysics of perceptual experience,
Chalmers account of the presentational aspect of perception should be rejected, along with the
associated structure of content it proposes.
Sensory Properties in SEP. I would like to finish this section by stating my take on
sensory properties, making emphasis on the interactionalist aspect of SEP. The position I have
been articulating is that the properties we perceive are appearances or aspects of things, such
that there is no distance—yet a perspective—between perceived thing and perceivable thing,
because for objects, events, and states of affairs there is no other way to appear perceptually
than to present themselves in appearances to perceivers. There is, however, a one-many
correlation, structured along the lines of the three dependencies explained above.
The interactionalism of SEP is also predicated of phenomenal character. Even though I
hold that perceptual experience of perceived properties is indeed partly characterized by
phenomenal character, this character is not a mental event but a characteristic of the interaction,
in which an aspect of the world is presented in such-and-such ways to a perceiver. This
presentation in the form of an appearance is not just a feeling, a ‘seeming.’ I here echo
Wittgenstein’s idea that the feeling in perception is not an inner experience or a private event
but rather a bodily engagement with the world, in which the we respond bodily “both physically
and verbally to […] perceptions” (Krebs 2010, 131). The phenomenal character of a perception
140
is woven into lived-experience in a responsive manner, and not merely in a receptive way, as if it
were “the last stop” on the input side of things, as Hurley would have put it (1998, 249).
I have argued that sensory and perceived properties are not intrinsic properties of objects,
which is what it is supposed under the idea that an object has a certain color and to perceive that
color means to perceive exactly the way such color is ideally thought to exist in the object itself.
On that view, perceived properties are merely contingent, supervenient aspects of real
properties existing in objects. This position can take the shape that perceived properties are
qualia alone. But this is to be rejected on the basis of the metaphysics of experience I endorsed,
for it entails an untenable projectivism in that the felt quality of the world becomes dissociated
from it.
So as to the intrinsic properties view I grant that it makes sense to talk of nonrelational
perceivable properties, that is, that it, of course, makes sense to say that there is such a thing as
a color in the things out there, and a certain texture. But the property that we could
linguistically fix as the color or the texture of an object, for communicative purposes, is not to be
expected to figure in our perceptions of it, strictly speaking. The color and the texture that we
perceive is always interactional: it is always a look or an appearance of the one reality that is out
there, but which cannot be described in its perceptual, sensible lingo outside of the perceptual
interaction with it.19 The linguistically fixed property does not really pick a finely grained
phenomenal appearance, that is, as it is lived in experience.
Shoemaker’s (2006) position on sensory properties allows me to underscore a key aspect of
SEP. For Shoemaker, perceived properties are not sensible qualities (physical properties of
objects). Perceived properties are qualitative characters of qualities, but are themselves no
properties of external objects or objects’ properties. Neither are they the ways of presentation of
objects and those objects’ properties, that is, they are not only different in the how of the
presentation but in the what of it (2006, 472). Qualitative characters, in Shoemaker’s
19 Even Ayer’s argument for the definition of the “real qualities of a material thing” is unable to escape this intra-perceptual dependence, as he tries to fix perceptual reality in terms of “privileged appearances” (1947, 31). I will explore this in some more detail in the next section.
141
terminology, are aspects of external properties; as such, they are ways subjects represent objects as
having. To perceive a certain qualitative character an object to have is to have an experience
whose phenomenal character is based on the representation a subject has of the object.
The fundamental disagreement in our positions is that Shoemaker is a representationalist,
unlike SEP, which is best characterized as interactionalist. Interactionalism can countenance key
tenets of the relationalism proposed by Campbell but it goes further. Let me illustrate it in the
following way.
It is unclear whether Shoemaker gets the relationalist wrong when he takes her to be
saying that on the relationalist view of experience that holds objects themselves to be
constitutive of experience, “the experience inherits the qualitative character by including an
instantiation of the color that has it” and that each color has only one qualitative character
(2006, 472–473). It woud follow from here that for the relationalist there is no way to account
for differences in perceptual experience of the same object, and such differences are—not only
under inverted spectrum scenarios—central to the way perceptual objects present themselves to
subjects. Shoemaker reasons that the idea of phenomenal character being inherited from the
object that is constitutive of the experience commits the relationalist to there being only one
“qualitative character.” The problem here seems to be with Shoemaker pressing too hard (and
mistakenly) on the idea of inheritance: one speaks of inheritance when a thing is transferred to
another, so there is a strong notion of continuity in the thing inherited.
To counter this view we would need a notion of perceptual relation that has objects as
constitutive of experiences, and where the nature of the relation itself is other than the passing
down of an object. Some relations, however, stand in a one-one structure between subject and
object. This is the case, for instance, of the relation between a viewer and a mirror, such that
given the angle at which the viewer’s eyes are in relation to the mirror, there is only one set of
objects reflected in the mirror that is accessible to the viewer.
142
On SEP’s view, we rather talk about a perceptual interaction. The reason for this is that the
relationship is conceived as one in which things and their sensory properties appear differently
to subjects (same or different subjects) depending on considerations pragmatic and
environmental factors as well as considerations about the constitution of the perceivers. While
inheritance is a somewhat apt analogy for a source-product relation, it is limited. Not every such
relationship is one of inheritance. In our case, the guiding sense in perceptual relation cannot be
pinned down by the inheritance model. In contrast, I hold that the phenomenal character of
objects and their properties is grounded on the “qualitative character of things” such that they
are shown in one-many or undefined-many relation between objects, events, states of affairs and
appearances or properties. These relations are best specified through the triple dependency of
perception, the two-fold structure of content, and the pragmatic account of perceptual
normativity.
3.4 Eating from the Tree of Illusion and the Veridicality Desideratum
Chalmers mythologizes that we ate of the tree of Illusion and that thereafter things did not
appear exactly as they were but rather with “different colors and shapes at different times.” Our
trust was broken. At pain of irresponsibility, we were then motivated to doubt whether things
are as they appear. Philosophers helped us began to realize and fulfill our duty to ever demand
from our perceptions whether they are true. Ever since, our relation with the perceptual world
is a rational contestation of perceptual evidence, at times yielding positive verdicts.
But things are sadder, now we know, for true veridicality is to us but a chimera. We would
never be actually presented with things in their pure glory. Our representations of things can
only imperfectly, and only sometimes, match what must ideally be the case in Eden: “Eden sets the
standard, and our imperfect world can only match it” (Chalmers 2006, 111). Whether or not an
experience is (imperfectly) veridical is determined by content that needs only to match perfect
properties, that is, “to play the role that perfect redness [properties] plays in Eden” (2006, 72).
143
Fregean content is an (imperfect) condition of satisfaction of our experience: the experience is
(imperfectly) veridical iff the world turns out to be the way perceptual experience (re)presents it
to be. The world turns out to be the way experience represents it if we have experience of
properties that normally cause the experience that perfect properties and objects would cause in
Eden. And ‘normally’ is enough for us because our standards are not those belonging to a
perfect world, for “after the fall, we have learned to live with the imperfection of perception”
(2006, 95).
In other words, the argument is that we can only get an imperfect idea of the world by
means of perception, and that even this imperfect idea is never secured, and that in order for it
to be secured, perceptual resources alone won’t do and extra-perceptual means must be put to
work. In this section I take up issue with this argument, as it is deployed around the tree of
Illusion (only one aspect of the more famous argument from illusion), and deal with it by
exposing the unspoken argument on which it is built and that such unspoken argument, dressed
of a strong ‘intuition,’ is faulty, and must then be rejected.
A concern for veridicality is the rule rather than the exception in the philosophical work on
perceptual experience or on the epistemology of perception. Theories of perceptual content
normally take for granted that the guiding issue about content is that perception has the
epistemological role of justifying beliefs arising from those experiences’ content (Byrne 2005;
Peacocke 1992; Siegel 2011a, 3–4; Siegel 2010, chap. 2; Toribio 2007). Experiences represent the
world to be a certain way—they have a content that shows the world to be a certain way—, and
because appearances are, by definition, taken to be only contingently corresponding with the
world, a “strong intuition” holds experiences “assessable for accuracy”—the veridicality
desideratum (Chalmers 2006, 50).20
20 One quick note: my taking the issue of content as a matter of the aboutness of perceptual experience implies that I do not take content to be ex hypothesi a piece of a representational framework on which the content of perception are “things conveyed by sources of information (as when we speak of the contents of a newspaper story)” (Siegel 2010, 28) that are truth-functional via correspondence (i.e. veridicality). On this view, ‘content’ lives in the veridicality neighborhood, and this is more patent when we touch upon the idea that perception is representational. Given that I dispute this notion, some might think I should just give up on using ‘content’ as a way of conceptualizing perceptual aboutness. It seems perfectly fine to me to offer an interpretation of content that is not definitionally linked to
144
The views that theorize from veridicality assume that the truth-functional behavior of the
concept ‘content’ in relation to the related ideas ‘perception,’ ‘belief,’ ‘object,’ ‘property,’ etc.
reveals something central about the philosophical interesting aspects of perception, guided by
some (never-all-too-clear) ‘intuitions’ and constrained by the extra-linguistic ‘phenomenology’
of things, i.e. a list of flat, isolated ways things look. Partly what is at work here is a
commitment to perception having an intrinsic inferential character. Such inferential or pseudo-
inferential character of perception is at work in beings like us, able to compare perceptual
experiences with idealized perfect objects and properties possibly instantiated in experience
(2006, 102). It goes without saying that in such views perception in non-human animals remains
a mystery.
The concern for veridicality is the flip side of a worry about deception. One can look at
someone’s theory of perception by looking at their conception and use of perceptual error,
deception, perceptual illusions, and hallucinations. The early deployment of the argument from
illusion in Price (1950) and Ayer (1947) is telling in this respect; and Austin thought in fact that
the faulty cases actually take the lead and are the levelers of the field (1962, 44). That this is the
modern attitude towards perception should by now be clear—down the line, philosophers think,
the task of philosophy is to see how everything stands in relation to, or on our way to, truth.
The nature of perception ends up being the distilled product of a reduction-to-truth, regardless
of whether perception is the type of thing that aims at truth. Chalmers’s is a clear case of this
view that takes, directly and indirectly, a certain conception of what counts as an illusion as
definitional of perception. An idea that certain perceptions count as an error is assumed before
the investigation about perception. As a matter of fact, there is not much argumentation for the
consequences of our eating the tree of illusion. This explains why my arguments are oftentimes
directed against other philosophers who actually argued for it, such as Price and Ayer.
veridicality, thereby allowing the position I am arguing to contribute in the important debates about perception on which content is invoked. This move entails saying that the ground level is that of aboutness. The content-veridicality defender should not have problems explaining why she takes content to be the correct take on aboutness, or why content is, regardless of the metaphysics of experience or aboutness, the right level of analysis in the problems of perception.
145
In this same vein, we find Chalmers just assuming that hallucinations can have the same
“phenomenology” as perceptions—the root of the Tree of Illusion.21 Chalmers “discusses” this
aspect in a footnote, as if it were inconsequential, or at least greatly downplaying its importance;
yet the discussion is simply a declaration of allegiances. For to be sure, what is contained in such
an assumption is that perceptual resources aren’t able to say much, with certainty, beyond a
report of a collection of rather isolated appearances that are only contingently linked to reality.
What makes the issue more problematic, it seems to me, is not that we hold different
positions. What is problematic is the way the issue itself is sidelined, not realizing the
fundamental aspect of some of the assumptions at play—such attitude simply renders the view’s
problematic aspects invisible to its defenders. Or better, in not realizing the definitional
character of the foundations to their approach, the standard view cannot treat but as off-topic
several well-based criticisms that do not share its language.
In this context, I hold, in contrast to the standard theory of perception, that there are
perhaps no heftier issues in the metaphysics of perception than the relationship between objects
in the world and our perception of them, between objects and their appearances. To claim that
the connection between perception and world is to be established beyond appearances and with
the aid of extra-perceptual contributions because appearances can be deceitful is a petitio
principii. It is to say that the connection between perception and world is contingent, i.e. that we
can’t be sure we’re not being deceived because we can be sometimes deceived by perception.
It may sound heavily counterintuitive that I call the possibility of perception to be deceitful
into question. Who has not believed a surface to be of a different color it turned out to be? Who
has not seen an object of a certain size to change its apparent size as one moves away from it?
Who has not seen circle look elliptical? When we come to see the reasons underlying this
21 Chalmers rejects the disjunctivist insight according to which a veridical perception and a perfect hallucination do not have a common ‘phenomenology’ (i.e. he denies disjunctivism about phenomenology). In other words, he affirms that there is a common factor between (paradigmatic cases of) a hallucination and a perception. He claims to be neutral on what he calls disjunctivism about metaphysics (whether experiencing and hallucinating are metaphysically different), a point on which we radically disagree, and on disjunctivism about content (whether the experience case and the hallucination case share content, partly or not at all), a point on which we partly agree but for quite different reasons.
146
‘intuitional’ understanding of perception, we will see why such ‘intuition’ not only need not be,
but must not be, and should instead be replaced by an understanding that rejects any idea to the
effect that the senses deceive and theorizes these cases as a function of appearances, in an
entirely positive way.
The idea that perceptions can be deceitful is evident to most philosophers of perception, in
a way they qualify as a strong ‘intuition.’ This seemingly naïve view brings along an entire
conceptual world with it. But should it be held as self-evident intuition, and not as an argument
that can be attacked? Let us revisit the initial framework and see if I can offer an interpretation
of the issue of deception that speaks in favor of my ‘looking at perception in its own terms’ and
against their framework.
Consider a bona fide or minimal good case of visual perception. It need not even be a ‘perfect’
perception (whatever that could exactly mean). You can even consider a case of what is
normally referred to as perceptual error or illusion. Just your regular perception of something
you look at. Consider that you look at a table, just like Hume did (1977, 104–105). Let’s call each
specific perception P1, P2, P3, and so on. There is a perfectly meaningful claim to the effect that
there are differences in the way the table looks as you move in relation to it, not only in size but
also in shape, or in the way its colors looks (which Russell keenly noted). This much is true. The
question is how far can one go with this cursory description of the phenomenon, and how much
one can derive from it.
Philosophers of different sensibilities might cash out this phenomenon in the following
way: that these differences mean that our perception of objects may or may not correspond to the
way things are. The inference-based claim (normally sold as an intuition) is that perception is
not necessarily faithful to the way the world is. I now want to make clear some of the
assumptions that are operative in the articulation of the intuition and call them into question. I
want to dispel the idea that the ‘intuition’ at stake here is theoretically noncommittal, but rather
a conclusion with loaded and doubtful premises, and should thus be rejected.
147
A central reason why one could cash out the phenomena in these terms relies on operating
on binary and atomistic terms. Either we perceive the thing as it is, or as having a quality it
has—unchanged—or we don’t. If we do, our perception is veridical; if not, our perception is
non-veridical. Second, on the standard view, the right interpretation when we say we perceive
something over time is to say that we rather see a sequence of individual perceptions. Or at
least, that on the right analysis we should find no contradiction with a scenario described as a
sequence. Hume’s position is certainly extreme in this sense, but its spirit remains on the
standard view (or even necessitated by such view): “[Our senses] convey to us nothing but a
single perception, and never gives us the least intimation of any thing beyond” (2000, 126).
Now, the object looked to us in more than one way when we compared P1, P2, and P3.
Only provided, as Ayer would insist, the identity and permanence of the object, states P1, P2,
and P3 claiming to be based on the object, i.e. deriving its intrinsic character on the object,
would not be warranted in claiming being so grounded, for if that were the case, P1, P2, and P3
would be the same. From this one concludes that perception is not a necessarily getting in touch
with the way things are. We cannot rule out that an exclusive disjunct of P1, P2, and P3 could
be true, so that one of them would be veridical, but we must rule out that an inclusive
disjunction of the three, or a conjunction of at least two differing (in the same respect) single
perception could come out true.
What we get is that in our perceptions of the world, veridical perception is only
contingently veridical. The reasons for its veridicality cannot be only perceptually warranted,
but need inferential backing-up—a thesis Hume explicitly states and Kant criticizes in the
paralogisms. Perceptually alone we can’t assess the exclusive disjunction P1, P2, P3 to be true
or false. Lack of sameness in a sequence of perceptions is interpreted negatively, for in this
frame of mind what I have called a sequence of perceptions is a sequence happening in us, but
not a sequence grounded on the thing perceived. From here on the standard framework for
perception may take different shapes, but it keeps the desideratum of veridicality understood in
148
binary terms and operating upon discrete perceptions, and puts perception and perceptual
powers on the negative side of the veridicality desideratum’s ledger book.
But let’s step back and see the basic phenomenon and the purported implication. Is the
implication warranted in the phenomenon as described? The answer is no.
Being warranted or not in saying that the differences between moments of the perception
of a thing entail that perception does not necessarily tell the veridical story about reality hinges,
conceptually, on the truth of the conjunction of two premises, (1) and (2):
A distinction appearances/reality:
(1) Same-aspect perceptual variations in the perception of a thing are incompatible with
the reality of that aspect of the thing, such that they can’t be predicated without mistake of the same real object (only as-if of the same object).
A thesis about the persistence of real objects of a mind-independent world and their
properties:
(2) Objects and their properties (objects, events, and states of affairs) are mind-
independent realities.
Thesis (2) is underdetermined, though. Let us consider two big-stroke variants, as they
pertain to the issue of perception.
(21) Objects and their properties (objects, events, and states of affairs) are mind-independent realities and their properties and they are defined from an objective point of view, intellectual or scientific.22 (22) Objects and their properties (objects, events, and states of affairs) are mind-independent realities and yet it is not the case that they can be entirely defined from an objective point of view; the actual perceptual engagement of perceivers and communities of perceivers with worldly objects (perceptions that involve a vantage point of view, not only spatial but also temporal and pragmatic, plus situational features) are necessary for a full definition of worldly objects and their properties in their being perceived.
It is important to note that the viability of (1) may set constraints on (2) (a version of which
I accept), for if differences in appearance are intrinsically, non-inferentially compatible with true
22 Although Chalmers’s framework is basically the same as (21), he may need to add to it either that such objects and properties are thought of as perfect objects and properties instantiated in them, or even that they are perfect objects and properties of a metaphysically possible world with normative import.
149
being, then the reality of a mind-independent reality, as to its perceivable nature, cannot be
known in independence from the way it appears, which is my claim. If (1) were true, only (21)
would be compatible with it. The conjunction of (1) and (22) would be false by means of mutual
contradiction. If (1) were false, (22) can still be the case. I will be claiming that (1) is false, (21) is
false, and (22) is true.
Let’s look at (1). Substantively, the issue of the compatibility between appearances and
reality is, I claim, a thesis about the nature of perceivable things and the nature of the perceiving
of those things.23
As to the nature of perceivable things it is important to note that (1) entails that the
qualifications of objects can be defined in a fixed way, such that an object or property can only
be characterized in one way in a given respect, which it is referred to as the reality of the object
or property. In this framework, for appearances of object or properties to be actually revealing
of the nature of the real object, they must be able to be predicated in the same way objects and
properties themselves are. This naturally entails that multiplicity in a given respect is thought
of as not revealing of the real nature of an object or property.
Being able to meaningfully refer to a definition of the nature of the real objects and
properties is a necessary condition to pronounce appearances incompatible with it. But when we
analyze the nature of that definition of real being we run into a series of problems.
The true description of the real objects and its properties must be perceptually meaningful
in order to be relevant as a standard for comparison of perceptual appearances. This means that
the aspects that figure in the definition must be cashed out perceptually: this beverage is bitter,
this smell is sweet, the object is this big, and this coin is round. At the same time, the definition
23 Let’s restrict our domain to the domain of actual experiences. First, I am interested in objects perceivable by perceivers, for I define perception by what the type of actual sensory-mediated interaction with a world of objects, events and states of affairs that occur for animal perceivers on Earth, and, by extension, in a universe with the laws we know, as they apply to perceivers our relative size—and not, say, to microscopic beings. I am interested in the way objects, events, and states of affairs are actually perceivable, and not in the way in another metaphysically possible world things of who-knows-what nature would be ‘perceivable’ for subjects constituted who-knows-how, for that’s as if in studying the nature of empathy considering telepathy is considered helpful. I see no way of guaranteeing truths about perception that are not based on actual perceptions. Instead, I offer a rich theory of (this-world) perception and a theory of (this-world) appearances and of the experience of the objects that present themselves in appearances.
150
purports to be mainly non-perspectival, non-perceptually based. In other words, that the nature
of its reality is such that it is of such a shape, taste, smell, or size regardless of the position or
circumstances it is looked at from or in. Sure it is possible to give an objective description of
some perceptually related states of affairs, such that, for example, a table is square iff it is a four-
sided equilateral polygon. But this description, being perceptually relevant—that is, reflective of
at least a veridical perception, according to the standard framework—, is one that coincides or is
instantiated in one (or several), but not all, of the possible ways perspectives from which an
object appears. But then there is a claim that the right perspective is no perspective, that is, that is
not just one among many perspectives but the right one. The problem is: Where does the right
perspective derive its right character so it can claim to be more than a perspective? And the
problem again is that for it to be perceptually meaningful it must be something cashed out in
terms one can understand perceptually, and not, for example, in geometrical analysis or
scientific terms.
Ayer bites the bullet and says that the reality of the object is actually one appearance yet a
‘privileged appearance’. The case of color or shape seems to lend itself more easily to the
solution Ayer proposes. Some appearances (sense-data, in Ayers’ and Price’s framework), say
appearance K, are related to the rest of the appearances of a thing in a way that has more
predictive power, in the sense, that having sense-appearance K is more telling of the rest of
appearance possibilities of the object than other appearances (Ayer 1947, 263–274). It is not
difficult to think this is right considering certain shapes or colors, for it seems natural to talk
about a red-colored surface that is perceived more clearly red in one position and in broad
daylight, or a round figure that would look from certain points of view really round and not
elliptical, as when one looks at a coin in a way that the plane of one’s line of vision is
perpendicular to the plane of the surface of the coin.
I am not convinced that these two cases settle the matter, for the variety of appearances
provide only relative support to each other, as that one that attains the privileged appearance
151
status would not do so in the absence of the range of possibilities, and in that sense it is difficult
to see how this privileged appearance would count as the ‘reality’ of the object or property in
comparison to which other appearances derive their ‘mere appearance’ status.24 In other words,
it’s not clear to me that relative predictive power of one appearance in relation to a gamut of
other appearances can furnish that appearance the epistemological status it supposedly does.
The perspectival status of the privileged appearance, though privileged, prevents the definition
of the reality of objects or properties derived from it to acquire the strong status it is supposed
to possess, for it is based on this definition that differing appearances of the same object or
property are treated as not revealing of such true reality. In this sense the privileged appearance
strategy is self-effacing.
This is in fact connected to my agreement with a version of disjunctivism. The baseline for
SEP is only a minimal ‘good case’: that a perceiver actually interacts with an external object.
Cases of hallucination plus coincidence (the subject hallucinates “correctly” what is
coincidentally perceptually available to them) are ruled out because they are not perceptual. In
order to understand the significance of this minimal good case as a requirement it is appropriate
to compare it to what looks like a more stringent requirement but which falls prey to the
preconceptions derived from veridicality. This is what Siegel calls the superstrongly veridical
case: a certain property is perceived accurately in this case: “seeing o when o looks F, o is F, and
o’s looking F is due to o’s F-ness” (Siegel 2010, 37). I dispute this seemingly clear statement.
First, F is not necessarily predicable of o in the absence of the perceptual interaction (think of
the color of a pond as one walks around it), even if it is meaningful to talk in such terms. We
need a conception of (2) the F that belongs to the object is not the F that appears in the specific
profiles or perspectives that are presented in perception. Actually, in perception there are Fs—
F’, F’’, F’’’, etc.—, so the relation between F and F’,F’’,F’’’ is a one-many relation. These are the
properties I referred to earlier as perspectival properties or P-properties (Noë 2004, 82–83).
24 I endorse a positive sense of something like ‘privileged appearances,’ provided its status is correlative to the totality of appearances and the normativity that belongs to them, as I will touch upon in chapter 5 but elaborate in more detail in chapter 5.
152
The difference between P-properties and properties of the objects, events, and states of
affairs can further be specified thus: objects, events, states of affairs and their properties are
presented perspectivally in perception and can only do so. We are acquainted with F but only
via F’, F’’, F’’’, etc.25 If a perceptual presentation is only perspectival, a perfect presentation (F
as F) is an impossibility. Physical occurrences—e.g. material objects in their visual aspect but
also in their olfactory aspect—cannot be experienced by perceivers but in perspectival
sequences. To put in a somewhat counterfactual way: unless gods enjoyed an embodied
existence they would not perceive at all (Pietersma 2000, 62).
Further, there is a stronger objection to the idea of a privileged appearance standing for
reality. The objection is that it can’t stand a careful perceptual analysis in the cases of size or
complex shapes. It is also an objection to another argument against the direct perception of
objects and their properties, namely, the argument of the continuous series in which delusional
and veridical appearances take place (Ayer 1947, 8–9; Price 1950, 32). Consider a cow. “If I
gradually approach an object from a distance I may begin by having a series of perceptions
which are delusive in the sense that the object appears to be smaller than it really is” (Ayer
1947, 8). Suppose I am situated at 100 meters, 50 meters… 3 meters, 1 meter away from the
cow. At which one of those distances does the cow look as big as ‘it really is’? To ask that is foolish, and
extreme cases—looking at the cow at 1-millimeter distance from it or at a million kilometers
from it—cut no conceptual ice. And it is mistaken to assert then that there is such a thing as the
cow appearing or smaller or bigger than it is, for the cow appears always as big as it is relative to
my distance from it. Naturally the cow has certain dimensions (although for exact dimensions a
living being of this kind is not the best choice), but those dimensions, say height, cannot play
out perceptually in the manner needed for it to be a standard for reality. The cow having the
25 This is another way to make sense of the rejection of the traditional commitment to veridicality understood along binary lines (objects are presented as they are or they are not) and in discrete terms (at each moment it is possible to assess whether appearances match reality or not. Thus, 1) Both F’ and F’’ are Fs, in the sense that perceptual profiles actually reveal how things are, and 2) an F’, F’’, F’’’, etc. could not be assessed in isolation, but only as a part of a sequence, where F* is deviant, but only in relation to F’, F’’, F’’’, etc. A discussion of P-properties and their normative relation to the social and the pragmatic is undertaken in chapter 5.
153
dimensions it has is not incompatible with its looking of varying dimensions depending on the
location of the subject from it, so the appearances cannot be called incompatible according to a
standard of reality, as it is needed for the tree of illusion to have any purchase in this respect.
But insofar as the tree of Illusion was intended as a general objection to all varying appearances,
this counterexample works as an objection against the broader case.
An even stronger objection is this: What is the shape or figure of the cow, in terms of
privileged appearances? While the dimensions of the cow, say its height, were something we
could make sense as a potential standard (one that fails to be such for it cannot play out
perceptually but without perspective), I don’t think it possible to define the privileged
appearance or appearances of the shape of the cow. The issue seems to me intractable were we
discussing the shape of the cow in tactile terms: what would even count as a differing
appearance of the shape of the cow if I were to perceive its shape by touch, that is, by
movements of my arms and hands over the body of the cow?
It starts looking as if that the philosophical articulation of the distinction appearance-
reality is based on something analogous to a snapshot visual comparator, in which perspective is
built-into but managed to seem absent, thus making it ‘intuitive’ to say what corresponds to a
standard and what doesn’t. But even in a visual mode, it is impossible to make clear what a
privileged appearance capable of becoming a standard of reality —able to ban differing
appearances from intrinsically counting as actual perceptions of the thing—in the case of the
shape of a cow. Clearly one shot won’t do—neither two would. So a set of privileged
appearances would stand for the real shape qualities of the cow: are we to suppose that a set of
images of the cow, taken from different perspectives, won’t overlap in the way a part of the
animal’s body appears, thereby allowing in the ideal set conflicting appearances? It may be
argued at this point that the general point is rather theoretical and that no one is claiming that
‘privileged appearances’ are supposed to be potential real appearances of objects: real visual
perceptions, real touch perceptions, real smell perceptions. But if this is not the case, if the
154
standard for reality is not one that can be rendered in perceptually meaningful terms, on what
material basis can actual perceptions be deemed as non-veridical? They can’t, and the issue is
then that there are no reasons to think the required standard exempt from a careful
phenomenological, perceptually based analysis.
The shape of the cow, then, is such that it is perceived in varying appearances which the
concern for veridicality insists on considering merely contingent, for it counts with the
possibility of having a standard of reality that is fundamentally non-perspectival. But the non-
perspectival cow’s shape is impossible to conceive. Some might think that the idea is not of a
view from nowhere, but a view from everywhere: this is the sense in which Merleau-Ponty says
that the full object may be thought of as seen from everywhere: “the house itself is not the house
seen from nowhere, but the house seen from everywhere” (2002, 69). One may think that he
grants the house itself the status of an ideal object, composed of all perspectives, existing at
once. However, he insists on the spatial and temporal nature of the different perspectives, from
which we can conclude that a unity of spatial perspectives at one moment is impossible to
actually be the case. The idea of a house seen from everywhere brings to light the fact that to
conceive of the reality of an object in perceptually meaningful terms, e.g. as a perceptible
material object, is epistemologically dependent on perceptual categories. Merleau-Ponty has
also spoken of the perceptual field as a multiplicity of perspectives where things show
themselves to others (2002, 68–70). Only metaphorically inert things show themselves to
others; what the point brings to light is the dependence on the idea of an observer, for only an
observer has a point of view from where things are perceived. To speak again of our cow, the
idea is that truly to conceive of the cow as a totality would be to think of all the possible
perspectives from where all parts, sides, and aspects of the cow would appear.
Let me try to take this line of thinking one step further. If it is the case that all perceptions
are essentially incomplete, or in other words, that all perceptual relating to objects is never fully
achieved because there are always perspectives we have not taken, in which objects and their
155
properties would appear in ever so slightly differing ways (colors, forms, etc.), then we are
always fundamentally related perceptually to things as to things that are never given
completely and in which their potentialities are on the horizon, even if they are never fulfilled or
explored. This line of thinking is at the basis of the account of normativity I will be offering in
chapter 5.
Going back to the need for a standard of reality as necessary to the argument from illusion,
the point I want to highlight from Merleau-Ponty’s argument is the impossibility of conceiving
of a standard of reality that is perceptually meaningful (and to which individual appearances can
be compared to in order to be deemed veridical or delusional) and that does not have the
limitations and indeterminations proper of the appearances it is to be compared with, namely,
the “problem” of having, in Chalmers terms, “different colors and shapes at different times.” This
being the case, it does not seem that Ayer, Price, and Chalmers can really offer the type of
standard of reality needed to make the concern for veridicality take off. This point just reached,
by reduction, is paralleled, and more succinctly expressed, in Husserl’s idea that even a God
would see things in perspectives—where the absence of varying perspective amounts to the
absence of perceptions.
What looks seemingly neat in the case of a coin starts looking foolish when compared with
more real cases. The real world is more like cows than it is like coins in a two-dimensional
space. This argument aims at saying that the idea that the reality of an object or property can be
defined in terms of privileged appearances is inconsistent with a metaphysics of the material
world involving the spatiotemporal determination of occurrences. I can’t imagine what peculiar
metaphysics may render such a view not inconsistent.
A less conspicuous point relates to the status of our perceiving the different appearance
variations of one thing, to wit: the issue of compatibility between appearances (in the plural) and
reality (in the singular) only arises because a gulf is supposed between them as if they were two
different domains. This is why in such a view the direct objects of perception must be an inner
156
occurrence call them sense-data, sense-impressions, mental images, Fregean Sinne, or any other
name for traditionally conceived representations, detached from the world they arise from. This
implies that the mental representations stand in need of further confirmation, so that our
perception of the world is understood as a double process: a sensory input followed by a
judgment or inference.
For example, when one has a phenomenally red experience as of an object in one's environment, this can be used as grounds for accepting a belief that there is a red object in front of one. One would not normally call this relation between experience and belief an "inference," but it can be seen as a sort of quasi-inferential relation. Just as with belief, the inferential role of a perceptual experience can be analyzed in part by asking: when given information about how things are in the world, will a subject accept or reject the perceptual experience? (Chalmers 2006, 98–99)
This is a good illustration of the way of looking at perception based on veridicality. It is
natural in this framework to require an inferential step that brings together different,
intrinsically incompatible, appearances. Also important is the conception of the perceiver behind
this theory, namely, the idea of a thinker. I have no space to expand it here, but what is worth
noting here is the erroneous idea that in relating perceptually to things one is always rationally
active and in control, always comparing, inferring, deducing. It is Ayer’s idea that while in
perception there is no deduction for no specific instances can count as a universal, we must be
engaged in induction, still reaching conclusions but not of the kind that provides certainty
(1947, 39–40). In contrast, I have in mind a perceiver that is engaged with the world, not in the
mode of judging, but in the manner that pertains specifically to perception: an engagement with
the world that is immersed in the world, takes implicitly its structure for granted, and actively
relates to it in a very immediate and involved way. While I do not intend this last line of
thought as an argument against (1), it seems to me rather clear that such a notion is at work in
our conceptualization of perception, and that this image of us is erroneous.
This way of looking at our perceptual involvement with the world has some problems. One
of them is that it over-intellectualizes the perceptual process, making it more mysterious the
157
cognitive continuity between non-human animals and humans, distinctions between fully-abled
and disabled human beings (extending to issues such as the relation between perceivers and the
world, and, ultimately, deep issues about our nature as perceivers, thinkers and emotional
beings). On the other hand, it removes the sense of immediacy that we find in perception and
which is central to sequential, instantaneous activities, such as the acrobat in the circus.
3.4.1 In Virtue of Appearances, Not In Spite of Them
I have been arguing that (1) is false, namely, that it is not the case that differing same-aspect
appearances are incompatible with the reality of real objects and their properties. I have been
also taking a position regarding (2) the mind-independent status of objects, events, and states of
affairs and their properties in relation to perception. I have rejected the interpretation of it
according to which such realities, if perceptually meaningful, can be objectively defined (21). I
defend interpretation (22). Thus, I hold that the mind-independent objects and their properties,
as perceived, cannot be fully defined in an objective manner alone, but that the actual perceptual
engagement of perceivers with them furnishes part of their full definition.
There is a world independent of us and we perceive it. I do not claim that there is no fixed
reality that we perceive. There is such a thing as ‘the way things are.’ There is more to what
there is than the way things are. Even more, all that there is about things is not limited to the
way things are by themselves. From the get-go, for an object, event or state of affairs to be
perceivable means to stand in one-many relation to the appearances in which it appears to
subjects specifically configured and situated. There is no leaving out “reference to properties”
for a view like mine in order to oppose the veridicality-structure notion of content, as Siegel
implies (Siegel 2010, 29).
I do not question then the possibility of being mistaken about something, like when it’s dark
and one sees a dark brown object that turns out to be a dark blue navy object. Or like when a
voice sounds like our friend’s but turns out to be a stranger’s. It makes sense to say ‘it turns out
to be X, not Y.’ By the same token, I hold that it is often the case that one is unsure about the
158
exact characteristics of the perceptual object in a given aspect, for the aspect appears unclear to
one, like when Descartes refers to a square tower that sort of looks rounds in the distance. But
these cases are properly interpreted not as incompatible between appearances and reality, hence
not as being veridical or nonveridical. I instead interpret these as occurrences in the complex
warp of normativity that constitutes perception.
What others call fallibility, or what they express as perception being deceitful, I interpret
and articulate in terms of degrees of fulfillment of perceptual expectations and of pragmatic
significance that is a function of the actual relation or interaction between perceivers and a rich
theory of appearances—not as a separation between perception and world. This notion of
normativity is not about bridging a gulf, for such a gulf does not exist, but about making
explicit many ways in which appearances can vary consistently and along several dimensions,
such as indeterminations on the part of the object, situational/environmental features, the
relative object-perceiver location (spatially, temporally, and pragmatically) the constitution of
the perceiver at the moment, and the specific nature of the perceptual engagement. The product
will be a theory in the spirit of a radically positive, affirmative theory of perception and
appearances.
The idea of an appearance or profile is the idea of a partial manner in which worldly
perceivable objects, events, and states of affairs can only present themselves directly, in their
being physically constituted, for spatiotemporally and pragmatically situated perceivers. To
perceive an object or being directly acquainted with it means to perceive or be directly
acquainted with ‘one’ appearance or profile, or with a ‘sequence’ or ‘system’ of the appearances
or profiles that are possible for that object, in manners that are holistically coherent in regards to
the intrinsic configuration of the object (from micro to macrophysical structure), the specific
disposition of the object in its environment, and to the modes of perceptual acquaintance (i.e.
roughly sensory modalities plus modes of interaction) that pertain to the object and to the
interaction object-perceiver, as reflected in specific configurations of contents, structure in the
159
manner that the present chapter suggests. In this framework there is absolute no conflict in
saying that seeing in this moment a by-now-disappeared star is the only way for that star to be
seen, in its existence at moment t1, by a perceiver situated so far away that she sees at t1+n
years.
We perceive objects, events, and states of affairs in the world not despite the differences in
specific appearances but thanks to them. The absence of factual variations, which the standard
theory would require for a series of perception to be necessarily of the same object, would, in
fact, be a counterfactual confirmation of the view I am endorsing. If the habitual variations in
the perception of a physical occurrence would not take place, according to the modality in which
it occurs, would be evidence that we do not actually perceive the object we perceive. This view
somehow begins with the idea that “the same unchanged Objects appear, according to the
changing circumstances, now in this way, now in another way” (Husserl 1989, 64, <58>), and
the whole gamut of ways in which the same object can appear carries normative force.
On this view, hallucination is cut out from the beginning. Illusion, as I will explain later,
will be treated not truth-functionally but re-described as a type of perceptual contingency that
carries no threat, and that is subsumable under the epistemic purview of experience itself, as it
follows from the theory of appearances that I started developing in the previous chapter.26
26 I said that Chalmers denies disjunctivism about phenomenology, and claims to be neutral on what he calls disjunctivism about metaphysics, and on disjunctivism about content. I hold that disjunctivism about metaphysics is true by definition, and is also confirmed by both hallucinatory and perceptual experiences, insofar as these aren’t experiences isolated from the totality of our experiential life. I hold that to deny “disjunctivism about phenomenology” is underdetermined because the standard conception of “the phenomenology of x” is too thin to capture the way things look. A proper definition of the way things look—as I started accounting for in the previous chapter—implies that while hallucinations and illusions may have the same character as to an aspect of an object or its properties in a momentary abstraction, the temporally extended, contextually-dependent, internally-coherent structure of appearances in which ‘phenomenology’ consists cannot be common to a hallucination and a perception. In other words, it is only trivially true there is something in common in the color of trees when I see them than when I dream of them—namely, that I can answer ‘green’ to question ‘What color are the trees?’ and also pick an object of the same color in the environment (engage in discriminatory behavior)—, but this ‘commonality’ does not translate in any serious sense in the nature of perception. I take disjunctivism about content to be true in the relevant sense, for the objects and its aspects are constitutional of the experience, therefore of content. I add that disjunctivism about content is false in the same rather trivial sense that dreamt of and perceived trees ‘are’ green.
One reason that makes disjunctivism both about content and about phenomenology true in my view is that I deny that there is a real distinction between them. In my theory both (‘content’ and ‘phenomenology’) are grouped under the same heading: perceptual content, which is a specification of the nature of objects perceived as they are perceived and of the ways in which such objects are presented to a perceiver.
160
In mainstream views, talk of content simply supervenes on experience (Chalmers 2006, 65).
In my view, experience is constitutive of content. To hold philosophically the ontological
priority of experience is to say not only that perceptual experience explains our thinking about
the world; rather, that it is that that it partly constitutes our thinking about the world. Further, it
is not only that perceptual experience constitutes perception itself and is, when suitable,
constitutive of our thinking about the world, but that it also partly constitutes our acting upon the
world. In these cases, I mean constitutive in the sense that what is explained is not only how
something came to be, but what it is or came to be.
Let us go back to Eden and look at it as one looks at a mirage that one knows it is so.
Chalmers’s strategy was to contrast the actual world with a hypothetical perfect world, in
which the actual world appears deficient, in order to render this world deficient in virtue
precisely of not being like the hypothetical perfect world.
My own strategy takes the perceptual world as it appears in perceptual experience and
investigates the conditions and structure of precisely our perceiving the world. Insofar as I need
no hypothetical world to make sense of the actual, neither the actual world is not a deficiency
nor am I itching for a fix that would take my perceptions and turn them into some alien
standard of perfection.27
The desideratum for veridicality understood as a demand for ideality is dropped and
replaced by a broader notion of normativity. In SEP’s view, perceivers are able to situate
perceptual interactions in relation to expectations and possibilities. Perceptual normativity is about
situating perceptual occurrences in terms of their pragmatic significance and of degrees of
fulfillment of expectations, as I started to elaborate in chapter 1 (section 1.2.4). This move is in
keeping with my examination, in the last chapter, of Augustine’s strategy, where I showed in a
slightly different way how an ideal notion—truth, in that case—is an idealization of what
perception actually presents us with. I have intended to build a strong case for an account that
27 The narrative I’ve offered is quite analogous to Nietzsche’s How the Real World at last Became a Myth in his Twilight of the Idols; a piece of his antiplatonic reaction to the idea that this world is not the real world.
161
takes perception for what it is, and not for what it supposedly lacks. The desideratum
concerning the presentational character of appearances is re-interpreted, not as a desideratum
anymore, but as the actuality of perception and in terms of a thoroughly positive, this-worldly
theory of appearances. In this context the presentational character of perception is properly
explained by a social enactive theory of perception, that shares some elements with relational,
directly realist views.28
Lastly, it may be objected that I am taking the idea of Eden too far: that clearly Chalmers
does not think that there was an Eden and we fell from it. That much is clear, though. Critics
might say that in refuting Chalmers I have, at best, only made implausible the use of the myth,
but not the deep philosophical reasons to hold perception accountable to a non-perceptual
standard of veridicality. But my critique has been about the rationale that moves his little myth.
If Chalmers has provided an ad hoc way of understanding perceptual content—if it is just an
ideal language to talk about perception (very much in the way Ayer saw his own sense-data
project) in order to account for the features that need accounting—my critique stands. In
objecting to the motivations underlying the desiderata about content, and in showing the
tensions in this account regarding the real world, I have provided reasons to reject his full
account of content.
The set of objections I have offered in this chapter shows the characterization of Eden to be
mistaken and concludes that the upshot of the Fall is not a rational one. In the crafting of Eden,
28 Schellenberg (Forthcoming; 2011) has recently argued that the perception is both relationalist and representationalist. I do not rule out the possibility of granting perceptual representations an ad hoc sense, as a way in which we could refer to what we perceive for instrumental purposes. Strictly speaking, representations must ultimately be entirely deflated. I say deflated and not eliminated, for the project of modeling the mind and modeling perceptual systems for instance for AI purposes may require such language. Recent developments in AI show that relationalist concepts are much needed for a robot that is able to dynamically perceive. Simaan and others have been working on ‘complementary situational awareness’: “the robot’s ability to gather sensory information as it works and to use this information to guide its actions” (Simaan, quoted by Salisbury 2013). In my framework, however, the instrumental, not constitutive, character of this situational awareness is tied to its representational basis (understandably so) and is linked to the fact that only original perceivers—living beings—are capable of having the original intentionality present in perceptual consciousness.
Further, as I will be arguing in this and the next two chapters, the casting of content constitutively (and not just instrumentally) in pragmatic terms is at odds with representational tenets. My rejection of the fundamental character of representations, which the entire project supports, allows me further to distinguish my view from Schellenberg’s (with whom I agree on several interesting points, albeit for different reasons), as well as from other relationalists, like Campbell, and other enactivists, like Noë (or even Schellenberg’s enactive ‘capacities’ approach).
162
a notion of perfection is embedded in the actual workings of perception and deemed deficient. In
accepting Eden as it is presented, one is already accepting the diagnosis of the Fall, for they are
correlative notions. Having showed that we have every reason to reject the idea of the Eden, I
have in the same way showed that we have every reason to reject any view that shares the axis
ideality-illusion-veridicality as the underlying understanding of the perceptual world.
Chalmers’s account of perception is of no use in trying to advance our understanding of
perception, except, and this becomes its virtue, as a way of looking at what perception is not and
at the way philosophy of perception should not proceed.
Chapter IV
Dynamic Content in The Social Enactive View
In the Social Enactive view, perceptual content is the notion subordinate to perceptual
experience that specifies that which perceptual experiences are about. I use experience and content
to refer to perceptual experience and perceptual content, unless noted. In this chapter, I build what I
call a dynamic account of content on top of the work of the previous two chapters, where I dealt
with the notion of experience (chapter 2) and with the relation between experience and content
(chapter 3). I departed from representational views on content and argued that content refers to
that which experience is about: it is an issue of the aboutness of experience. I proposed that
content derives from, or is ‘molded’ by experience. Putting experience-content in a model-mold
relation is meant as a way of signaling that to understand what an experience is about amounts to
a great extent to understand what to experience perceptually is in the first place, and as a
methodological device in the sense that content allows us to see things about experience that
aren’t observable from the point of view of experience alone. Because of this relationship, the
scaffolding for the conception of content I am to articulate more precisely in this chapter
consists in the argumentation about experience offered in the previous two chapters. In
particular, it should be noted that my full-fledged argument about veridicality in relation to
experience and content—an argument against the concern for veridicality—appears in chapters
2 and 3. The task I take up in this chapter is to distil the lessons from chapters 2 and 3 to make
the central constraints on the idea of content explicit and offer a parsing of content that honors
the account of experience already offered. The next chapter will be devoted to an account of the
normativity of perceptual experience and content.
In the view I am presenting, experience defines what aboutness is: aboutness is the relation
between an experiencing subject and the experienced object, such that the subject’s experience is
164
about the object, and in the concrete way in which it is experienced. Perceptual content is a
specification of what is experienced, in the way it is experienced.1
Within the social enactive theory of perception I am proposing—a relational, or rather
interactive social externalism—the notion of content should satisfy some desiderata. The first
one is a desideratum about phenomenology—understood in the thick sense I use. Since in my
view perceptual experiences are about temporally extended continua, this specification of
contents, which I term dynamic, explains the transitions and other relations among moments of
such perceptual continua, as well as the relations of those sequences with the objects, events,
and states of affairs that we experience perceptually, including the high-level, pragmatic-based
properties that we find in them.2
Second, perceptual experience constitutes the ground of our being conscious of things
phenomenally, both terms of action and, sometimes, predicatively (propositionally) and
emotionally. Perceptual content, then, must provide partial explanations and justifications of
what in each case is the object of our perceptions and actions, of our thoughts and emotions.
Thus, content as specification of aboutness also has an explanatory and justificatory role, which
in general follows this formula: we are perceptually aware of things (we act on things, we think
of things, we feel in relation to things) partly because we perceive things in specific manners; so
the way perceive them explains and justifies the ways we are aware of them, act upon them,
think of them, and feel about them.3
1 In not using the intentionality idiom, I am purposefully setting aside traditional understandings of what intentions and intentional objects are and what theoretical roles they are expected to perform. Particularly, I am not buying into the idea that all intentional objects play the same role, for that disregards specific types of intentionality and their objects. 2 See chapter 2 for an argument for high-level properties. In relation to properties in general, there can be a further metaphysical question about whether events are basic or only a construction on properties of objects, hence whether perception of events is of the event or of properties of objects: “the noisy police car coming towards me now” or “there is something about the noisy police car and that is that it’s coming towards me now.” My suggestion, following my argument on the pragmatic dependence of objectivities and properties at the end of chapter 2, is for the interests of theorizing about perception, there is no fact of the matter, and the specification of objects or events and their properties highly depends on the way in which the subject takes position about a worldly reality. In the next section, I touch upon this issue when I talk about perceptual intentionality and its particular variations and the way they partly determine the object-as-perceived. 3 I do not include a constraint of reasonability in this desideratum: the idea that perception grounds what it is ‘reasonable’ to believe, to do, or to feel, as Siegel does (as well as several standard takes on perception) (2010, 9). This and related issue are pursued in greater detail in chapter 5.
165
In section 1, I sift the account of experience and the account of the relation between
experience and contents of chapters 2 and 3 in order to draw general constraints on content.
This taking of stock allows me, first, to make the case for taking a perceptual continuum or
perceptual sequence, and not a static object, as the paradigm of the perceptual object; and
second, to account for the distinction between perceptual object and perceptual content in terms
of the perceptual object and the object-as-perceived. Note that in the expressions perceptual object and
object-as-perceived I use ‘object’ as a placeholder for objects (proper), events, and states of affairs
to which we are perceptually related. I then provide an argument for the perceptual
intentionality at work in object-as-perceived and finish the section by highlighting the non-
detachable, world-involving character of perceptual content in the Social Enactive View.
Section 2 is the core of this chapter, where I proceed to offer a parsing of perceptual
content. Perceptual content must reflect, on the one hand, the stability (and at times unity) of
perceived objects, events, and states of affairs; on the other, it must reflect the dynamism of
perception, in which unities are embedded. This makes up for an account of dynamic content
that is multilayered and pragmatically dependent, and structurally four-fold. As as to its nature
(1), content is constituted by the real, worldly objects and the object-as-perceived, the latter
being the main specification of content; as to its structure, content is parsed into (2) core-content
and (3) environing-content; and (4) environing-content extends all the way down to the very
moment of acquaintance or contact of a perceiver with properties of the physical world.
In section 3 I discuss an objection raised by Drummond to the effect that a view of content
that takes perceptual continua as perceptual objects is committed to phenomenalism. I reply to
this objection arguing that the parsing of content proposed (full=core+environing) is not
committed to a part-whole structure and can hence guarantee the reality and stability of the
world.
166
4.1 Object and Content: The Relation Between Perceptual Object and Object-As-
Perceived
In this section I would like to take stock from the accounts of perceptual experience and its
relation to chapters 2 and 3, hence also offering an argument for the distinction between
perceptual object and object-as-perceived.
To perceptually experience temporally extended continua featuring external objects,
events, and states of affairs is to engage in a sensory-based active manner with worldly objects,
as they come, are available for interaction, and go; in their coming, being available for
interaction, and going away.4 This spatially and temporally extended interaction with objects is
pragmatically constituted in ways that are more often than not socially constituted. Perception
takes places in practices, as chapter 1 accounted for, so perception appears in the richly defined
description of situations like tasting a meal or visually following a soccer ball as it comes
towards me and I prepare to kick it, and not properly about ‘detecting’ the shape of the spherical
volume. SEP follows Hurley (1998) in rejecting the input-output picture, that is, the view that
perception equals causal sensory input, upstream of motor output. I will explore these aspects in
chapter 5 where this argument will be linked to the broader idea that perceptual interaction
grounds other types of engagement with the world, such as action (not motor output), thought,
and emotion.
In this conception perception is direct and is also mediated by three main different types of
dependencies that I introduced in chapter 3: idiosyncratic (facts of personal and species
embodiment, and otherwise idiosyncratic), socially pragmatic, and non-socially pragmatic.5
Hence, the social enactive view is entirely at odds with the notion that there can be an
unmediated contact between subject and objects. More specifically, the Social Enactive view is
committed to a distinction between object properties and perceived properties: objects, events,
4 Unless explicitly stated, ‘object’ is used as a placeholder for objects, events, and states of affairs. When talking about actual objects (the ambulance siren, the car), I will talk of ‘physical object.’ 5 Cf. chapter 3, section 3.3.1.
167
states of affairs and their properties are presented perspectivally in perception and can only do
so. The mediation of these dependencies plays a role in the appearing of objects.
External objects, events, and states of affairs cannot be experienced by perceivers but in
perspectival sequences, according to the perception-relative dependencies. Thus, in perception,
we are acquainted with pragmatically governed temporally extended continua.
Take the Bicycle Ride example. When I ride my bicycle to work, there is a sense in which
the perceptual object is the whole continuum made up by the changing road, the many cars
parked and moving, the building, signs, and people I pass by, the different thermic sensations in
my skin, my touching the wind, and the smells around me. Granted, if the ride lasts for 25
minutes, we are less inclined to talk about the whole ride as one continuum, but at least when I
am going down a two-block long slope, the whole perception of things through the two-block
distance can be confidently pronounced one continuum. So as I ride, I perceive people and
objects around me. I can, for instance, move so as to avoid another cyclist.6 I truly perceive
them, but there is also a sense in which the object of, say, my visual perception is not just one
object and then another and then another. Rather, the object of my perception can be the
sequence itself in which objects present themselves, as they succeed one another, and as I feel
the crisp cold air and the smell of a rainy early morning. I often remember rides precisely in
terms of the moving sequence. It would be contrary to my experience to say that I never
experienced the sequence for all there was was a sequence of static moments.
In chapters 2 and 3 I approvingly quoted Husserl saying that perceptual continua could be
thought of as chains of “resting perceptions, unified by transitional phenomena, in which various
sides and parts of the thing present themselves in a stable way” (1997, 83, 76, <98,89>). I must
make that assertion more precise: while we can think of perceptual continua as made of resting
parts and sides, these parts and sides are not accurately characterized as static either. On the
one hand, they are embedded in pragmatically governed continua and contexts, so their status
6 Chapter 5 will revisit the Bicycle Ride example, but with an emphasis on the “systematic dynamic interdependence of perception and action, with multiple channels of motor-to-sensory feedback” (Hurley 1998, 302) at play, for example, in avoiding another cyclist or taking a curve by a turn of the handle bars.
168
as independent entities is contingent upon the perceptual relation. It was in this sense that in I
elaborated, in chapter 2, upon Husserl’s insight that perceptual unities are not simply detected,
but rather 'posited,' that is, objectivated or individualized as they are grasped.7 The thought that
must warded off is the following: that the objects of perception can be individualized and defined
before the perceptual relation takes place, and that it is proper to define them (including their
parts, sides, and aspects) in the terms we normally refer to them, as when we talk of a building’s
façade and its sides and roof. Whether those objects of the world are the objects of our
perception, and whether their architecturally or otherwise defined sides or parts feature in our
perception, it is all a matter of the perceptual activity itself that may or may not focus on them,
defined this way, in their ‘worldly’ independence. On the other hand, it is sometimes the case
that there are no parts or sides that we can categorically pinpoint (or at least not in a way that
can categorically refer to a pre-existing static configuration of things), as is the case of the
inattentive onlooker, the person that inattentively watches the country passing by while riding a
car or a train.
When I listen to a song in order to enjoy it, or to someone speaking so as to understand
what she is saying, the object of my perception is the song or the conversation, coupled with
whatever background noise there is, but both song and conversation are continua of sounds—
and it would be a confusion to say that the actual perceptual objects are isolated sounds—even if
there is a level of subpersonal processing that takes up sounds in chunks (as in vision, as we
know because of motion pictures). Even when we contemplate an object, say, for aesthetic
enjoyment, the object is present to us in an extended manner. First, eyes explore objects in fast
movements known as saccades, placed inside a head that moves, and atop a body that moves too.
But also, the specific shifts in attention that make up for the contemplation of the objects are not
random but guided by the (in this case) contemplative intention and the object itself. In the case
of taste, liquids or solids move inside the mouth, and these movements may matter or not, and it
is standard practice to take the time to enjoy a piece of chocolate by letting it slowly melt in 7 Cf. chapter, 2, section 2.3.3.
169
one’s mouth, for the experience is different than that of a fast biting the chocolate. In olfaction,
we sniff and take in waves of air, and it is a learned practice to sniff something intently yet softly
to be delighted by it: one does not typically explore the faulty trash can in that way. These
observations are available to any perceiver, reflecting on her perceptual experience as it occurs
in everyday life. They illustrate that the natural objects of perception are continua, embedded in
pragmatic interactions, which guide perceptual attention and perceptual awareness (and, as
chapter 5 will show, also the connections between perception and action, thought, and emotion).
These two commitments, (1) perspectival appearing and (2) the temporal extendedness of
perceptual objects, further buttress the claim that to perceive something is to perceive it as
something. It is a take on reality since reality is perceived in a particular manner or aspect. If the
perspectival appearing of things allows for the same object to appear to the same or different
perceivers in various manners, the difference in each perceptual take would not be due to the
intrinsic materiality of the object (or event or state of affairs), but would belong to the
perspectival appearing. Noë is right in remarking that we generally don’t put much attention to
perspectival properties and variations in them, but that once we turn our attention to them, it is
plain to every perceiver that there are differences in different perceptions of the same object, and
that other perceivers may have slightly (or significantly) different takes on same objects (2004,
83). If we focus on the temporally extended aspect of the way things appear it is even clearer
that our contact with things is not just an impression of an object itself, but a take on it.
On the one hand, then, we agree that there exist differences in the particular ways in which
things are presented to us, as a function of perceptual dependencies and expressed in
perspectival properties and perceptual continua. On the other, it is part of the perception of
things that in each case we are acquainted with the external object, event, or state of affairs. As
different philosophers in the phenomenological tradition have insisted on, it would be a mistake
to say we are only acquainted with the individual perspectives in which objects are presented.8
8 See also (Noë 2004, 76).
170
In both cases, we are dealing with the direct perception of an object. The difference I would
like to introduce now, following these distinctions, is that what we perceive, that is, the content of
perception is two-fold: on the one hand, the external object that we perceive is an aspect of
perceptual content, which I will call the perceptual object; on the other, the specific way in which the
object is presented to us—which I will call the object-as-perceived—is also an aspect of perceptual
content. Perceptual content then is composed of both the perceptual object and by the object-as-
perceived. This point is about the nature of perceptual content, which only partly maps onto the
discussion on the structure of perceptual content that I address in section 4.2 below.
The Ambulance Siren. I work near a hospital, and it is quite common to see ambulances
going by with their sirens on. When I hear an ambulance siren getting closer to where I am and
then going away, it is the ambulance siren itself that I hear, and as such it is part of the content
of my perception. The perceptual object can be thought of as an answer to a what question. But it
is also true that I hear the siren in specific ways and that those ways are also part of the content
of my perception. For instance, the sound gets louder (and seemingly higher in pitch, due to the
Doppler effect) if the ambulance is coming towards me, but becomes lower (and seemingly lower
in pitch) and fades away if it’s going away. Those are two different ways of hearing the same
ambulance siren. The object-as-perceived can be thought of as an answer to a how question,
because, once again, I do not only hear the siren: I hear the siren of an ambulance, as it goes
away, and in that going away there are specific characteristics that I am aware of (or can be if I
turn my attention to them), and also characteristics that are linked with other aspects (actional,
propositional, emotional) of my perceptual interaction with my surroundings.
In fact, I am not a passive receiver vis-a-vis the ambulance siren. My perceptual relation to
it is best described as an interaction. There is much more about my perceptual experience of the
siren than my location relative to it. In order to understand the siren as an object-as-perceived
we need to account more fully for my interaction with it. I now bring to the fore the three
constitutive dependencies of perception presented in chapter 3 (cf. section 3.3.1).
171
I am interacting with the ambulance siren even though I do not act in a very hands-on way,
as I acted towards the cyclist I was avoiding in the Bicycle Ride case. But this also makes it a
good example: it will give me a chance to signal that perceptual interaction is not only a direct
manipulation, but it is the form of every sensory-based experience of the world. Because sirens
are loud and unpleasant to hear, it is common for a person to avoid somehow or try to minimize
the exposure to the sound, for example, by covering their ears or even slightly turning the head.
But a case of a more evident perceptual interaction with the siren is not difficult to find. Suppose
I am walking down the street with a friend of mine, and we are talking about something
important; perhaps I was confiding something to him. Although I don’t see people I know
around us, I lower my voice a bit—it’s not just caution, fearing someone would hear the
confidence, and we both understand that a piece of sensitive information is coming. That is the
moment when the ambulance siren comes towards us. Surprised at first, we see where the
ambulance is coming from and then hear it getting increasingly louder, and apparently higher in
pitch. I stop telling my story, waiting for the ambulance to pass. I stop in the middle of the
sentence, prompted by a subtle gesture in his face that I interpreted as “I can’t hear you very
well” and wait until the noise has gone considerably low before I resume. My friend understood
my pausing and waiting; there is no surprise in him. I also noticed that when the siren started to
get closer I could no longer hear the noise of the other cars and the voices of few people around
us, but now that the siren goes away, I can hear that background noise again. Let’s finish the
case by adding three more characters, a runner coming from behind us, and an arguing couple,
across the street but 50 meters behind my friend and me, which we noticed as we were walking.
They were arguing very loudly. When the siren came towards them, they didn’t stop but kept
yelling at each other, now at the top of their lungs, evidently upset and careless about what
other people could have thought. Of course, they did notice the ambulance because they had to
yell louder and louder, and their yelling seemed even louder after the ambulance had gone away.
172
What the Ambulance Siren case illustrates is, first, as I have already said, that the siren
itself is a perceptual object for my friend and me, the runner, and the arguing couple. The
perceptual object can be the same for people situated very differently, as in this case. Let us now
look at the differences in the object-as-perceived. The configuration of the object-as-perceived
varies according to the three constitutive dependencies of perception: the idiosyncratic
dependencies, the non-socially pragmatic dependencies, and the socially pragmatic dependencies.
For instance, the tone and loudness of the siren are mediated by the idiosyncratic
dependencies, that is, facts of the embodiment of each of the listeners and deep-seated personal
sensory-specific attentional habits or associations. Suppose that my friend experiences mild
hearing loss. For him, the siren is not as loud as it is for the others—and this he “knows” and is
part of his way of navigating the world (in taking clues from running cars, in setting music at a
higher volume). But by the same token, the moment at which he is unable to hear my soft-voiced
confidence comes sooner than it would for another person. That explains that although I was
cognizant of the ambulance siren and knew that I had to stop at some point, I didn’t think it was
so soon and it was a gesture of his that clued me to pause. In this sense, the perceptual
experience of the ambulance siren is mediated by an idiosyncratic dependency for my friend. For
the runner, listening to music through regular earphones (not the noise-cancelling type), would
also experience the noise of the ambulance siren—its unpleasantness, getting louder, and going
away--mediated by what would count as an idiosyncratic dependency because it affects her
initial sensory acquaintance with physical properties of the world. In this case, the idiosyncratic
dependency (additional to facts about her hearing system) is also partly formed by the way the
earphones and the music affect her listening to the siren. The idiosyncratic dependency, it must
be said, is also at work in the case of a person with average audition capacities and “good”
hearing conditions.9
9 As I noted in section 3.1, the average way of perceiving the world, as in “good” hearing, has no intrinsic normative value. It is conceptually arbitrary, although statistically significant.
173
The non-socially pragmatic dependencies refer to patterned links between actions and sensory
stimulation that do not belong to the socially constituted aspects of pragmatic interactions. In
the case of the ambulance siren, this type of dependency refers to variations in the way the
object is perceived due to environmental conditions product of the sensorimotor relations
between subject and object. In the ambulance siren case, the Doppler effect (that pitch seems to
get higher when the siren approaches one, and lower when the siren is going away) is a non-
socially pragmatic dependence, because it depends on the pragmatic relation between subject
and object.
Lastly, the perceptual experience of the ambulance siren is social-pragmatically mediated or
dependent in several ways. First of all, it is mediated in the fact that this perceptible object is, in
some social contexts, a siren. Societies have developed this loud object and positioned it on top
of certain vehicles so it emits noises configured thus-and-so, in intensity and frequency, to
ensure awareness of such vehicles in a relatively broad radium, on account of a socially accepted
urgency. A siren is a siren because it is loud and (for most) unpleasant—it is impossible not to
notice it in this negative way. In this sense, some gestures that can be seen as non-socially
pragmatic dependencies such as the so to speak instinctive reaction in relation to this sound
becomes a social mediation when my conversation with my friend is interrupted by it and a
gesture of his lets me know that the noise is now too loud for him to hear me.
It is appropriate to recall a central aspect a theory of perception must explain. A theory of
perception should not only explain the way things look in terms of some basic sensory
properties such as loudness or pitch—which are often reduced, but wrongly so, to the
perceptible side of a physical property of objects. As Krebs analysis of Wittgenstein’s take on
perception, a theory of perception must explain the connection between the sensory and the
significance of things for human existence: the fact that perceptible things are meaningful
aspects of “the world in its sensuous richness”, that is, in the way they appear to us, within
systems of references, of personal and communal histories that become rooted in the body
174
(Krebs 2010, 134). It is this domain of meaning that more often than not remains out of the
radar of ‘epistemizing’ or ‘scientist’ views, as Krebs puts it, reflecting on Wittgenstein’s lessons
on the perceptual.10 Such was also the view of Husserl and Merleau-Ponty, and it is one to
which the social enactive view fully subscribes.
Back to objects, notice however that the perceptual object is part of perceptual content in a
very general sense: when I hear the ambulance siren coming towards me, I hear the ambulance
siren. Period. By contrast, if we are to specify how the siren sounds to me I need to recur to the
siren-as-heard. For specifying the perceptual object, the object-as-perceived is the appropriate
notion and not the perceptual object. The notion of perceptual object simply points to that which I
perceive, without much ado. And yet, it is central to the Social Enactive view I am putting
forward (as well as to other enactivist, relationalist, and realist views), that the perceptual object
features squarely in a description of the perceptual content of an experience.11 I hear the
ambulance siren and I see another cyclist on the road—even though I cannot give any details
about the siren or the cyclist unless I talk about the way I hear the siren and see the cyclist.
4.1.1 Perceptual Intentional Relation and Object-As-Perceived
The reader may have noticed that the question “How do you perceive what you perceive?” is an
ambiguous one. Rather, it admits of two types of complementary answers. One refers to the
particular qualities with which the thing is presented: I perceive the ambulance siren as going
away, sound getting lower and fading in intensity. This I have captured under the heading
content, specifically under the rubric object-as-perceived.
10 Such is also a pragmatist view of James, Dewey, and Austin (and connected to the views of Wittgenstein) that Putnam echoes in saying that “if there was one great insight in pragmatism, it was the insistence that what has weight in our lives should also have weight in philosophy” (1999, 70). 11 Counterfactually put: to perceive a table does not mean to be acquainted with every aspect of the table. Not being perceptually acquainted with every aspect of the table does not mean not directly to perceive a table. Being perceptually acquainted with changing aspects of the table (due to environmental conditions, changes in the object, or in the relative perspective of the perceiver), even somewhat conflicting between them, does not mean not directly and truly to perceive the table. Perceptual object and object-as-perceived are distinct yet correlated notions, and both coexist in perception. Also, the somewhat simplicity of this commitment is thus expressed: “I perceive the physical thing, the Object belonging to nature, the tree there in the garden; that and nothing else is the actual object of the perceptual intention. A second immanental tree, or even an ‘internal image’ of the actual tree standing out there before me, is in no way given, and to suppose that hypothetically leads to an absurdity” (Husserl 1983, 219, <186>). One possible absurdity, relevant for the present purposes, is that several of the perceptually specific possible predicates of the actual perceptual object do not apply to an internal representation.
175
But logically prior to this answer, there is a more immediate one: I perceive the ambulance
siren auditorily, or visually. More abstractly, we can say that there is an adverbial or intentional
qualification at stake, one that is first of all sensory-modal (even multi-modal, like when I am
taking to someone, hence hearing and seeing), but one that can secondarily include emotional
and pragmatic aspects. For example, I thermally perceive how hot a hot beverage is, as I am
about to drink of it, in order to not burn myself; or I olfactorily perceive the old house, as I long
for the times I spent there several years back—in longing, I pause over specific smells, and
perhaps connect them with others or with memories, and may even try to find past sensations.
The Husserlian-inspired insight I am underscoring here—and the ground I want to secure
for the discussion to come in this chapter and the next--is that the specificity of content is also
partly arrived at through an analysis of the type of perceptually based intentional relation in
which it takes place. This account of perceptual content would in fact not be complete without
placing it within this broader perceptual intentional framework—which, to be sure, belongs to
the theory of experience I have endorsed. Descriptions of objects-as-perceived are ‘soaked’ with
specific perceptually based intentionalities: to speak of a seen object is grounded on what it is to
see: to relate to things using one’s own eyes, which pick things on the basis of light, reflectance,
that is, to be acquainted with visibilia. The linguistic point carries with it a deeper element: the
specificity of object-as-perceived derives substantively from the type of relation in which it is
perceived.
The object is singled out by the perceptual intention, but it is not just singled out: it is held
in a particular way, it is engaged under certain determinations, and it is taken up in specific
manners. In a broad intentional sense, Husserl refers to the object-as-intended as the noema of
an intentional relation; and to the type of relationship with the noema, he refers to as the noesis. 12
12 Intentional analysis takes many shapes. I think that the best intentional analysis so far originates from the work of Husserl, and is suitable for modifications and improvements. The reader may want to take a look at other intentional analyses, of which (Crane 2001) is a good introductory example. For the purposes of this paper, however, I wish to indicate that where other intentional analyses speak of aspectual shape as a way of accounting for the fact that things are for us in a certain way, Husserl’s phenomenology treats this aspectual shape as a very extended feature that allows and requires of much more analysis. The distinction between noesis and noema (as well as the further
176
Each ‘object’ of consciousness is made conscious in a specific way, of which perception, memory,
object-to-be-avoided, regret, and expectation are examples. Hearing the orchestra playing a
song is not the same as remembering the song played by the orchestra—and this not only
because the recollection cannot match the richness of the actual listening situation, but, for our
present purposes, because hearing something is different than remembering sounds in that in
hearing we are related to an occurrence of the world whereas in remembering we are related to
a memory. We know that to stop a sound from being heard we can plug our ears, but that is not
what we do when we want to stop remembering a sound.13
Let us now focus on perceptual intentionality. The analysis of concrete perceptual experiences
gains in depth from the idea that perceptual intentionality and object-as-perceived are not only
moments of the relation, but are structured in connection with each other in strict parallelism,
so that the nature of each co-determines the other, and second, that variations in one are causally
concomitant with variations in the other. This parallelism means that they mutually influence or
co-vary with each other. In other words, that there is an interpenetration or interweaving
between the intentionality and object-as-perceived—between noema and noesis. What does this
constitutive mutual interpenetration consist of?
First, the perceptual object insofar as it is perceived has, even is a ‘sense’ or a ‘meaning’ for
us (Husserl 1983, 214, <182>). There is here a twofold relation: the perceptual intentionality—
to smell—and the phenomenal character, the sense the perceptual object has for me—a smell.
Second, and in clearer interactional way, I related auditorily only to audibilia, to sonic
occurrences, and in a way audibilia determines that I relate auditorily to it.14 Multimodally, for
distinctions I am to examine in this paper in connection with the issue of content) purports to investigate ways in which aspectuality can be accurately specified in the case of perceptual experience. 13 Unlike other intentional relations, perceptual intentionality requires that the perceptual object exists. I won’t pursue here the differences with other types of intentionality. I am aware that my commitment to the actual existence of the perceptual object is at odds with strands of phenomenological philosophy, and I hold that my position is both correct and defensible as a position Husserl himself held. I have visited this issue in different fashions in chapters 2 and 3. 14 I do not deal here with synesthesia. Noetic and noematic adjustments would be needed to accommodate to subjects that relate modally to objects or events that are usually thought to be perceived in other modalities. I do not foresee that these adjustments jeopardize any of the central tenets of the social enactive view of perception. The same applies to other perceivers, e.g. non-human, and their abilities to engage perceptually with otherworldly reality, as bats do with echolocation or some fish by a type of magnetic/electric type of perception.
177
example, I relate to someone speaking to me in a concrete way that includes both audition and
vision (evinced in phenomena such as the McGurk effect). At the same time, the fact that
someone addresses me verbally calls for my engaging with this occurrence in precisely the
appropriate multimodal interaction.
A virtue of the social enactive account is that it corrects the far-too-common habit in the
philosophy of perception of treating all perceptual intentionality the same, and this means
mostly to treat it as a type of vision, or secondarily as a kind of touch—in any case dealing
primarily with spatially related properties such as size and shape.15 The relation between
perceptual intentionality and object-as-perceived is an antidote to the idea that perception, as to the
object and as to the subject, is a one-currency thing for the objects of perception.16
Different versions of Enactivism have committed this mistake as well.17 Varela, Thompson,
and Rosch’s influential Enactivism (Autopoietic Enactivism, as Hutto calls it) defines perception
as “perceptually guided action” and defines action in motor terms (Varela, Thompson, and
Rosch 1991, 173). Perhaps even clearer is the case of Noë’s Sensorimotor Enactivism, a
refinement of some aspects of Varela et al.’s. Noë also defines perception is sensorimotor terms,
but he goes one step further. It is not, he says, that perception is for action (as one could perhaps
interpret from the Varela et al.’s), but that perceiving is constituted “by the exercise of a range of
sensorimotor skills” (Noë 2004, 90). From another point of view, our capacity to perceive is
constituted by sensorimotor knowledge. This exercise is not only the possibility of executing
certain movements on the basis of what is sensed but rather in being able “to draw on one’s
appreciation of the sensorimotor patterns mediating […] your relation to it” (2004, 90). This
appreciation grounds movement made on the basis of things perceived, even in terms of
15 Furthermore, the framework of veridicality, as I have been discussing it, seems to be built upon and depending on visibilia and sight: stable objects, clear boundaries, occlusion, geometrizable perspectival relations, and a relatively clear physics lingo. How different are things when we start thinking in the sense of smell: no stability, not much of a boundary there, no clear occlusions, no mathematizable relation, not easy and still not clear physics lingo. This should raise all sorts of concerns for philosophers of perception. 16 Somehow relatedly, although from a non-perceptual field, Husserl explains that in the case of an object we value, the noema is the valued object, already valued, and not the valuable object, to which a valuing (the noesis) would be added (1983, 232, <198>). 17 Others enactivists like Hurley and Hutto have not made this mistake.
178
affordances, but it also grounds the understanding, we might say the phenomenal character, of
what is perceived. That is for sure an important precision, for it deals with the oft forgotten
issue of the original consciousness of perception.
The point that concerns me now, though, is Noë’s claim that the exercise of sensorimotor
knowledge or skills allows “my perceptual experience to acquire full-blown perceptual content”
(2004, 90).18 While Noë at times qualifies content as visual or spatial, his position does seem to
be that all perceptual content is mediated in a sensorimotor way. For instance, when discussing
the possibility of individuating sensory modalities by reference to their objects, he says: “at the
ground of our encounter with these different objects—appearances in one modality or another—
is sensorimotor skill” (2004, 107). He attributes to sensorimotor dependency the “suitable
generality to play a basic role in an account of the nature of sensory modalities” (2004, 109).
Inter-modal differences belong, in Noë’s view, not to a different kind of dependency but to
different patterns of the sensorimotor type (2004, 109).19
I contend that sensorimotor skills do not exhaust the ways in which perceptual content is
mediated. Modalities other than vision provide evidence that (i) some perceptual content is not
mediated by sensorimotor dependencies, and that (ii) intra-modal content, even if partly
sensorimotor, cannot be all acquired in such way. Take the case of the bitter flavor of a
18 Sensorimotor skills and sensorimotor knowledge are for Noë the same. This is problematic despite his insistence that this type of knowledge is implicit, practical, and non-propositional. Daniel Hutto has charged Noë of proposing a conservative enactivism, and his criticism is based mostly off of this point: “Ultimately, the problem is that SMC [sensorimotor contingency] theorists fail to be radical enough. For, if we give up on the idea of experience as a static inner representation and truly think of perception as a kind of exploratory activity, extended over time, then there is no need to introduce ‘knowledge’ as a kind of bond that holds together various percepts in order to explain phenomena such as perceptual presence” (2006, 399–400). While Noë takes precautions in order to fend off precisely this type of objection, Hutto’s criticism succeeds, I think, in that knowledge is too rigid to capture the plasticity and the tacitness of the type of ability involved in sensorimotor dependencies. Enactivist views are better off not using the talk of knowledge in explaining what is grounded in action or practice, as I have shown in chapter 1. While I can’t discuss it here for reasons of thematic focus, I’d like to note that this mistake of Noë is linked to his position on (non-)conceptualism, namely, that all perceptual content is conceptual. If, as he says, “concepts are practical skills, and some practical skills—some sensorimotor skills—are simple concepts” (2004, 199), first, we would be missing a concept for propositionally structured concepts, and second, we’d be running into familiar problems about dealing with experiential novelty. 19 Although Thompson’s own work on mind and cognition is thorough in a number of ways, rich in nuances, and philosophically and phenomenology rigorous, his account of perception, mainly drawing from Noë’s Enactivism (and some of Noë’s collaborations with O’Regan and Hurley), suffers, for that reason, from the same drawback I have been addressing (2007). Intersubjectivity figures in his account of the mental as a mode of embodied activity, but not in perceptual terms. I do not have a position on Thompson’s take on cognition overall, but only on his position on perception.
179
sweetened beverage, coffee or tea, after you’ve eaten something very sweet. Or take, for
instance, the perception of ambient temperature on a hot day. In these cases, there is nothing
properly sensorimotor in perceptual content intrinsically, or in terms of the perspectival or
motor potentialities of objects to be seen in different perspectives. Meaningful possible actions
in these cases are not motor, yet they are actional, as the socially pragmatic dependencies
illustrate. For the second variation, take the case of a deafening space. There are aspects of the
auditory content that are spatial, such that I know that turning my head to one side seems to
decrease the intensity of some sounds, or that in walking in a particular direction I may be
getting out of the noisy area. Yet, concrete audible properties such as pitch or timbre, while can
be affected by distance, are not perceived in terms of knowledge or a mastery of sensorimotor
skills such that they are perceived insofar as I am able to perform movements that affect the
perception or that make the perception meaningful.20
I, however, would not dispute that spatial content is mediated, in its spatiality, by
sensorimotor contingencies, as Noë defends. The mistake, once again, is in supposing that all
perceptual content is spatial, or even that all content is not exclusively but at least
fundamentally spatial, as for example Peacocke (though not an enactivist) has argued, by saying
that spatiality is presupposed by "representational properties of all other types" and constitutes
part of the "objective content of an experience" (Peacocke 1992, 61, 67).
One case that disproves this claim is retronasal olfaction, which is, roughly speaking,
smelling things in the mouth via the throat. Orthonasal olfaction happens through the nose,
making even possible to find spatial information according to the smells coming in from the left
and right nostrils (similar to interaural cues in the case of audition, or binocular comparisons, in
the case of vision) (Gottfried 2005; Porter et al. 2005). Retronasal olfaction, in contrast, happens
via the nasopharynx and is normally associated with the experience of flavor, when smell works
20 Further, a correct account of the nature of auditory content is based on time, rather than on space. Sounds do not have spatial boundaries: they are not experienced as starting here and finishing there. They are however experienced as having temporal boundaries, and it is precisely the succession of 'boundaries' what allows in many occasions to distinguish some sounds from others, in a manner structurally similar to a distinction figure-ground.
180
"in tandem" with the sense of taste (Porter et al. 2005; Stevenson 2009, 11; Gottfried 2005). In
the case of retronasal olfaction of food or beverages in the mouth, subjects assign the position of
the object of smell to the mouth (Small et al. 2005). An olfactory stimulus may be mistakenly be
experienced as flavor when is in the mouth, and in other cases the relatively simultaneity of
taste and smell makes it also difficult but not always impossible to parse out between tasting or
smelling. Since the olfactory epithelium is located in the nose, there is no distinguishing of the
part of the oral cavity where the molecules that reached the epithelium through the retronasal
passage were released. Thus, the establishment of a point of origin located somewhere in the
mouth and of a system of axes operating from that index (as when eyes are the point zero of
observation of a cube in front of me) is an idle exercise for retronasal olfaction. There is no gain
in such description: a system that would yield exact positions of odors in the mouth would yield
information that is altogether irrelevant for the characterization of olfactory content acquired
retronasally. While, lastly, intensity of smells may change with location, and dependent on the
type of food or beverage at stake, it seems that such changes inside the oral cavity are
negligible, if not altogether irrelevant, for a characterization of olfactory content, since
differences of location inside the mouth do not contribute to differentiating smells from one
another. Be it a feature common to all representationalisms or not, to affirm that perceptual
content is always spatial (whether only, mostly, or fundamentally spatial) is incorrect, for it
leaves out, for example, most experiences of flavor and some cases in the experience of smell.
Back to the mutual constitutive interweaving of perceptual intentionality and object-as-
perceived, Husserl refers to the very concrete nature of the perceptual experience as one in which
the perceptual object, as it is perceived (or in general meant) must be seen in a double specificity:
in the how of its determinations, and in the how of its manner of givenness. The object in the how of its
determinations (1983, 314, <272>) corresponds to determinations pertaining to the object, in its
noematic aspect; the object in the how of its manner of givenness (1983, 228, 316, <194, 273>)
181
corresponds precisely to the way in which it is perceived, its noetic aspect. It is, in sum, “the
sense of the object itself in its [double] how” (Micali 2012, 154; the translation is mine).
To bring this series of reflections up a notch, let us consider a case involving emotional,
socially rich interaction that includes a qualification of a sensory modal intentionality. For
example, I can look at a tree somehow disinterestedly, but also look at it melancholically. In
both cases, I am looking at the tree, but there is a difference, which in this case is a
compositionality on the side of the intentional act, for my two ‘seeings’ of the tree are more
complex than a simple seeing the tree ‘neutrally.’ They can be so different that unattended
features of the physical tree can be made conscious in virtue of the attitude: perhaps soft colors
or shapes capture our attention when we look at the tree melancholically, in contrast to those
details being absent when we look at the tree customarily. Think of epochs, cultures, and artistic
movements that developed and increased sensitivity or disinterest for certain sensual aspects of
reality, due to artistic sensibilities or to vital needs, as it can be the case of a culture in which
people rarely stop to see the soft tones of things, or as in the case of Eskimos, reportedly being
able to make very subtle distinctions in ‘shades’ of white.
We can think of a similar case in a different sensory modality by contrasting the customary
perceptual exploration of an object and a careful exploration set in motion by a change in
attention. Think for example of a known rock song, and in the contrast between the generic
listening of it, where no change in pace and no virtuousity display call my attention at all, and
when, for example, a guitar solo catches one’s attention.21 This attention shift may lead to
increased attention to other features of the song. The fact that details raise to the surface in the
careful exploration mode entails a variation on the side of the object-as-perceived (Husserl 1983,
222–26, <189–92>). These attentional modifications of the object-as-perceived constitute further
evidence of the dependence of perceptual content (specifiable in terms of the object-as-perceived)
on the pragmatic component (Husserl 1983, 225, <192>).
21 Notice that I use ‘object’ is a generic sense, but that is inadequate when applied to audible things. Following O’Callaghan, the case of auditory experience shows that the objects of sound are not object but events, chiefly because they do not have spatial but temporal boundaries (O’Callaghan 2007; O’Callaghan 2009).
182
4.1.2 Perceptual Intentionality, Detachability, High-Level Properties, and Perceptual
Practices
One of the central characteristics of the conception of perceptual content in the social enactive
view is that it is a peculiar type of content externalism: content is dependent on the intentional
relation and is non-detachable from experience because it is world-engaging. Simply put: the
social enactive view never treats the contents of perception in detachment from experience, that
is, from the relation in which they come to be and persist as contents, and this relation is an
interaction with the world.
A legitimate question is whether the distinction between perceptual object and object-as-
perceived is metaphysical or epistemological. The distinction is better conceived of as
epistemological, for the following reason: no new entity is created when I perceive something.
Certainly, the intentional act or relation is metaphysically different from the object it is about.
But the object-as-perceived is the very same object but as it is in the relation, from a perspective.
In other words: the object as a part of physical nature, described in a scientific-like manner,
cannot capture the way in which it is taken up. The object as taken up can only be described
within the relation or interaction that is established between perceiver and object. It seems
plausible to offer an argument to make this very distinction between perceptual object and
object-as-perceived into a metaphysical one. But accepting the distinction does not require that
step; as a matter of theoretical parsimony, there is no need to encumber the theory with a
metaphysical distinction, when an epistemological one suffices.
At the core of the theory I am proposing, there is a rejection of the concern for veridicality
that is at the heart of standard theories of perception (most of which are representationalists).
As chapter 3 showed, the concern for veridicality is a piece of a conception of experience that
entails detachability for contents. Criticisms of representational views on content are often
directed, and not without reason, to a propositional construct of contents, that is, where
contents are propositional attitudes. Standard views deal with this issue assuming that
183
perceptual experience and its contents are structured propositionally, mostly as beliefs, which
makes individuation of content a truth-functional semantic matter. Siegel terms this view the
Strong Content View, and argues that the representational view of content (that contents are
truth-functional aspects of experiences that render them veridical or not) is not committed to
the Strong Content View, that is, to the propositional construct (Siegel 2010, 73–74).
But since both views treat content as detachable from experience (so an accuracy or
veridicality verification can be performed), showing that content must be treated as non-
detachable works as an argument against both views, whether contents are cashed out in terms
of propositions or not. As I have argued, the theoretical commitment to the perspectival
appearing of things, as a function of the system of dependencies previously accounted for
(idiosyncratic, socially and non-socially pragmatic) bars us from conceiving of content in
independence from the perceptual interaction. And since it is in the nature of the conception of
perceptual experience as interaction that perception is of the world, then it follows that there is
no conceiving of perceptual content as non-world-involving. Since both the “[Representational]
Content View” and the Strong Content View conceive of content as detachable they are on the
wrong track.
But there is something more substantive at stake here. The conception of content of the
social enactive view, insofar as it is non-detachable from experience (meaning that it is non-
detachable from perceptual intentionality and from the world that is engaged in precisely the
type of experience issuing from such intentionality), guarantees that if it is the case that in
perception we are acquainted with high-level properties, there must be a perceptual intentional
counterpart to those properties. This entails, for one, that perceptual intentionality—or
intentionality in general—is not simply a type of mental state, narrowly (internally)
individuated. To be in an intentional relation with something is then not simply a matter of a
mental regard upon something, but a being related to things that is grounded in practice, and is
hence embedded in an environment and a context, and embodied. Further, this argument makes
184
it all the more feasible that perceptual intentionality is also extended. Moreover, this reasoning
furnishes another argument for the suitability of the perceptual practices accounted for in
chapter 1 that constitute the ground level for our perceptual engagement with the world.
4.2 Full Content Is Core Content plus Environing Content
The central (albeit general) distinction between perceptual object and object-as-perceived touched
upon the nature of content, but not upon its structure. This section takes up such task and offers a
parsing of content as an account of its structure.22 I take heed of the fact that the worldly object is
part of content, but put that aspect to rest. If raised again, the question about the real objetc can
always be answered along the lines already presented. I now change gears.
The structure of perceptual content must reflect three key elements. First, it is the holistic
character of perceptual contents, in the sense that no isolated sensations or objects are ever
present in perception, but always in a figure-context configuration.23 Each moment of a
perception is concrete and unique in the very specificity of its determinations in its extended
temporality. In each moment, a specific configuration of objects and surroundings takes place.
Second, it must reflect a difference in the phenomenological structure of perceptual experience,
namely, the coexistence of change and identity. This is the idea that perceptually, “a “continuous
‘multiplicity’ is related to a ‘unity’” (Husserl 1983, 87, 237–238, <75–76, 203>). The case of a
melody is immediately telling: the melody is itself perceived as a unity despite its continuous
changes and yet the continuous changes can be perceived.24 Perceptions ‘keep’ their object in the
22 This account began following broad distinctions Husserl used in the Logical Investigations, descriptive content and intentional content, intentional aspects and reel aspects, quality and matter of the act, etc. and the analysis later done by him in his Ideas I. It is not possible now to draw a clear line separating Husserl’s specific influences from this final account. I can say that a lot has remained, in terms of the spirit and mode of analysis—notwithstanding that spirit and mode come not only from the Investigations but also particularly from the Lectures on Thing and Space and the Ideas I, esp. §§128-135. I can only declare the Husserlian inspiration of this account. 23 Agreeing with the key tenets of Gestalt theory, Merleau-Ponty says that the perceptual object is always in the midst of a field (2002). Merleau-Ponty’s attitude (and Husserl’s to an extent) was both sympathetic and critical towards Gestalt theory, which they refined and embraced. I do not offer an exegesis of their takes on Gestalt theory, nor on the way my my account of the structure of perceptual content differs from them or the original Gestalt theorists. My intent here is only to recognize the affinity. 24 I grant that the case of a melody goes one step further than the mere stability within change, in the sense that the stability at stake can be said to be an emergent property. My argument here does not depend on the case of a melody,
185
face of changes in the subject, in the object, or in relational aspects (Husserl 1983, 313, <271>
§§130-131).25 Furthermore, it is central that perception is able to withstand the fluid reality of
perceptual sequences, for that enables us to establish relations with objects or events in the
world, despite their being extended in time. Third, since content is a specification of aboutness,
an account of content must provide us with conceptual and lexical resources to refer to the
object of our perceptions, no matter how dynamic and ephemeral it might be.
If we reflect for a moment on observing a tree as its branches move with the wind, or in the
flavor experience of eating a piece of sushi, or in hearing an ambulance siren coming towards us,
we will notice the following structural features: (1) the perceived totality is (2)-plus-(3) (full); (2)
that an object or situation (and its properties as well) remains as a referent (core); (3) that there
is more than the intended object or situation as intended, such as the context environing the
intended object or aspects of the object that were not intended (environing). While (2) is a
holding of an object that carries a certain intentional permanence, the object is stable in the
variations featured in the perceptual sequences (3). The variations are not threats to the permanence
of the object but the concrete manifestation of what permanence means for real objects. Further, my use
of permanence should not be overstated, because objects may not be stable and can radically
change or disappear, but for as long as a perceiver is able to identify actionally, predicatively, or
and holds well for the case of my perception of a squirrel running up a tree. However, the case of the melody highlights a central commitment of the Social Enactive View, very much derived from the work of Merleau-Ponty, presented in chapter 2 when I introduced high-level properties in perception, and rehearsed above when perception was qualified as always perception of something as something, to wit: if I were to encounter a 'melody' as a mere sequence of notes without an internal configuration holding them together, giving it its sense of melody, then that would not be a melody. I would not be encountering a melody but a sequence of notes. It is, once more, the coming across something as a totality, that is, as a unity that overrides a hypothetical perception of just the parts (Merleau-Ponty 1942, 93–94). 25 A cursory taxonomy of possible changes in the perceptual relation may include: kinetic changes in object, subject, or both (the latter entails perspectival changes); changes in the object; bodily based changes in the subject, which, excluding those merely kinetic, can be interactional beyond movement (pressure put upon something, or more carefully exploring something—that is, a more narrowly defined physical interaction, and a more pragmatic component); psychological changes in the subject (such as attentional shifts); or changes in the environment, such as illumination, background noise, and other modal-specific environment-like variations, e.g. antecedent flavors or smells) (Husserl 1997, 75–76, <87–88>; §26; Drummond 1990, 146).
186
even imaginatively the object as the same in a sense, then there is a sense in which permanence
applies to that which has remained throughout the changes.26
(1) Core content + Environing content = Full content. Correlatively, we hereby have another
equation: full – core = environing. This last one is particularly useful to reflect on aspects of our
perception of things that often go unnoticed. Relatedly, this tool can help examine other sensory
modalities and, if I am correct in identifying environing content as nonconceptual, also as a tool
for analyzing nonconceptual content.
(2) Core content. It is central to most perceptual experiences to focus on an object or event
that remains a continuous referent throughout the perception (Husserl 1983, 224, <191>; §90–
99). Core content refers to the concrete objects (events or states of affairs) that guide or receive
our attention, that is, the object on which we act and about which we predicate. In looking at a
tree, even if I am walking past it while having it in my line of vision, it is undeniable that specific
moments of the tree are different from each other in several respects, only one of which is the
difference in the perspective from which I see the tree. And yet, it is undeniable that I perceive
the tree at all time and can refer to it as the same tree. The analog analysis for the Ambulance
Siren case should be clear.
Core content is an abstractum that, so to speak, hovers over objects and environing
changes—in the way a center of gravity of an object is abstract yet very real. What SEP
accounts through the notion of core content is a desideratum of a theory of perceptual experience.
Representationalism and other theories may have notions that attempt to respond to a similarly
construed desideratum, e.g. perceptual object representation. SEP’s account is superior on
account of the nature of content of which it is a specification and of the relation with environing
content.
26 The connection between nature and structure is explored at length in the following chapter, where the chief claim is that perceptual content is pragmatically individuated. Both if we take the perceptual sequence as the model of perception, and the core content as an admissible pole in the description of content, we find that it is exactly the placement of events and aspects in a coherent sequence what characterizes perceptual experience. What type of coherence is this perceptual coherence? How does that apply to both the extended sequence and the singularized moments? These aspects are explored in the next chapter.
187
The Case of the Parked Car. What counts as a core content, as explained before, depends on
the specific pragmatically guided perceptual intention at stake in each case. Say I am walking
down the street and there is a car parked near me. I may notice the car or not. I may only notice
the presence of a big object without thematizing it as a car. If I notice it, I may notice it in many
ways: noticing its color or not, noticing where it is exactly parked, etc. My way of noticing it or
not somehow depends on what I am doing: perhaps I am rushing to get somewhere and my
surroundings are not something I have an interest in, except for efficiency. My level of
awareness of the car is also related to my pragmatic engagement with it: if I barely notice the
bulk I may be able to avoid it (and vice versa too), and my noticing it without awareness of
model or color may be enough for a more involved pragmatic relation, such as intently standing
behind it while another car goes by. In all these cases, I take a position about the car, which
affects what perceptual properties I notice. Thus, when I am in the vicinity of a car, it is not the
case that I always encounter a car as such, with its many characteristics, and that my perceptions,
actions and reactions about it can be defined objectively.
Perceptual intentionality relates to ‘core contents’ depending on our pragmatic relation to
things. This intentionality can take the shape of a clear intently intending the object, but it can
also lack this heightened purposeful awareness of an object. The first situation is the case of an
intently listening to a mosquito flying around me to avoid it or catch it, where other objects or
events surrounding me may move, as it were, to the background. The second situation is one in
which my attention may be wandering and only transitorily focusing on things. This can be
illustrated by a person suffering a poor weather’s day. She may not be intently looking at the
cloudy sky, or concsciously feeling a very cold temperature, or intently listening to a noisy
street where she is waiting for the bus. And yet, as she waits for the bus, her attention may fall
upon the low light that makes objects look unattractive. Her attention may be momentarily
taken by a cold wind reminding her, as it were, of how cold it is. It seems still that a minimal
awareness, not necessarily an intently focusing on things, is necessary for there being a
188
perceptual experience with its corresponding perceptual content. In all these cases, however,
core content is not specified in advance on the side of the world, because the same world full of
objects and situations, may be taken differently at different moments. In the case of the car
parked on the street, the core content, the referent of my perception could be the bulky object
that I avoid or the brand-XYZ yellow car of beautiful lines and bold color I am admiring. In the
case of the street where a woman waits for the bus, a specific building across the street can
feature as core content, but core content could also be the collection of building and objects
looking unattractive under the dark cloudy sky.
Further, there is the explicit singling out of the object as it occurs in verbalization: we refer
to objects of the world as stable objects. This element underlies a deeper, stronger point: we
experience objects of the world as stable and unitary, or conversely, we experience the world as
comprised of objects that we see or hear, of which we speak, upon which we act. This is core
content of, and, as this type of isolated entity, it constitutes a layer of perceptual content.
(3) Environing content. The perceptual sequence in which the object or situation is presented
as the same does not only consists of the object at stake. It also comprises (i) objectual,
unintended aspects, and (ii) extra-objectual (hence unintended) aspects and properties, extended
temporally, (at times) spatially, and modally, reaching all the way down to the moment of initial
contact with physical aspects of the world. Environing content is a specification of the
perceptually relevant ‘environings’ of more keen perceptions.
Just as the perceptual object is the one that exists in space and time and the one that we
relate to (act upon, refer to, think about) in its perspectival determinations, it is of the essence of
perception that, as a whole, we find a continuous “braid of partial synthesis of increase and
decrease [of the relative givenness of sides and parts of things], in which, to be sure, the
individual strands of the braid have and can have no autonomy” (Husserl 1997, 95, <113>).
Each same object is presented in a series of changing aspects or perspectives (Husserl 1983, 87,
<75>), some of which belong to the focal object and some others to context. But whether they
189
belong to the same object (the swirling colors of a colorful kite), or to the extra-intentional
aspects of the object (the changing illumination of an object in a case in which I am not
concerned with lighting) or to context, they do not affect the sameness of core content. Hence,
these variations are thought of as belonging to environing content, and environing content can
be said to be an ever-flowing multiplicity of moments.
The unintended aspects of the intended object ((i) above) are, for example, the colors in
colored things when my intending has nothing to do with color. For instance, in tasting a piece
of sushi I do not normally intend its color (or its shape), and it yet makes part of the experience.
To use an example of Husserl’s, this is the way the whiteness of a piece of white paper is part a
visually based interaction with the paper (e.g. I want to grab it). It is the same for feelings
accompanying the objects that are felt in a given way, as with the melancholy that may
accompany my smelling an old house full of memories for me. These aspects are extra-
intentional because I do not intend those aspects and they still accompany the whole and are part
of content (Husserl 1983, 75, <65>).
There is another fashion that this still objectual yet unintended environing content can
take. This is the case of heavily amalgamated habitual associations and entrenched ‘known
connections’ related to an object—possibilities or properties—that may present themselves
when the object is intended in certain manners (Husserl 2001b, 113). A piece of china porcelain
may, for instance, be intended as a piece of decoration on a mantel, and yet, its fragile character
is perceptually presented with it, although perhaps only explicitly in the face of impending
danger (for the china piece’s integrity).
Besides the aspects still belonging to the object but that are unintended in core content (i),
environing content refers to the surroundings of the core (ii). These surroundings are, first,
temporal, as a function of the dynamic nature of perceptual experience in the Social Enactive
View. For instance, in my tasting a food item over the course of a meal, what I ate right before
such item is part of the full content of the tasting of that food item, for it can be the case that the
190
previous flavor influences the new one. A sip of wine immediately before a bite of brie cheese
will somehow affect the flavor of the cheese, and the flavor of the wine plus cheese lingering in
my mouth has the potential of influencing the flavor of yet another piece of cheese, this time
perhaps a camembert cheese. Or following an example of William James’s, hearing thunder
must be specified at times as thunder-after-silence (or thunder-after-thunder), for the
phenomenal character of the experience changes in one case or the other. Another useful
example is that of dipping both hands into lukewarm water after dipping one hand into warm
water and the other into cold water. The lukewarm water feels as if with two different
temperatures. The hand that was initially in the warm water container will feel the lukewarm
water colder than the other hand would, and vice versa, because the second hand was dipped
first in cold water. When hands are in the last (lukewarm) container, that water there is the core
content, and the two previous buckets, one warm, one cold, are the environing content.
Relevant environings can also be, in several but not all modalities, spatial. In my perception
of a colorful house, for example, the colors of the surroundings matter, for colors are context-
sensitive. As the artist and educator Josef Albers put it in his famous Interaction of Color, “a
color has many faces” (Albers 2006, 77).
Also on the normative side, we have that all the concrete aspects of perceptual sequences—
of those braids just mentioned— refer to “possibilities of fulfillment” (Husserl 1997, 105, <125–
26>) and the pragmatic possibilities of perceptual acts, which I will explore in chapter 5.
As to its normative and explanatory work, environing content accounts for the relations
between the sides, parts, elements, and transitions that form perceptual continua. To specify the
color of the surroundings of a yellow house entails that surrounding colors are part of an
explanation of the color of the core content, and would also be part of the explanation of another
color interaction occurring there, as it could be the perceived color of the clothing and umbrella
of another person passing by. In the context of a meal, to say that part of the content of a
specific perception includes the flavor of item eaten or drank right before means that within the
191
proper zoom level, those previous flavors partly explain the current flavor, as well as other
aspects of the whole perceptual interaction.
4.2.1 Lowest-Level Interpretive Take on Physical Reality: The Roots of Normativity
A theory of perception should have something robust to say about the sense in which there
is in perception a contact with a physically defined reality. The Social Enactive view has a
position about this, and it is spelled in terms of perceptual content: perception starts to be
contentful at the very moment of acquaintance of a perceiver with sensible physical and
chemical properties of the external world. Since perception is a pragmatically guided normative
field, to say that there is content at such basic level means that the explanatory desideratum of
content—that content as an explanation of the internal transitions and transformation of the
way the world is presented in perceptual interaction—finds there a partial answer. In other
words, understanding how and in what sense aspects of the physical world come to be
perceptual is necessary to understand what it is for perceptual content to be content. Also, this
discussion bears weight in accounting for the modal (also inter- and multi-modal) component of
our taking up aspects of the world in perception.
This topic requires a much longer account than what I can offer here but my purpose at
this stage is simply to situate the content of this basic contact with the world within the
taxonomy of content provided and to articulate the fundamental rationale under which it is
considered as content. This rationale is also as able to give normativity some anchoring in the
physical reality and its interaction with perceivers. The details of the psychological mechanisms
by which this takes place or the specific constraints, derived for instance from scientific accounts
of neural networks of multisensory integration or about the physiology of sensory receptors are
not addressed here, but they do not affect the conceptual point I am making.
To start off, within the parsing of content proposed, the content of perception at the
moment of contact with the world belongs to environing content. It is useful to notice that this
192
moment embodies the nature of the fundamental distinction between the perceptual objects and
the object-as-perceived.
On the one hand, there is a physical world whose physical characteristics (reflecting light,
having a particular kinetic molecular energy, having a precise material composition, the
vibrations of airwaves at certain frequencies, etc.) make it possible for a being like me to
perceive it, that is, for me to take heed of it in the manner in which I do (as being visible, as
having a temperature, as telling of shape, as opposing resistance, as being audible, etc.). On the
other hand, it is the fact that I can engage in perceptual relation with those aspects of the
physical world, that is, that I am able to be about them in the way that the different sensory
modalities and inter and multimodal interactions are about things. Through the sense of smell,
for instance, we are acquainted with things in their smelling. But in things’ smelling we are also
about smells’ connections with flavors, with past experiences, with hedonics, and with the ability
to think and talk about the things we smell. It is not only that there is a what-it-is-like about
them at a given moment, but more generally that they come to be for us in a sense that exceeds
our phenomenal consciousness of them.
This general perspective according to which we can entertain in specific perceptual ways
characteristics, aspects, or events of the world translate, at the present level, in the following
insight: there are aspects of the world that are seen from a subjective standpoint when both parts,
perceiver and worldly aspect, enter in a relationship. It is not possible for those physical aspects
of the world to remain merely objective when they enter into a relation with a subjectivity. Once
they are made conscious, they are not anymore perspective-less, neutral. Thus, physically
defined things of the world are always taken up by consciousness in a particular way: they are
animated—minded—, they come to be as a sense.
But, what does it mean for physical aspects of the world to be animated, to become minded,
or to be taken up perceptually?
193
In this analysis I somewhat follow Husserl' referred to this moment as the apprehension of
hyletic stuff—also translated as hyletic stock or hyletic data.27 This is in no way sense data. The
term hyletic points to the idea that there is a sense, acknowledged above, in which we become
acquainted with stuff. Although we must acknowledge the existence of this vaguely qualified
stuff, it is not quite ‘something’ yet, and we can’t speak of them in precise terms. This stuff is
perceptual, yet barely so. It’s a limit notion than can’t yet be jettisoned, for it is part of the
causal determinants of perception.28
So we have, on the side of the world physical properties. We don’t talk about these
properties from the point of view of experience, but sideways, from the point of view of a
physical description of the world. In turn, such physical description is itself part of an experience
and cannot claim to reach things themselves. For someone concerned with the description of
that matter as physics or chemistry does, another phenomenological analysis of such scientific
acquaintance with stuff is appropriate—and would indeed be necessary in a project that wanted
to account for our contact with the world in all domains and not just perceptually. That is not
my task here.29
The taking up (or ‘apprehending’) of sensory material in perception is an interpretive act.
The taking up of physical stuff in experience refers, at a basic level, to the very experiencing of
27 Husserl began this discussion in the Investigations and continued and nuanced it later in his Ideas I (Husserl 2001b, §§20, 22–31; Husserl 1983, §§85–86, 97). Welton and others hold that this framework was abandoned by Husserl in the years leading up to Ideas I, and replaced by the noetic-noematic correlation, and later on by a construction in terms of perceptual sense (Wahrnehmungssinn or Auffassungssinn) (Welton 2000, 183; See also Crowell 2013, 130–131). The reason for that appraisal seems to be that Husserl must have abandoned a simplistic matter/form or content/schema view in which we could separate data from the interpretation of data. Reasons of space prevent me from exploring this issue in detail, but for the present purposes it will suffice to say that, while I agree that a simplistic division is untenable, in my view a data element and an interpretive element are still necessary in order to understand the constitution of objects for perception—and so Husserl thought as the passages from Ideas I attest to. The difference is the way I think the hyletic data should be treated. The view I propose can reconcile the Auffassung/hyletic data, with noetic-noema, and with perceptual sense (Wahrnehmungssinn). 28 The causal aspect of perception is here understood as a confluence of causal-sensitive aspects rather than a matter of a linear chain ending with a mental event. The causal relation is not a sequence that starts with objects emitting impulses and finishes with a mental, inner event identified with the experience of the property associated with the objective impulse, that is, a representation in the classical sense. Actually, the causal antecedent of perception is a physical occurrence of the world not intrinsically understood as an object. Perception begins once this hyletic stuff is taken up as a perceptual-meaningful something. That something may or may not be an already defined object. 29 Yet in order to block the objection that this position leads to an endless regress, I hold that since we can never get out of every relationship we have with stuff—so we never achieve a position from where ultimate foundations can be laid or assessed—, in dealing with basic questions we are in many-legged situation, where one or more legs must stay in the ground in order to move the others, and all can’t be up at the same time. The foundational dream of a complete revision—or a complete foundation—is wishful thinking.
194
physical realities in a phenomenal way, such that, for example, a particular range of the
electromagnetic spectrum is taken up as colored stuff by seeing beings. This colored stuff—an
initial perceptual determination—would be what Husserl called hyletic stuff (Drummond 1990,
144). Notice that the former is part of the perceptual, while the latter is part of the as-perceived
aspects of things, as understood in 4.1 above.30 This type of interpretation depends indeed on
the type of beings we are, and it also evinces pragmatic dependencies (both socially and non-
socially constituted) for it situates sensory-based occurrences in a system of perceptual
references that forms a horizon that is open for action in certain ways and not in others.31
Not only do I relate auditorily to sonic stuff, but also sonic stuff constraints my relating to
it: it picks, as it were, my auditory relating to it. In somewhat a related fashion Husserl says: “I
cannot rejoice in anything unless what I rejoice in stands before me in the hues of existence ”
(2001b, 137). By extension, I can’t hear what does not present itself sonically, and I can’t feel as
slimmy what I can’t touch one way or another. I can’t say it’s acrid what only presents itself
auditorily, and I can’t say it’s glossy or mate what is not in the first place visible.32
By the same token, this interpretive taking up of physical realities bears a connection with
other senses in which things appear, for example, whether something appears as familiar or
exceptional, as melodic or harmonic with other parts, and others similar categories. We have
30 I offered an initial discussion of the temporality of perception in connection to experience and consciousness in chapter 3, section 3. I was there concerned for the first time with a proper understanding of the causal element in perception. It is important to acknowledge that there is at this level a question about temporality, particularly as to how the temporal aspect of this initial contact with stuff connects with the temporal sequence of experience. The temporal structure of perception requires that initial ‘impressions’ do not disappear immediately and are ‘active’ in the following ‘impression,’ or in other words, that there is a lingering impression turned into anticipation towards continuous perception of objects, for otherwise it would not be possible to experience objects as continuous, and that we do and is at the very basis of a perceiver’s capacity to relate to the world. This is what Husserl calls the temporal structure of inner consciousness—impression-retention-protention. Now, this structure must have a counterpart at the level of the taking up of hyletic stuff. I cannot undertake that analysis at any length here. 31 We find here the idiosyncratic, socially pragmatic and non-socially constituted pragmatic dependencies I have proposed above. Following the argument about the intentional structure of position-taking of section 2.3.3 above, the perceiver is a pragmatic position-taker, so there are reasons to think that connection between the pragmatic and the interpretive taking-up of stuff reaches all the way down to the basic level of contact with reality. Further, internal and external horizons of possible fulfillments are already at work in the objects we perceive and determine the possibilities and impossibilities for perceptual nexuses (Husserl 1973, 103–106, 122; Husserl 1970, 165; Husserl 1983, 322–23, <279>; Drummond 1990, 150–151). 32 An analysis of sensory modal predicates—acrid, tart, bitter, rough, brilliant, etc.—, and the connections between sensory related uses and their metaphorical uses can shed interesting light on the philosophy of perception, traditionally limited to shape, size, and color.
195
here the case of a sensation being taken up, which means that it stands in definite relations to
others and to perceptual fields.
While I do not do the fine-grained work here, a further development would contribute to
an account of sensory modalization (in one modality, intermodally, or multimodally), that is,
what counts as a modality, as combinations of modalities in one, or even regarding modal
compatibility. This may have a bearing on cases like the case (presented in section 2.3.3) of
research in social cognition showing differences between the way some Americans visually
perceive scenes and the way some East Asians do. The fact that the same “patch of light” is
taken up by some as independent or as standing in relation to nearing patches is not a feature of
the physical occurrence, but a function of the pragmatic intentionality at stake.
Because the Social Enactive View sees the perceptual relation as an interactive coupling,
this basic acquaintance level is in no need of a decision as to what comes first, whether it is the
interacting subject or a radiating world. Since perception is subject to pragmatic dependencies,
there is no question of physical aspects in a sort of void and (in place of a real perceiver) a
sensor. This means, among other things, that no useful or interesting definition of the physical
occurrence of perception belongs to the physical occurrence itself. The physical event is nothing
without the interpretive taking up of it. Unlike Berkeleian idealism, for which that which is
perceived is that which is, in this account there is a distinction between “qualities of objects and
hyletic data” (Lévinas 1995, 40). The distinction, though, is not ontological but epistemological,
in keeping with the analysis of the perceptual object and the object-as-perceived (Drummond
1990, 142).
By way of conclusion, a few clear points. I do not mean that airwaves of such and such
frequency and wavelength, or chemical compounds in the air of such and such molecular weight,
or rays of light of such and such frequency are part of the contents of perception. The reason is
not, as one may think, a supposed lack of certainty about physico-chemical configurations being
the correlates of perceived properties. The reason is that, as physical properties, they are no
196
content of perception yet—no matter how close the correlation between physical properties and
perceived properties, there is an irreducible (yet somewhat bridgeable) between them. What is
part of environing content are the perceptually meaningful aspects once the physical stuff is
taken up, as I have been illustrating.
The moment physico-chemical aspects of the world become perceptual matter they are
specified in perceptual ways: they are sonorous, smell-like, colored, etc. Often, those aspects
feature in distinct objectualities: in the loud ambulance siren, in the smelly trash can I walk by,
in the sweet hot chocolate I drink. It is plain that the sonorous nature of what I perceive as a
loud ambulance siren is closely related to the core content. What makes it environing content
still is that when I focus on the ambulance siren, I do not focus on the sonority of the ambulance
siren. Likewise, when I walk by a smelly trash can my attention is directed to the disgusting
smell as disgusting and not to its olfactive nature, as a philosopher of perception in investigative
mode would.
The question gets tougher in the case where I focus on the sensory nature itself of
something. As I write these words, I decide to play music and to focus on the music. But I
attempt to focus on it as it is something I can hear, as sonorous or audible, and not as it being
the sound of a guitar, or it being a voice, loud or not, high-pitched or low-pitched. Merely as
something I can hear. I think I can do this, but it takes a very particular turn of attention—I
easily slip into the form sound takes, or in general into musical categories. So the question is:
when I focus on the sonorous nature of the occurrence, following the characterizations I have
offered, is the sonorous nature of the sonorous occurrence core content or environing content?
My take is that what in this case figures as core content is a sophisticated abstraction but not
the sonorous nature in which airwaves come to be sound for me. Once I can focus on the
sonority of sounds, sounds are already sonorous. Hence, the sonorous nature of sonorous
occurrences, in the sense that they initially are taken us by the embodied perceiver I am, is
environing content.
197
There is another case. Basic perceptually meaningful aspects are often not part of
objectualities: they can be vague, foggy or hazy.33 Let me say a word about cases like the latter.
The totality of environing content also includes marginal aspects that may or may never
saturate or become features of core content (or even of featuring in more central (less marginal)
aspects of environing content). We can characterize this aspect of environing content as
potentiality, indication, symptom, hint, clue, trace, or inkling---all of them related somehow to
clear perceptual formations, which they may never come to be.34 Part of the difficulty in
pointing to these unsaturated, low-intensity aspects of perception is precisely that they are not a
concrete thing yet but they are not nothing.35 In a fuller account of the transition from the
unsaturated to the saturated talk of intensities and magnitudes will be needed. While I don’t
offer here a full-fledged account of these aspects, the initial indications provided left the domain
almost readied for further development. The framework of pragmatic individuation of content
and the discussion of normativity, both coming up in chapter 5, will make it clearer how a full
account of the perceptual unsatured—indicios perceptuales—plays an irreducible role in
perception.36
33 Upon further examination, which I cannot offer here, nonconceptual content considerations would play a central role in favor of individuation of perceived properties at the experiential level itself, as it is the case with rather capricious perceptual continua such as the interplay of colors due to the play of light and tree leaves or as random reflections of things in water. 34 A very precise term for what I am aiming at is the Spanish word indicio. In English, I settle with inkling. 35 A similar, and connected, difficulty is faced by theorization of nonconceptual content, for it requires putting in words in somewhat clear terms what is hazy and non-concrete. 36 A basic puzzle on the theory of the unsaturated has to do with the status of environing content as unconscious perceptions (in the sense of lack of awareness) or implicit aspects of perception. Thompson (2007, 262–266) offers the following diagnosis: Block, for instance, would accept these implicit aspects as a case of access-consciousness without phenomenal-consciousness. The problem there is that not every aspect that figures implicitly in perception, in the Social Enactive view, is characterized by its availability for rational decision and control of action. On the other hand, Thompson says, Noë and O’Regan object to Block, and hold the position that perceptions without awareness are no perceptions. Thompson’s outlining of a solution to this puzzle is compatible with the Social Enactive View. Three aspects are to be retained from Thompson’s (and used in further developments of the issue of the perceptual inklings). (1) Within the framework of “temporal extended dynamics” there is room for both implicit and explicit aspects (I think that the formulation according to which “there is no differentiation” between them is wrong (2007, 263)). He is right, though, in pointing to “moments of comparatively weak and strong affective force” in what he calls intrinsic aspects. I cast these differences in terms of intensities and magnitudes, correlated with marginality or centrality within environing content. (2) Activity and passivity play a definitive role here, which in my taxonomy of content are somewhat mirrored by core-content and environing-content. Pragmatic individuation of full content is central here. (3) Affectivity and receptivity are at play in perception in the sense that one is receptive to what has already affected oneself, and affectivity refers to what has “a kind of affective force or allure, or affective ‘grabbiness,’ in relation to one’s attention” (2007, 263). Spelling out the interplay between affectivity and receptivity, Thompson says: “something becomes noticeable, at whatever level, owing to the strength of its allure or grabbiness, emerging into affective prominence or salience, or relief, while other things become less noticeable owing to the comparative
198
4.3 The Charge of Phenomenalism
The account of content of the Social Enactive view is so closely linked to its conception of
perceptual experience that several of the objections against the parsing of content just offered
are actually objections against the conception of experience at stake: questions about the
autonomous nature of content and the directness of perception, about the centrality of
veridicality, and about the issue of high-level perceptual properties. Those have been addressed
in previous chapters, and answering again to them in content-specific terms would require a
rehearsal of the same arguments. That, I won’t do here.
There is another important objection against this view on content that pertains, not to the
structure of content, which this chapter focuses on, but to the normativity internal to the
dynamic account of content. A strong version of that objection has been put forth by Siegel, and
it consists in the claim that to the extent the Social Enactive View allows for perceptual
comparisons, then it is committed to a representationalist, autonomous view of content,
entailing a concern for veridicality. It will be taken up in chapter 5. I will answer to this
objection once the social enactive take on normativity has been established.
There is, however, an objection that applies directly to the nature and structure of content
I have offered. This objection has been raised by John Drummond, initially in response to
Gurwitsch’s reading of Husserl’s concept of noema, or object-as-perceived.37 Succinctly, the
charge is that a view that takes the perceptual object (and in consequence, the object-as-
perceived) as perceptual continuum is committed to phenomenalism, because a whole like a
continuum cannot be but understood as a whole composed of parts, and whole-parts conceptual
framework betrays the extended temporality it was aiming at, rendering us unable to account
for the real world.
weakness of their allure” (2007, 263–264). There is a significant agreement between the Social Enactive View and Thompson’s Autopoietic Enactivism. 37 In personal communication, Drummond has also raised this criticism against my view that the perceptual object is a perceptual continuum.
199
At a deeper level, the problem with phenomenalism is that it has the impossibility to affirm
categorically that in perception we perceive the real world, that is, real object, events, and states
of affairs. At most, the objection goes, perception gets acquainted with parts of the world, but
the holding together of those parts and its product, the whole of perceptual experiences of
objects, has the status of a mental construction. For phenomenalism, the world is only made of
contingent appearances—mind-made reifications of a world that is separate from us. To be sure,
phenomenalism has been around for centuries, has been espoused by several philosophical
schools, and been challenged by philosophers of different persuasions (Cf. Noë 2004, 79ff.).
Austin, for instance, engaged with Ayer and Price—I examined others facets of that debate in
chapter 3. I focus on the Gurwitsch-Drummond debate because I take the decisive issue to be
one that is at the very center of the Social Enactive View; an issue that comes from the
phenomenological tradition. The issue is that in perception we deal with a temporally extended
world, and perceptual object and perceptual content are constrained to this dynamism.
I contend, contra Drummond that the perceptual object—in the broad sense I have been
using, i.e. as a placeholder for objects, states, and states of affairs—and its correlative content is
normally a perceptual sequence or continua, and that this is possible without falling into
phenomenalism. It follows from the Social Enactive account of content structure that specific
objects are, even in cases of continua, fully accounted for in their being objects of phenomenal
awareness, thought, predication, and action.
In the perceptual discussion on phenomenalism, the key is the status of the relation
between real object and object-as-perceived. It is, in other words, the problem of content, or what
is the same, of the perceptual object as it presents itself in perception. Is the object-as-it-is-presented-
in-perception/as-it-features-in-perceptual-interaction (perceptual content) a composition of
parts in a mind-projected unity, hence necessarily separated from the world and only
contingently matching it at times? Or is the unity and reality of the object-as-it-appears-in-
perception such that the familiar problems associated with a gulf separating mind and world do
200
not appear? And in relation to the Social Enactive View: Do the nature and structure of content
presented (perceptual object/object-as-perceived and full=core+environing), which responds to the
constraint that the objects of perception are temporally extended continua, entail either phenomenalism
or the type of realism that the Social Enactive View espouses?
Let’s look more closely to the problematic alternative Gurwitsch proposed. Drummond
diagnoses the problem with Gurwitsch in the whole-part model, to wit: “On Gurwitsch’s view,
that an identical thing appears in each of its appearances is a consequence of [a] whole-part
structure, for in grasping the appearance (the part), we grasp a part which has a functional and
systematic significance for the whole and, hence, we grasp, albeit imperfectly, the whole itself”
(Drummond 1990, 96). On such view, the real object is a “system of appearances,” or a system of
a totality of adumbrations or presentations (Mohanty 2008, 382; Drummond 1990, 150).38
But what is the nature of this system? Is the system given, or is it idealized? On
Gurwitsch’s view, the system is ideal: “[such] Gestalt-whole is an ideal object” (Drummond
1990, 97). Drummond says, is that since Gurwitsch only allows for the grasping of parts, the
whole is never given—rather it is posited as an ideal, and it does not matter that it is qualified as
a system of adumbrations with functional and systematic significance. Functional qualifications
notwithstanding, the whole is an ideal.
This type of analysis reduces each appearance to a moment of a whole that is never given
and only theorized as a Kantian regulative idea (Mohanty 2008, 394). This path invites idealistic
interpretations that counter the realist spirit that I am articulating, for it declares the
impossibility of real contact with objects in the world. The object is thought of as a transcendent
unachievable infinity, yet rationally present and regulative. While I do not think that Mohanty
thinks of the system of appearances, of the perceptual content, in a way that makes of it an
38 By way of illustration, let us recall what Merleau-Ponty says of a visually perceived house: “the house itself is not the house seen from nowhere, but the house seen from everywhere” (2002, 69). Notice though that the house is never seen from every angle. From the point of view of the actual perspective we have each time, based on sensory stimuli, the system of appearances Mohanty and Gurwitsch talks about is never actually given. Further, Merleau-Ponty’s dictum entails that the house itself is never experienced. I do not think that Merleau-Ponty falls into phenomenalism, but this affirmation—aided with a bit of decontextualization—allows us to see how attempting to escape one type of intellectualizing illusion—the house itself as an unanalyzed house seen from nowhere—may lead to another illusion—that the feeling of presence of the whole house in perception means that the house is seen from everywhere.
201
entity separate from the real object, which Gurwitsch does, I regard his interpretations as
providing at least too weak of a bridge between appearances and object. It must be noted,
however, that with this rejection not every teleological account of the perceptual object is ruled
out.
This conception regarding parts and whole “raises problems concerning how to understand
the categorial differences between senses (or perceptual appearances) and the object itself and
how to understand the possibility of perceiving things themselves” (1990, 98). In other words:
by using the categories of part and whole in analyzing the conjunction of identity and change
that characterizes perceptual experience, and which has animated the parsing of content I have
offered, we are unable to properly understand the relations between change and identity, or
between, as Husserl put it, a “continuous multiplicity” and a “unity,” which I set out to account
for in the first place (Husserl 1983, 87, 237–238, <75–76, 203>).
The reason of this categorial incongruence, in Drummond’s view, is that when only
individual appearances are given real status, they are treated statically, and the whole is posited
as ideal. This type of analysis “abstracts from the temporal process of the perception as a whole.
Whole/part analysis […] is essentially static analysis and cannot be employed in the analysis of
the perceptual process as a process” (Drummond 1990, 151; Emphases in the original).
On the Social Enactive View, as well as for Husserl, these three constraints are honored:
the perceptual object is a perceptual continuum, not necessarily but possibly identified with a
physical, unitary object; whatever is presented in perception is presented with a sense of
wholeness that belongs to perceptual experience (despite the fact that the object as a whole can
never be present to sensory receptors).
Let me now elaborate the point where I think the Social Enactive View and Drummond’s
view differ. This will show why, first, the Social Enactive View is not subject to the
phenomenalism objection, and why the Social Enactive View, while incorporating several
features of Drummond’s analysis, is an improvement upon it.
202
For Drummond, the way to think of the perceptual object is not in a whole-part model, but
rather in terms of identity and manifolds. The idea is that the identity of the object is taken as a
given, which is presented in a temporally extended manner in “a manifold of appeareances.” He
adds: “The identical is that which is given in and through a manifold; hence one of its sides or
aspects is present whereas others are absent, although they can in time be brought to presence”
(1990, 151).
In Drummond’s view, the object is a unitary object and it is the focus of perception. The
object is certainly given in a temporally extended manner but it is always a unitary object. This
is what I think distinguishes our positions: I do not think it is necessarily an issue of identity-in-
manifolds, but identities-and-manifolds.
Drummond focuses on unitary objects and theorizes content as the object as it is presented.
Manifolds are for him the appearances in which and through which an object itself is presented.
But there is no clear room for what surrounds “the” object.
Drummond is moved in these considerations by a concern for the stability of the object.
The way he proposes to ensure such stability is to analyze the perceptual relation as always
having a definite object that is unitary and stable. Not having a defined object as the perceptual
object jeopardizes the stability of the object, hence, the certainty that perception is of real
objects, and not the mind-projected unity that we fear in phenomenalism.
Contrariwise, I have insisted that I used “perceptual object” to mean objects, events, and
states of affairs. I have also said that I understand the perceptual object to be a perceptual
continuum or sequence. Notice, furthermore, that I take content to be the addition of both core
and environing content and not just core content. Further, I have clarified that core is not
always highly defined and that whatever count as a core is not predefined by worldly objects,
but is defined by perceptual intentionality. In perceptually interacting with the world, I do not
only interact with (physical) ‘objects’ with precise spatio-temporal boundaries. I used examples
in the experience of flavor and audition to illustrate this point.
203
The Bicycle Ride case features a good example of a perceptual continuum. Drummond has
responded saying that we should distinguish between the phases in “seeing the road as the
bicycle moves along it” and the concrete object-as-perceived, namely, “the road as perceived
over the entire, temporally extended perception. The road perceived is a stable object, even
though it is disclosed only in its salient features and even thought it is disclosed in a multiplicity
of noematic phases. The dynamism is at the level of the multiplicity of experiences and the
noematic phases, the stability is found in the temporally extended unified experience and its
object” (Drummond 2014).
My qualification of the road lends itself to the criticism, but I contend that Drummond
would be at a loss if the perceptual object (in my broad sense) were more complex, dynamic and
plastic. For instance, I hold that a perceptual object can be defined this way: while riding my
bike, the perceptual object is the whole continuum made up by the changing road, the number of
cars, building, signs, and people I pass by, the different thermic sensations in my skin, my
touching the wind, the smells around me. Perception often occurs in this way, and not directed
to specific physical objects.
At that point, the route that defines the stable object at the “world pole” in terms of worldly
objects is at a loss, unless it wants to define the object as the overall disposition of the world,
locally defined spatio-temporally. But that is clearly no definition in the sense of stability
desired.
So when I say that it is more appropriate to define the framework as one of identities-and-
manifolds, I mean that the plasticity of the contents of perception, featuring core and
environings (which accepts of gradations or levels of marginality or centrality), is better
understood as a plurality. This plurality occurs not only on the side of the perspectives or
appearances (manifolds) but also on the side of the identities since they can vary in their
configuration (objects, events, states of affairs). Core content can pick a wide perceptual
continuum. There is nothing in the notion of core content that limits it to ‘stable’ objects.
204
In the framework proposed, what guarantees the reality of the perceptual object (in my
broad sense) is the fact that it definitionally belongs to the world. And the world, as the home of
endless possibilities for perceptual interaction, does not seem to hold stability in the manner
that physical objects do. As a matter of fact, the world may be a very unstable place in that
sense. I think it is more appropriate to perceptual interactions to think of the world as plastic.
There is one last element that also serves as a door into the next chapter: the pragmatic
normativity of perception does not make our perception of the world be of the world, but it
reflects that they are so. This issue, the pragmatic horizons in which perception is embedded
buttresses the claim that the perceptual continuum view does not fall into phenomenalism.
We know already that the perceptual object—the world that presents itself in temporally
extended sequences—is present in appearances, in perspectives, i.e. in “successive and adjoining”
perspectives of the object. The perceptual presenting of an object is the type of thing by which
an object presents itself in successive appearances or perspectives that are interrelated in the
feature of perceptual consciuousness of presenting the objects perceived in their wholeness, and
in pragmatic horizons or pragmatic systems of reference (Drummond 1990, 150–51).
The peculiarity of perception lies partly in this dual character: it allows perceivers to
engage with objects in a way that such object are fully given to perceivers—they do not feel
they are acquainted with sides or parts—, and at the same time, in such a way that a horizon of
possibilities of givenness is open. As elaborated above, the temporally extended perspectival
appearing of things in perception is the enveloping characteristic of the perceptual phenomenon:
perception happens from point of view—a temporal, spatial and pragmatic positionality of a
subject over against an ever-shifting and changing world.
This takes us to state once more that moments of perception do not exist in isolation, in the
manner that touching the side of a book as a side is a holistic performance, for realizing it as a
side is bound with the whole of which it is a side. (Husserl 1997, 66–69, <80–84>). And yet,
those never-isolated moments of perception point to the radical open-endedness of perception,
205
to the fact, that the ideal of perception of an object in its entirety, so it is adequate to the way the
world, both at rest and in gradual development, is but a myth (Husserl 1997, 96, <114>).
The fact that the Social Enactive View escapes the charge of phenomenalism does not mean
that teleological thinking is entirely debunked from a consideration of the perceptual object.
The idea of a total perception of the object can be perfectly entertained in imagination/phantasy
as what would be the result of all possible experiences of the object: my, or our, experiencing the
object from every possible point of view. This is the proper understanding of Merleau-Ponty’s
dictum seen above. For example, I have really seen my desk, and perceived my pillow by touch,
and yet I understand that there may be perspectives or perspectival configurations that I have
not occupied yet, and that may give me a different, however slight, perception of the object.
There is even no conflict in saying that the perspectives are infinite and I may never see or
touch familiar object in every way that it is possible to see them—yet, I have truly seen them.
Imagination or phantasy exercises may, among other things, underscore the radical perspectival
character of actual perception.
Further, the real object is related to the possible perspective that other members of the
same, common world would have of that object (Zahavi 2003; Micali 2012, 156). The object, the
real one, which presents itself in different perspectives, not only presents itself to me, but to
others as well. In the development of this idea lies part of the genius of Husserl’s approach to
intersubjectivity: the ‘object’ is always fully achieved in the phenomenal sense and yet, given in a
limited, open-ended way. It is a totality that is not exhausted in what is given at each moment,
but not because it is not exhausted it stops being a fully achieve totality. The object’s open-
endedness serves as a horizon of the perceptual interaction in an intersubjective context, as an
“index of a subjective [perceptual, in this case] system of correlations” (Husserl 1970, 165;
Husserl 1983, 322–23, <279>).
Chapter V
The Normativity of Perceptual Experience and of Dynamic Content
Perception is normatively structured. The how, when, where, why, and what of perception are
subject to normative relations. In its pragmatic aspect, perception is normative because it
features a dimension of successfulness and pragmatic significance that is exhibited in social practices
and the individual interactions that based on those practices. To inquire about the normativity
of perception means, on the one hand, to inquire about how perceptual practices and individual
interactions hold together, that is, about the origins of our being able to situate perceptual
interactions in relation to expectations and possibilities. This sense belongs to the normativity of
perceptual practices and it is cast in terms of the mastery of a technique by which we are
familiar with perceptual properties and their aspects and interactions, we respond appropriately
to them, we explore them, and we manipulate them skillfully. This subset of perceptual
normativity was addressed in section 1.2.4.
On the other hand, there is also a normative dimension to perceptual intentionality and to
perceptual content. There is normativity in how the different aspects of perception hold together
with other aspects of our (so-called) mental life such as thought, awareness, action and emotion,
and in how the contents of perceptual experience hold together. This chapter focuses on the
normativity of perceptual intentionality and perceptual content.
The normativity of perceptual intentionality deals with the role of perception in the
economy of our mental life. The general perspective of the social enactive view in this respect is
that our mental life is part of our pragmatic engagement with the world, and our pragmatic
engagement gives perception a central place in that engagement. In this chapter, I will offer
arguments for the perceptual application of this general thesis.
Specifically, in the first section of this chapter, I will take up the issue of the relation,
justificatory and otherwise, between perception and the other central aspects of our mental life.
207
In this regard, I argue that perception as perceptual experience is a form of original intentionality
that grounds awareness (or phenomenal consciousness), thought (including belief, desire, and
predication in general), action (beyond the scope of perceptual practices), and emotion. As a type
of original intentionality, perception can be said to be a type of consciousness, in the sense of
being an original way of making things available for consciousness. The extended argument is
that since our pragmatic engagement with the world encompasses not only what we do, but also
what we are aware of, the things we think about and what we think about them (predication and
belief), and what we feel, it is important to spell out the way in which the perceptual aspect of
that pragmatic engagement stands in relation to these aspects. I will have something to say
about the way these dimensions are interrelated.
This grounding connection issues, first, from the nature of perceptual experience (chapters
2 and 3). Second, since I intend to maintain a continuity with the literature, and the relationship
between perception and other aspects of our mental life —whether they are mental states or a
different kind—is addressed in the literature as part and parcel of the normativity of perception,
I will address that desideratum in terms that are somewhat close to that discussion.
The second part of this chapter is about the normativity of perceptual content, namely, how
the contents of perceptual experience hold together. What these aspects are is normatively
implicated in this how. In this sense, to ask for the normativity of perception means to ask, at the
level of content, how simultaneous and consecutive experiences hold together, what governs
intra, inter and multi-modal perceptions, what are the relations between parts (properties,
perspectives, etc.) and wholes in perception, what are the transitions between liminal
experiences and fully saturated ones, and so on. As a matter of fact, one of the raison d’être of an
account of content is the instrumental role it plays in helping us spell perceptual normativity.
Lastly in section 3, I take up two important objections to SEP’s view on perceptual content
and its normativity. The first one is Stephen Crowell's view entailing that there is no place for
the sensory and the undetermined in perception since normativity arises only from the
208
conceptual or from quite determinate norms, as in the case of bodily action aiming at clear
successful, optimal grasp of something. The second objection will be Susanna Siegel’s
argument about the two-fold entailment from properties to content: (1) that accepting that
properties are presented in experience entails the (representationalist) Content View (2010, 29),
and (2) that using properties in perceptual comparisons, which SEP does, commits one to a
content view, for those properties would be, as it were, isolated in order to then be compared to
others, and this isolation would entail detachability, a sufficient condition for the
representationalist view of content.
5.1 Perceptual Experience as Original Intentionality
The issue of perceptual intentionality falls under the general problem of the possibility of being
conscious of things at all. To be conscious of something is a relation of conscious being (in this
case a human being) to things other than herself in which things are something for herself. This
relationsgip is specified according to some essential modes in which things are given, that is, are
to be something for consciousness, e.g. perceptual, predicative, actional, emotional, cognitive,
etc. (2001b, 126). Perception is one of the original ways in which this happens. On the issue of
consciousness, I follow in general Husserl’s phenomenological orientation.
So what does it mean to say that we are conscious of objects we perceive? What does it
mean to say that when we interact with a thing in a sensory-based way, which we’ve called
perceptual experience, that thing is something for us, and on that very basis, we are able to
construct memories of it, say things about it, think possibilities for it, make judgement about it,
or act upon it? The answer to this question is partly to be found in the accounts of practices,
experience, and contents. Let me offer a recap of those aspects.
To talk about perception is to talk about interacting with worldly things in a sensory-based
manner. As I have been arguing in the previous chapters, perceptual experience is interaction
with the real world, in which a spatial, temporal, and pragmatic situated perceiver relates in a
209
sensory-based manner to physically-based objects, events, and states of affairs in the world,
which are not—are never—given in absolute ways to perceivers, but always presented in the
appearances in which they can only occur in their being perceivable. Real objects are
experienced as they are referred to and acted upon by people in their everyday lives (and by
scientists in their theoretical endeavors) (Husserl 1997, 3, <6>).1
Further, perceptually experiencing (or just perceiving) worldly objects is an original way of
being intentionally related to these objects. This means that perceiving objects is one of the
original ways in which we, as conscious beings, are able to relate to an object, or to be about an
object—in contrast, for example, to the way in which we, as living beings, relate to nutrients
found in food. More precisely, to be acquainted with the world perceptually, that is, to experience
it perceptually, is to be in interaction with things that are presented to a subject in-the-flesh,
that is, with a sense of bodily immediacy and evidence that is incompatible with the actual
doubting of their being so presented. To perceive an object, event, or state of affairs of the world
is to be in such a relation to the world that “one is in touch with a spatiotemporal entity that is
real in the sense of not being either an inference drawn from earlier beliefs or in some other way
a product of a belief” (Pietersma 2000, 61). In perceptual intentionality, the subject who is
sensory acquainted with objects—the one who interacts with objects—is thereby also able to
entertain further thoughts, to act upon them, and to have emotions about them (Husserl 1997,
123,<147>; 2001, 40, <4>).2
In one sense, the accounts of practices, experience, and contents of previous chapters are
themselves an explication of the idea that perceptual interaction with the world is one of the
original modes of being conscious of things. Several arguments in those chapters located
perception in an explanatory relation to predication, thought, action, and emotion.
1 While I take my theory to be compatible with much less complex forms of life, I limit myself to the case of the human being. I do not think that perception requires awareness in every case, although it sometimes does in the case of the human being. I won’t pursue this topic here. 2 This description offers a robust answer to the two questions Price poses in Perception, about the status of that which gives rise to our perceptions (for him, sense-data), which he referred to, following Moore, as a ‘belonging to’, and to the question of the nature of ‘perceiving’ or ‘perceptual consciousness’ (See Price 1950 esp. Ch.2).
210
A few examples may illustrate this triple entailment. From the account of practices we
gathered, for instance, that the precise fineness of grain that matters to us when we experience
things is often defined by the socially constituted practices of which they are part (e.g. that a
food item like a potato chip is supposed to be crispy). Our experience of aspects of reality
featuring perceptual properties is often an experience of high-level properties. We become
acquainted with those aspects of reality through perception and not through inferential
processes. Regarding experience, I also argued that the type of interaction we see in perception
is properly understood as direct, and is characterized by the mediations of perception
(idiosyncratic, non-socially pragmatical, and socially pragmatic). Concerning content, I argued
that there is not even a sensory basic aspect of reality that does not come to be what it is for us
if not in a concrete perceptual relation, characterized by specific perceptual modalities. These
examples, among others, have already shown how SEP accounts for the fundamental role of
perception in our conscious acquaintance with things.
Someone might say that these are only indirect accounts that do not demonstrate that
perception is a type of original intentionality. It is difficult to make sense of this objection since
it seems to call for a direct account. It’s hard to see what an account would be since chapter 3
rejected the usual candidates. As a matter of fact, one position or the other seem to operate at
the level of fundamental assumptions about the workings of the mind, not susceptible of judged
directly. It appears that an indirect strategy is necessary. I have offered several indirect routes,
and will in a moment add one indirect route, proposed by Campbell.
Someone might also say that the problem is that this view does not solve the problem of
the consciousness of perceptual objects any more than representations do. On this objection, it is
not any less clear why acquaintance with real objects would be originally situated, so to speak,
in the economy of consciousness. Why would direct acquaintance be more in the clear than the
acquaintance with ideas? SEP opposes Fregean and Russellian ways of going about experience
and content that take inner experiences and their contents (abstract mental entities) as what
211
constitutes our basic being conscious of objects. It is in fact characteristic of the standard view
that it takes its assumptions as if they are natural, and the only conceivable way of looking at
issues. In this case, the problem with mental representations is that they are taken eo ipso to
stand in just such conscious relations to a subject (Campbell 2002, 121).
To be sure, I agree with Husserl when he says that theories that posit internal
representations as the ground-level entity on which consciousness takes place leave the
phenomenon unaccounted for, because the mere having of a representation does not explain that
the object is meant or taken by a subject and in a certain way (Husserl 2001b, 125–127). The
explanandum remains unexplained, and we see intellectualist tendencies turned philosophical
intuitions find solace in retreating to the inner.
Two further arguments in this respect. First, an indirect argument. It is plain that “being
conscious of objects” must be established somewhere. This is, once again, an issue lying at the
very basic level of the ontology of mind and consciousness. The question is whether we are
going to take real objects as the objects of perceptual consciousness or will jump, in a potential
endless regression, to mental entities, which, in any case, at some point would need to be
declared conscious. If this is the case, I see no principled reason to reject taking external objects
themselves as that which we are conscious of. Notice two parallels. First, to take representations
as the object of perceptual consciousness is like the perceptual object analog of the homunculus
fallacy: We are perceptually aware of objects because we are perceptually aware of objects in our
heads. It is not difficult to see that the issue of perceptual awareness is not really explicated by
that reasoning. Couple it with the homunculus fallacy itself, and we have a clearer picture of
how we are in the presence of a regress: I don’t see objects in the world; a little man in my head
sees little things in my head. How does the little man see things he sees? Inside his head?
The second line of argumentation is about the internal 'coherence' of perceptual objects and
their continuous existence. In this respect, there are several reasons why external objects are
the very objects of perceptual consciousness, and why not doing so—and instead relying on
212
abstract entities as the objects of our perception—leads us to all kinds of problems, particularly
the epistemological bias that treats perception as intellection, and the objects of perception not
in their own terms but under the alien concept of truth. These reasons are that in matters of
perception only a realist, relationalist position can account for the dynamic, perspectival, high-
level content workings of perception, and for the continuity and “coherence” of objects in
consciousness. The temporally extended, multiple, finely grained perspectives that feature in
our perception of objects are best explained by assuming that we are in contact with those
objects in temporally-extended sequences, in which different perspectives are explored, in finely
grained ways, in sensory based interactions. The best way of talking about the external world is
to be directly realists about it.
This issue has been importantly argued by Campbell, one of the chief proponents of
relationalism, with which SEP is in partial agreement.
The problems with the representational view are well treated by Campbell in a critique of
the “common factor” view (also “highest common factor”), exploited by both disjunctivists and
relationalists. The common factor view states that what makes a person conscious of something
is its being related to a representation of the thing, which would be common between the actual
experience of the thing in the world and a perfect hallucination of the thing (See also Snowdon
2008; Martin 2008; Haddock and Macpherson 2008a). The representationalist endorsing the
common factor view is committed to the view that both experiences are the same, despite one
being caused by a real object and the other not, for in both cases a mental representation
obtains, and it is mental representations, not real relations to objects that individuates the
awareness of objects.
Relatedly, as McDowell has elaborated, this is all we must concede to a massive skepticism.
All we could aspire to, regarding perception, is the type of content that could belong either to a
real perception of objects or to hallucinations of them. Epistemically we can in principle never
be confident that we perceive the world (McDowell 2008).
213
There are several problems with this view, but I can only review a few of them. Let me
highlight Campbell’s strategy to derive some conclusions precisely from the indistinguishability
on which the common factor view preys. If, as the representationalist says, there is a common
factor between hallucinations and real perceptions, because they seem indistinguishable to the
philosopher upon cursory examination, then it would appear that the representationalist has no
resources to posit the continuity of objects as they exist in time and space. As Campbell notes,
experience is what makes it transparent to the subject that objects are the same “across time, or
across sensory modality,” or as a basis for inferences (e.g. predicate attribution) based on the
identity of perceived objects (Campbell 2002, 130). But if experience is only defined by mental
representations bearing no necessary connection to a mind-independent world, an experience
thus conceived cannot provide the needed warrant.
Instead, a conception of experience that makes it a direct contact with objects in the world
is able to warrant the identity in question. To be sure, this conception of experience takes
reliable syntheses (cognitive processing) to enable the subject to have precisely that type of
interaction with the objects that constitute it. Brain, cognitive processing is taken to be a
necessary condition for a perceiver to have experiences, but it does not entail that the real
outcome of such processing is a mental representation: “It is not that the brain is constructing a
conscious inner representation whose intrinsic character is independent of the environment. It
is, rather, that there is a kind of complex adjustment that the brain has to undergo, in each
context, so that you can be visually related to the things around you; so that you can see them,
in other words” (Campbell 2002, 119, 131).3
3 A further problem is that hallucination talk is simply overrated. It is not the case that we are actually deceived by hallucinations, although it is quite true that perception is ‘fallible.’ Specifically, when snapshot hallucinations are pressed to fit into the flow of continuous perceptions and their continuous coherent relation to action, they lose their grip because no people are tricked this way. Some may argue that illusions would further the common factor view, as in the case of phantom limb phenomenon. Upon close examination, though, it is clear that this type of illusion does not have the consistence and coherence that would make it indistinguishable from a real limb. Not only the phenomenon is not coherent across cognitive capacities—the phantom limb patient recognizes there is no limb—, but it also does not behave in strict concomitant variation with changes in the environment. Sensations in the phantom limb do not feature the proprioceptive and kinaesthetic continuous feedback that real limbs have.
214
Further, if the identity of objects over time is a puzzling issue for the representationalist, it
follows that she doesn’t have the resources to justify the perceptual sequences in which identical
objects feature along with other objects, for the problem just multiplies. What this objection
amounts to is that when the representationalist is pressed about real time, spatially extended
perceptual sequences, there is simply no warrant for our actual engagement with the world.
We find in Campbell an argument for the identity of perceptual objects. As I have had
occasion to argue in chapter 4, specifically in regards to the variations of perceptual objects that
core plus environing content can explain, SEP goes beyond relationalism: it is interactionalist. In
this sense, there is no commitment to perceptual objects being identical with themselves,
although they can be. Not every perceptual object remains identical during a dynamic
interaction. Perceptual objects are in a certain way continuous while we perceive them, but they
frequently change. What I want to retain for the time being is this continuous existence of
objects, to which different properties apply over time. SEP is well suited to account for this
vague sameness of the dynamic object. Since this dynamic object is an object of the world, in our
interaction with them, we are acquainted with finely grained objects, even as they change. This
fineness of grain is also better account for by SEP than representationalism.
This dynamism is, once again, best explained by a theory that takes the external objects
themselves as the site of aboutness, since mental copies would lack the detail that only reality
can offer.
Let us now move on to exploring perceptual intentionality and its connections with three
central aspects of our mental life: phenomenal consciousness or awareness, action, and emotion.
My goal here is not to present conclusive arguments barring representationalism but rather to
articulate a coherent framework in which perceptual experience plays a grounding role in
relation to a vast reaching range of our world interactions. This grounding role, which I will
specify in terms of awareness, judgment, action, and emotion, is one which representationalist
views assign to detachable contents and understand as justifications.
215
5.1.1 Perceptual Experience Grounds Awareness
The term consciousness also has a narrower meaning than the one just presented. In this
narrower sense, consciousness as awareness or phenomenal consciousness is characterized by a
reckoning of a what-it-is-likeness, that is, the fact there is something is experienced as
happening to one, or felt as belonging to one. Perceptual intentionality grounds this sense of
consciousness as awareness. However, awareness is not thought to be definitional of every step
and aspect of perceptual intentionality and perceptual content. This is because there are aspects
of what we perceive that we are not conscious of directly, but only, for example, as possibilities
for future engagement. Still, most perceptual experiences exhibit this aspect.
It is a central tenet of SEP that experience is not solely the feeling or awareness of having a
sensory-based acquaintance with an object. That view, which SEP opposes, is the modern idea
that experience is an inner issue, a mental issue, something we feel. This position has become in
many ways the natural way of thinking about mental phenomena. In the case of perception, this
view is coupled with the input thesis, that is, the idea that perception is the subjective end point
of sensory input: seemings. In that version, to perceive something is to have a subjective
impression that things both have the perceptible properties they are perceived as having and are
that way. Since, in that view, things might turn out to be, or not be, the way they seem to us,
they are just seemings.4 SEP disputes this view. SEP holds that perception is the actual contact
with actual objects—qualified in dynamic, perspectival terms and so on—, and that seemings
accompany parts of these interactions, but are not what defines them.5 However, I would like to
be careful in the following: I do not take awareness to be the same as belief.
5.1.2 Perceptual Experience Grounds Thought, Judgment, and Inference
In addition to phenomenal awareness, perceptual experience directly grounds judgment, and by
judgment I mean to refer to thought, judgment, and inference.
4 This applies to both low-level-only and high-level theories. The representational view is independent of a commitment to low-level or high-level perceptual properties theories. 5 That only some aspects of our perceptions or perceptual experiences are accompanied by the feeling of awareness is best understood through the account of content as full=core+environing, of which the pragmatic background that individuates them is a central part.
216
As to belief formation, in particular, since I do not take content to be detachable from
experience nor consisting of conditions of satisfaction of experience (accuracy conditions), for
reasons explained at length in chapter 3, contents do not form beliefs. Rather, because
perception is an original way of being conscious of things, perceptual experience and its
contents (here understood as a specification of aboutness) carry with them an intrinsic certainty
of things being as they are presented—in their dynamism and perspectival context—,
incompatible with disbelief and doubt. It is an intellectualization of perception to argue,
upstream experience, that perception forms belief because when I want to know whether X is
the case, I go see X. Rather, it is because when I see X and have the immediate certainty that X
is as it is presented in experience, that I can reflect on the fact or verbalize it. It would be more
appropriate to say not that perceptual content justifies belief, but, rather, that the belief consists
of having a perceptual experience with a particular perceptual content.
Naturally, this does not mean that I can’t ask whether the object I perceive is as I perceive
it. And still, it is because I immediately “believe” it to be so, that I go on and ask: “Is it so?” This
question operates on an already existing belief. There is no initial impression that doesn’t come
with a sense of reality, which amounts to the “belief” element. We must not forget that the
perceptual interaction, and the awareness, and the eventual wondering are all contextually and
pragmatically dependent.
Further, I wish to make clear that being able to ask a clarifying question about the
relationship between the independent structure of a physical object and the way it appears to me
in a concrete perspectival and pragmatic situation, does not entail that the question itself
somewhat represents or carries a standard of accuracy applicable to perception itself. Nor does
the questioning mean that perception does not as a matter of fact come with the sense of
immediate certainty I’ve been claiming it does. The difference lies mainly in the fact that the
double-checking question is derivative upon an initial acceptance. But the language-game of
asking whether things are as they appear is only one fueled by thought experiments— a game
217
that is not part of everyday experience, since even when an initial doubt appears it is only
further perceptual experience that confirms, as it were, that initial doubt. But this doubt needs
to be taken as doubt in the sense the skeptic wants. The same situation occurs when one is
exploring an object or a situation that requires further exploration due to its spatial or temporal
extension or configuration. In such a case, one may wonder whether the object will be, in its
totality, as one foresees it to be, and so the exploration goes on. Although this partial result
could be construed as a doubt on whether the object is as it seems to be at a certain moment in
time, it would be wrong to apply to model of reality as a standard against which to judge
experience’s contents, as it were, where further contents are conditions of satisfaction of an
experience.
We know is that different perspectives or appearances of a thing can be compared
meaningfully—and with good reason: they belong to the same environment and interactive
perceptual context. And we also know that being aware, as we are, about the perspectival
character of perception, it is normal that we wonder about the status of our perceptions in the
midst of dynamic, extended perceptual interactions. This is why sometimes, for instance, in
double checking something like a reflection on a piece of glass, reflection which ‘covers’ the
objects behind the glass, we move so as to alter the reflection and prove to ourselves that the
reflection we saw is such, and is not the object, or vice versa. But, once again, individual
perspectives can’t be compared to an extra-perceptual, extra-perspectival reality able to deliver
a final verdict. Rather, experiences’ contents stand in more or less coherent and stable relations
with their own milieu. The radically incoherent, wild case is the one that makes us pause. Even
in those cases, we try to find an irregularity in nature that explains the irregularity in
experience, which still comes to us with a sense incompatible with belief.
In a line of thought that goes as far back as Aristotle, perceptual experience constitutively
entails a basic coming-to-be-present-for-the-experiencer of a thing present to the senses, such
that it is the basis for being conscious of the way things feel, for my being able to think of or
218
imaginatively play with them in the manners pertaining to the specific perceptual modality, and for
being able to relate consciously to them as possibilities for action, as in a decision-making process, and
even as a basis to entertain imaginary possibilities for action.6 Campbell is right in echoing this line
of thought: “Experience of objects has to be something more primitive than the ability to think
about objects” (Campbell 2002, 122).
Allow me to illustrate this array of possibilities. To perceive auditorily an automobile
coming towards me is not only to be conscious of it sonically, so to speak, but also as something
that is not a smell, as something that is amenable to carrying certain perceptual-related
predicates (such as ‘getting closer’ and even perhaps ‘bigger’), as something that I can classify
(e.g. “this must be a high-cylinder car”) and, further, as something that I can act upon. Further,
auditorily to perceive a car also encompasses the possibility of hearing a rhythm in the rumbling
of the car, such that a memory of an old similar-rumbling car may come to mind—or even to
discover rhythms of songs in the rumbling of the car, like we can play finding shapes of animals
in the clouds. Let us not lose sight of the fact that in all these cases, as in the Parked Car
examples, there is normally a pragmatic setting that defines expectations and possibilities. Even
surprising events are located in relations to expectations and possibilities.
There are, in the domain of possibilities that come with a perceptual experience,
experiences that can be rightfully called judgments and inferences, or are bases for judgments
and inferences. Such is the case of perceiving a given color as familiar, which is a type of
judgment and yet is entirely perceptual. Similarly, and somehow between judgment and
inference, is the case of a man that having chosen a suit in the morning, goes to a drawer and
picks matching socks pair. There is in seeing the right pair a certain judgment of match about the
socks, and an inference of socks-and-suit match. As to inferences, it is like the case of someone
that probes with her foot the bottom of a river in order to walk without falling, and adjusts, so
to speak, tactile expectations to the way things feel in the water. Or like the person driving in
heavy, thick fog, that awaits for objects closer to him. In this case, this person adjusts the 6 See Aristotle’s On The Soul, especially books II and III (Aristotle 2001).
219
inferences made to a perceptual situation, or, in other words, the inferences made are heavily
based on the perceptual experience, which in this case is affected by visual conditions. Lastly, it
is the same case, in the modality of touch, of the person that just went to the dentist, and still
with a numb lip, is able to use a straw, putting to use the “knowledge” that the edges of a straw
would be easier to feel than the surface of the glass.
5.1.3 Perceptual Experience Grounds Perceptual-Related Action
Perceptual experience’s grounding of action is part of the engagement with the world that
implicitly takes the world’s structure for granted, and not in a judgment-mediated way. As I
have explained in the previous chapter, the implicit acceptance of the world and of perceptual
experience is better explained by a theory that denies that a perceiver is sensory-awareness-
guided-by-rational-patterns-of-judgment about what they seem to perceive.
One obvious sense in which perception grounds action is as part of perceptual practices, as
I have defined them before, as intersubjectively constituted and sensory-based practices of
interaction with worldly objects, and defined socially in a way that picks out objects such as
food, dance, and dress and activities related to them. It is of the nature of practices to be
intrinsically normative in a way that chapter 1 explored. I won’t spend any time on those
arguments.
The sense that I explore here is different from the sense in which perceptual is found
woven into perceptual practices. Rather, it is more basic than perceptual practices, and, in a
sense, it encompasses them. The idea here is that perceptual experience is at the basis of our
acting in the world in terms of movement and explicit interactions with and upon objects and
persons. Since perceptual practices include interactions with people and objects—yet specified in
particular ways—the type of grounding of action on perception I will explore here grounds
perceptual practices as well.
Snowdon has argued that to be perceptually related to an object entails that one can
entertain demonstrative thoughts about the object (2008, 67; see also Snowdon 1992). It is
220
possible to extend this rationale to intentional agency. If perceptually experiencing an object
entails that one can think about that object and to think about it in the ways in which it presents
itself, it must also be the case that perceptually experiencing an object entails that one is able to
interact with the object in sensory and sensorimotor ways, accounting of course for the
possibilities of action holding between subject and object (distance between one another, type of
object perceived, physical and cognitive capabilities of subject, etc.).
In SEP, the fact that perception is an original way of being related to worldly objects
themselves means that perceptual experience partly constitutes our being related to the world,
not only phenomenally but also in terms of action.7 We perceive the world in action-related
terms, and not in mere appearing manners to which possible actions are added by judgment.
Of the ways in which perception is constitutively grounding of action, we can divide into
personal and subpersonal levels. At the personal level, we have perceptual practices, treated
extensively in chapter 1, as well as the action-meaningfulness of perception and the perceptible
character of action-possibilities.8 At the sub-personal level, we have what systematic
interdependencies between sensory impulses and motor significance, part of which I have
captured before, in chapters 3 and 4, under the heading “non-social pragmatic dependencies.”
Straddling both personal and sub personal we find that perception grounds action on the
basis of the temporal dynamism of perception, on which a sense of the timeliness of actions
clearly rests. Temporal relations between “moments” of perceptual continua ground our reasons
for action, since action is temporally-bounded and, for the most part, has a timeliness
requirement.
At the personal level, say that perception grounds action partly means that we act in a
certain way upon an object partly because we perceive it as we do: as having a certain location
7 Certainly it is in this line that we should understand Kant’s idea of “the primitive character of perception relative to thought and judgment” (Ginsborg 2013, 210). 8 To the objection that action-meaningfulness is a type of instrumental dependence, Social Enactive Perception answers by noting that instantiations of this case are indeed instrumental, but the fact that perception is structured in this way, that is, that perception has this significance in the intentional interaction with a world is an ontological fact that emphasizes the interdependency between the two domains—of which, once again, specific cases are instantiations that can be interpreted as instrumental.
221
within reach or without reach, as being of a liftable weight, and so on. I kick the football in a
given way because I perceive it is in such and such location and moving in such and such
direction and I want it to move in direction X at speed Y, etc. I think of objects in the way I do
partly because I perceive them in certain ways.
A good deal of what is involved in this case is instrumental dependence, and this one is
uncontroversial. Philosophers of perception of all persuasions accept this is the case. But to say
that we perceive the world in action-related terms has a deeper, constitutive sense. Our
perceiving the world is inseparable from our acting in the world, and our acting in the world in
inseparable from our perceiving it. In what sense? In my everyday perception of the world,
objects are continuously experienced as affording action possibilities. This means that that it is
constitutive of perception to be action-meaningful, and for action-possibilities to be perceptible.
This does not mean that some action-possibilities are not perceptible or require an active
judgment or inference, but it means a) that some are not in need of judgment, and b) that it is
possible that in the inference-requiring cases, perception affords a series of horizons on which
specific action-oriented inferences could me made, but in a way that is dependent upon the
horizon of concrete perceptual interactions.9
There is a second constitutive sense that tracks the personal to the idea of intentional
agency, that is, of what it means for a subject to be an agent. Hurley has argued that the
interdependency, and for my purposes the constitutive dependency of, action and perception is
part of what makes the notion of an agent capable of motor action. For one, the notion of being
able to act (but not simply in the manner of automatic response) allows for a “normative space”
between stimulus-response and action. But this acting is only possible because an agent capable
of motor action is able to “understand” the motor significance of the perceptual, and vice versa.
Thus, Hurley says that the agent’s point of view is that from “which what you perceive depends
systematically on what you do and vice versa, and such that you keep track of this
9 This means, for example, that an olfactory experience may afford a spatial judgment, but not an auditory one.
222
interdependence of perception and action. Such perspectival self-consciousness involves
ordinary motor agency” (Hurley 2001, 427–428).
It is in this context that Hurley understands “reasons for action” as constraints on making
sense of the relation between action and perception in general, where making sense is not the
capacity of verbalizing those reasons, but the capacity of acting so that it is evinced that the
agent is able to cast motor significance in sensory terms, and sensory significance in motor
terms. This, she says, characterizes the first person point of view.
Hurley is right in saying that reasons for action or not reasons for belief for action (See
Chalmers 2006, 100; Toribio 2007).10 In fact, in the expression “reasons for action” reasons is a
bit of a misnomer. The main reason is that practical reasons “don’t require the language, or the
kind of theoretical inferential/conceptual abilities that language makes possible” (Hurley 2001,
430), which explains the attunement of animals to their environments. Reasons for actions are
rather basic and common to all perceptive and motor beings. Practical reasons may be better
understood under the model of what characterizes motor tacit, appropriate responses to
situations, as judged by the apparent goal of the action, which is normally more than the mere
motor display. Having a language or being able to make language-based inferences are not
needed to make sense of practical rationality as I understand it.
5.1.4 Perceptual Experience Grounds Perceptual-Related Emotion
The purpose of this section is not so much to offer a conclusive argument for the idea that
perceptual experiences ground emotion, but to offer a couple of remarks that make this thesis
compatible with the social enactive theory of perception as a whole. This should increase the
attractiveness of the view.
An argument coming from SEP’s commitment to the perception of high-level properties
says that part of the high-level properties perceived are the hedonics of the chemical senses. The
10 These are certainly not reasons of the kind that one is supposed to be able to give in the face of doubts about one’s rationality. Second, and most importantly, reasons for action are normally amenable to be the only ground that there is: I throw X with a certain force because I see the target in such a position and I experience X to be of a certain weight. It does make sense to ask for further evidence of the connection between the sensory and the motor than appeal to the other person’s understanding of that inter-significance.
223
hedonics of smell, flavor, and taste are the part of the smell, flavor, or taste experience that
expresses a liking or disliking of the thing experienced, to the point of being inseparable. As I
showed in section 2.3.2, hedonics are explained by a dynamic interaction between the object and
the perceiver. They cannot be explained by reference alone to the object. The common
phenomenon in which smells or flavor conjure up emotionally loaded memories supports the
idea that perceptual consciousness grounds emotions. Evidently, SEP does not hold that all
emotions are perceptually grounded, but that some emotions are. In those cases, part of the
answer for the emotions is found in the way we perceive something.
The perception of others and the phenomenon of empathy also suggest that perceptual
consciousness grounds emotion, that is, that some of the ways I feel about X are justified in my
perceiving X in a certain way. In empathy, we experience others and understand some of their
psycho-physical experiences as theirs and as similar to ours (Stein 1964). In the case of empathy,
the character of immediacy of the experience of the other and of parts of her 'mental' life is
coupled with a particular reaction to it. A quick example that comes to mind is our perception of
someone's anger in her speech, which Zahavi credits Husserl with and which is also a well-
known point made by Wittgenstein (2010, 294). In fact, to be empathetic with someone's
situation partly means to respond to that situation not in judgment-based way, but in an
immediate way in which the feeling (say, compassion) is not 'judged' appropriate and then
generated, but rather immediately felt and at times acted upon. Expressions of moral rage upon
the experience of someone's pain or humiliation, or expressions of compassion upon the
experience of someone's pain or plight fit well in the framework of SEP. If we accept that there
is such a thing as the emphatic experiences, and we have every reason to do so, SEP provides a
useful framework to understand part of the experience as perceptual. The understanding of this
type of experience as partly perceptual has the advantage of explaining its immediate character
and its bodily dimension. Since SEP provides a pragmatic understanding of the perceptual, the
phenomenon of empathy can also now be understood in its intersubjective and practical
224
dimensions, and would be compatible with interaction-theory (IT) and other phenomenological
proposals (PP) about the nature of empathy that can fall under the label direct-social perception
(some of the alternatives to the orthodox ways of looking at empathy, namely, theory-theory
(TT) and simulation-theory (ST)) (Gallagher 2005; Gallagher and Zahavi 2008; Zahavi 2010;
Zahavi 2011). SEP would then be the general theory of perception able to accommodate a
central desideratum of IT and PP views, to wit: "to take the embodied and environmentally
embedded nature of psychological life seriously and acknowledge a more immediate experiential
access to the minds of others which is prior to and more fundamental than any imaginative
projection or theoretical inference" (Zahavi 2011, 546). This feature makes SEP an attractive
view based on its comprehensive character.
5.2 The Normativity of Perceptual Content
Perceptual experience is partly constituted both by phenomenal character and by full content11
(core plus environing). This means that two experiences would be if they had the same
phenomenal character and the same content, but they would not be identical since each
experience depends on the pragmatically defined interaction with the object. In SEP’s view,
phenomenal content is only part of experience, for experience is the actual interaction with
11 As I have stated before, I hold disjunctivism about metaphysics to be true, and disjunctivism about phenomenology to be underdetermined in trivial cases (hence a deflationism about the comparing of properties in trivial cases: “Is the blue of my dream the same as the blue of my real perception?” where the answer is yes, but only in this trivial sense), but true in the final analysis (cf. chapter 3, section 3.4). In the present case, the significance is that, by saying that I see or touch something to be of a certain size or shape, I refer to the case in which I engage in a visual or tactile relation with a thing and its subjective impression, and not only to a putative subjective impression without referent. My use of “I see X” or “I touch X” includes cases where I deviate from what is generally agreed upon. My use of “I see X” or “I touch X” does not include cases where I am merely imagining or remembering the thing, for in those cases I am not actually seeing or touching anything, that is, I am not engaged in a sensory visual/tactile-based way with a thing in the world.
The claim that narrowly conceived phenomenal character (momentary sensation of X) and content can come apart, despite the claim that content is constitutive of phenomenal character, points to a version of disjunctivism. In other words, it is the idea that the content and the phenomenal character can be exclusive disjuncts, that they are not necessarily linked. I do not think that it really happens—in the context of spatially and temporally extended perceptual continua—that two perceptions with the same phenomenal character can have different contents, but for the sake of argument I accept this can be ruled out entirely. For the cases in which it happens, namely, hallucinations (extended hallucinations, if you will), I hold that the experiences are different in virtue of having different content (a real one vs. a hallucinatory one). This is compatible with my acceptance of disjunctivism about metaphysics and my claim that disjunctivism about phenomenology is underdetermined. As I have expressed, once ‘phenomenology’ is understood in the context of a temporally extended, contextually dependent, internally coherent structure of things’ appearings, phenomenology about content is also true (see chapter 3, n.21).
225
objects. This section of the chapter deals with the normativity of perceptual content, namely,
how the contents of perceptual experience hold together.
This section accounts for how, at the level of content, simultaneous and consecutive
experiences hold together, what governs intra-, inter-, and multi-modal perceptions, what are
the relations between parts (properties, perspectives, etc.) and wholes in perception, what are
the transitions between liminal experiences and fully saturated ones, and so on. Content has
been explained already to be a composite of core plus environing content. The present account
of content operates within that composition.
To be clear, if the perceptual interaction is formed by a practice component that relates
in specific ways to objects, and those objects, perceptual normativity occurs at both ends. In this
section, I don’t deal with the practice aspect —neither as to perceptual practices (chapter 1) nor
as to perceptual dependencies (chapter 3)—but with the content side of those interactions.
Perceptual interactions are like the axle of two wheels, one being the acting, the other being the
content. I address here the content wheel.
In keeping with the ontological and epistemological priority of practices in relation to
perception, SEP’s take on content normativity is pragmatic, as opposed to syntactic or semantic.
The master argument of this section will show that what makes perceptual moments stand with
each other in systematic relations, is a pragmatically governed field of perceptual fulfillment,
consisting of possibilities, expectations, and actualization of perceptual content. In other words,
to say, for example, that a series of perceptual contents (according to its specific composition in
the full=core+environing model) are part of a certain perceptual experience means that they are
glued together by being part of actual or possible interactions with objects, events, or states of
affairs. In other words, perceptual content is pragmatically individuated. I will argue in this
respect that content is partly individuated by (1) local pragmatic considerations (specific links of
content to other close contents), and (2) holistic pragmatic considerations (placement within
high-level, holistic pragmatic motivations: embeddedness in pragmatic sequences). These actual
226
and possible interactions are partly specified by what objects, events or states of affairs afford. It
is evident that our interaction with objects depends on what we can do with those objects, so in
this sense the what of perception has imposed a normative horizon on pragmatics: a horizon
spelled out in terms of both constraints and possibilities.
This account of normativity of content will allow me to offer a view about content-
individuation at the lowest level of contact with the world—a relation that was left open in
chapter 4. To be sure, the domain of possible perceptual interactions that constitutes the
pragmatic level on which the normativity of content depends is the domain of intersubjectively
constituted, sensory-based practices of interaction with worldly objects, such as food, dance, and
dress. These are, not surprisingly, the perceptual practices defined in chapter 1.
5.2.1 Core Content Is Not Individuated Conceptually
My first argument for the pragmatic dependency of perceptual content concerns core content.
This is a negative argument: it argues that content is not individuated conceptually, and rejects
the conceptual thesis on pragmatic grounds. This argument does not prove that content is
individuated pragmatically, but its conclusion is necessary for the further pragmatic thesis.
The core aspect of content has the peculiarity that it can be understood, under a certain
description, as a type content that is such in virtue of being a function of concepts. It is true that
a description of the content of my auditorily perceiving a car as an instantiation of the concept
‘car’ picks up something correct about my perception of it. This description is, however,
secondary. This content can be characterized, and so primarily, in terms of its placement in a
pragmatic context, and not as the instantiation of a concept.12 Not every time I perceive a car I
am aware that I perceive a car, or verbally report that I hear a car, such report being explicit
and standing in the first line of my cognitive relation to the car. In other words, my car-
involving perception is not necessarily the perception of a car, and the actual perception is
pragmatically determined in complex ways, where objects are rarely all that is perceived, and
12 Some alternatives for a pragmatic casting of the noema in general and the core of the noema in particular include, among others, its casting it in terms of my perceptual geographies, Gibson’s affordances (1979), Cussins’ cognitive trails (1992), or Noe’s access (2012).
227
the whole perception normally just involves objects. Since it involves objects, but not
necessarily qua the objects they are, everyday perception is rarely, if ever, individuated
conceptually. The individuation issues from the whole pragmatic framework in which the object
is presented, as the Bycicle Ride and Ambulance Siren examples of chapter 4 illustrate.
Hopp drives the point home in an interesting way when pointing to the for-the-sake-of-
action character of perception: It is very easy to persuade oneself that perception has the same
sort of intentional content as judgments when one’s paradigmatic instance of perception is
visually attending to an already familiar sort of object and reporting, either to others or
internally, what you see, and do so for the sake of doing just that. But this is not a paradigmatic
case of perception. Most perceptual experiences do not have perception, or even knowledge, as
their goal. Perception is more typically done in the service of action” (Hopp 2011, 48).
5.2.2 Full Content’s P-Properties And The Case of Attention
This section addresses perceptual content as full=core+environing and constantly refers to the
parallel between perceptual content and object-as-perceived, provided in chapter 4 (esp. Section
4.1.1). This being the case, the specific determination of the perceptual object, hence of
perceptual content (that insofar as object-as-perceived is content) can, and often does, acquire a
certain life of itself that rules on its perceptual horizon and can affect other perceptual objects.
This content’s life of itself own is brought about by attentional dispositions, both consciously
aware ones or deeply seated attentional habitualities. To the latter case belong, for instance, the
perception of written language or speech, which SEP holds exist in a world as it appears to a
suitably situated perceiver.13
In accounting for the three types of dependencies of perception in section 3.3.1, I presented
the concept of perspectival properties, P-properties. Noë defines them as follows: “P-properties--
the apparent shape and size of objects—are perfectly ‘real’ or ‘objective.’ Indeed, the relation of
P-shape and P-size to shape and size can be given by precise mathematical laws (e.g., the laws of
linear perspective)” (Noë 2004, 83). All that is necessary for my argument is to say that P-13 Cf. chapter 2, section 2.3.2.
228
properties thus defined do not exhaust the whole range of perspectival properties. While in
chapter 3 the emphasis was on the perceptual dependencies that made them possible, I want now
to focus on those properties themselves as part of the content of perception, and I want to
articulate the claim that part of the content of perception is given in the form of P-properties
that are not defined in Noë’s way. This difference is another aspect that distinguishes SEP from
other enactivisms (see also 4.1.1).
In Noë’s view, “P-properties are real in the sense that they do not depend, for their nature,
either on what goes on in us (e.g. sensations), or on what we do” (2004, 84). I hold, in contrast,
that it is not the case that P-properties do not depend on what we do, or on what goes on in us.
More often than not, P-properties depend on what we do, and derivatively on what goes on in
us, both regarding sensations (what stimulates our sensory endings) and in terms of both core
content and the phenomenal character associated with that type of content. Take, first, the case
of attentional dispositions that fix content, as happens in the case of series of dots forming a
cube that can be seen in two different ways.14 The perceptual content qua content is entirely
dependent on a certain attentional disposition, and it can become fixed in a way that even rules
out other possibilities. It is the case of learning to see something as something specific, in a way
that makes it really difficult, or perhaps impossible, to change that specific take on the thing.
The Müller-Lyer lines, which westerners “learn” to see as of different lengths but the San
foragers of the Kalahari do not, are a perfect example here. Back to Noë, P-properties are
properties of the environment only under the assumption that there is nothing else to the way
things appear than relations between their objective properties, relations between objects,
locations, and, at least in the visual case, illumination, as Noë describes them. But there is often
more than relations between objective properties in cases where attentional direction fixes the
content, that is, where attentional regard decides the issue. In other words, it is often the case
that there is no fact of the matter in the environment as to the perceptual specification of a state of
14 It is conceivable that there are internal divisions in these attentional dispositions. For instance, it may seem premature to say that seeing-as or seeing aspects phenomena, as illustrated by Wittgenstein, are due to changes in attention alone. It may be a matter of further investigation to determine what divisions are possible here.
229
affairs—what core content, what environing content—, and in those cases the definition of the
perceptual object is attention-dependent.
Take, for instance, cases like those of change blindness or the case of holistic or atomistic
perception of visual scenes in research on social cognition. These are cases where the object of
perception cannot be established independently of the pragmatic interaction. Take also the case
of perceptual attention based on relations of familiarity or harmoniousness, of eating with a view
on food-enjoyment: in those cases perceived properties are not ‘objective’ properties, but
perspectival properties, in the sense that they are possibilities of things to appear, based on the
pragmatic intention with which it is seen. Along the same lines, when I am at a furniture
showroom, looking for items of colors that could potentially be harmonious with other colored
items I own, objects and their colors would start showing up perspectivally, but not only in
terms of objective relations between objects, subject, and environmental conditions, but also in
terms of the pragmatic intention that guides my looking at them. The harmoniousness of a
shade of green with a beige lamp would not show up in many other perceptual interactions.
Although I don’t provide the full proof here for high-level properties as normatively governed,
the case of relations of familiarity or harmoniousness provides a clue about how a case of this
kind would stand in a content-normative sense.15
5.2.3 Master Argument for Pragmatic Normativity of Perceptual Content: A Pragmatic
System of Possibilities
Content has a normative element constitutively in it since the parsing of full
content=core+environing entails a series of relations of containment and sequentiality in the light
of the dynamism of perception that accounts for the way contents hold up together. This section
spells out those relations and other aspects constitutive of the normativity of content. SEP’s
take on content accounts for (i) the holistic character of perception and for (ii) the coexistence of
change and identity in perceptual continua, both these aspects being of normative significance.
15 Other types of high-level properties include perceiving particulars as natural kinds, perceiving agents performing actions, perceiving processes, relations like harmoniousness or familiarity, the hedonics of chemical senses, visual and haptic object recognition, and written word and speech recognition, among others. See 2.3.2.
230
The present arguments for the pragmatic location of content cash out the potential of the
parsing of content in full=core+environing. First, Environing content will be understood as a
pragmatically governed system of possibilities. This entails that core content is determined by
the perceptually relevant system of possibilities in which it is embedded.16 Two further aspects
are discussed in this section. The first one is that core content is partly defined in virtue of its
relation to a pragmatically related environing content, hence in virtue of its role in full content. The
second element is that environing content is defined in virtue of its nature as a system of
possibilities. This system of possibilities is horizonal in nature. This is what makes it possible for
environing content to be a geography in which core content can take place. As to its normative
and explanatory work, environing content does a good deal of work accounting for the relations
between the sides, parts, elements, and transitions that form perceptual continua.
The distinction between core content and environing content is one of structure and not a
hard distinction about two natures of content. All content is in a sense at the same level—the
level of possibilities. This is what allows core content to be dynamic and continuously change
within environing content. An apt analogy is a center of gravity. The center of gravity of a
volume is real but it is not one specific atom or molecule, and it moves around as the object
moves. The nature of content was resolved as a specific combination of perceptual object and
object-as-perceived, with the emphasis on the latter (section 4.1). A further but separate step is
the structural distinction between core and environing content (section 4.2). This distinction is a
desideratum of a theory of content, as argued at length in chapter 4, on account of the pragmatic
differential treatment of the specific object of our perception, however dynamic it might be, and
of the relation between change and identity, and multiplicity and unity in the perceptual object.
The structure of content presented in the equation full=core+environing is roughly
described as a combination where core content is the concrete object of our attention, action, or
16 In SEP, the domain of the perceptually relevant is broad. For instance, someone’s body smell may affect the possibilities of social interaction, including aspects of social distinction and class issues, giving rise to treatment of the other as the same, as indifferent, as superior, or as inferior, among others, wherever those distinctions are in place in human communities.
231
predication, among others, and environing content comprises perceptually relevant (i) objectual,
unintended aspects, and (ii) extra-objectual aspects and properties, extended temporally, (at
times) spatially, and modally, reaching all the way down to the moment of initial contact with
physical aspects of the world. The question that paves the way to understand the normativity of
content is: What makes all those aspects of content be contentful? The answer in the case of core
content seems evident: core content is contentful because it is that which I most attentively or
explicitly experience perceptually. If core content is the object of my perceptual experience, it is
precisely its being the object side of my interactive perceptual experience what makes it be the
content that it is. After all, content is but a specification of aboutness, just as experience is.
(Notice, however, that this does not specify everything that there is to know about core content:
it gives the most straightforward sufficient condition for something to be content, not a set of
the determinants that make a piece of core content to have the specific nature it has. For that,
we also need, on the side of content, the connection with environing content. Another aspect of
that definition comes from perceptual practices.).
Things are not this straightforward in the case of environing content: What makes the
objectual-unintended and the extra-objectual (hence also unintended) aspects contentful? What
makes them relevant for perception? The answer to this question is the mark of perceptual
normativity, and that answer, in turn, is the source for understanding the scope, depth, and
fineness of grain of perceptual normativity.
Let me put it in a different way: If content’s nature was already established following the
notion of object-as-perceived, of which the perceptual object is a part (the object that appears in
perspectives), why do core and environing content need an additional justification? Core content
can in any case ratify its membership easily. Some can object, however, that environing content
(objectual but unintended aspects, or extra-objectual aspects and properties of perceptual
wholes) is not clearly an object-as-perceived, hence not content in the first place. When singled
out, doesn’t environing content fall through the cracks? And to the extent that I said that both
232
environing and core are part of the same fabric of content, doesn’t all content lose its character
too? The answer is no and the argument I now present takes us to the whole system of
possibilities of which both environing and content transient and real specifications.
Environing content comprises aspects or properties of perceptual objects or situations that
are not explicitly intended, such as the color of a soccer ball as I kick it or the texture of the
surface of a table where I simply rest my hand, or the olfactory background on which further
smells can acquire significance as they come to be experienced. I am not paying attention to
those aspects but they somehow partake in my perceptual engagement with the world. How? In
what sense and way?
One might at first consider that what makes this type of content contentful is simply its
being sensationally present, that is, that all things that reach our sensory endings are part of
content, whether or not they make it to awareness. The problem with this merely sensational
description of such contents is, first, that it would force us to declare every element of sensory
impingement part of the content of a perceptual situation.17 This alternative partly is based on
the wrong assumption that our nerve endings are like doors always open through which
everything that fits gets through: that sensory impingement is the same meaning all the way to
experience. Further, this is not a good alternative because although what becomes content does
so first in virtue of being available sensorially, through our perceptual apparatus, it is so easy to
mistake the perceptually meaningful sensory with sense data, and sense data is a bad hypothesis
for reasons that have been profusely discussed in the literature and that I have addressed in
previous chapters. Thus, contenfulness of environing content is not availability of sensory
information per se, without an understanding of what a perceptually meaningful sensory
17 An argument that I don’t explore here is the argument based on the physiological fact that even at the nerve ending level, there are selective forces that determine what is felt, e.g. the simple case of sensory fatigue. Neurologically downstream things get even more complicated, for sub-personal processes already operated with filters upon impulses. Backward judging has the enormous problem of assuming that things of which we are phenomenally aware always had that specific interpretation, hence the idea that initial impulses were simply “captured.”
233
contribution means.18 That understanding is not to be found in the sensory information in some
sort of brute, basic level. Further, to insist on the merely sensory would make too big of a gap
between content and experience, and both content and experience are specifications of
aboutness, that is, there has got to be a common ground for both content and experience.
However, it is true that whatever comes to be content and experience must be able to be
felt. In section 4.2.1 where I talked about at an interpretive taking up of things of the world at a
very basic, sensory-like level. What is this interpretive taking up grounded on? Whatever this
interpretive taking up is grounded on, I argue, is the same ground on which content stands,
both core and environing. That ground is what makes content contentful, and on SPE’s view
that is the placement of content in a pragmatic system or field of references and expectations, of
possibilities and fulfillments.
Let’s start with what Husserl calls the present and the absent parts of the perceptual object,
and let’s proceed to analyze their relations. To start with, think of a relatively simple perceptual
experience, such as touching a book. Imagine that it is nice old volume and someone is admiring
it tactilely. We notice at once that the whole book is not perceptually present to the person at
each moment, and yet, regions yet-untouched of the book are present—the feeling of the book
right there includes aspects unseen. The whole book is present: it is not that the story ends
simply by noting that I don’t feel the parts I don’t see. There’s more than that.
Part of the book being present consists in the availability and likelihood of a normal, deft
exploration of the book, so that you would explore tactilely (also visually, perhaps olfactorily)
those regions you have not explored. One may also be examining a book (perhaps a thinner and
longer one) and find it suitable for scratching one’s own back—a desire that appeared suddenly,
connected in quite a simple way with quite a simple action, touching a book. But if it is an old
volume (perhaps someone’s treasure), it may not as easily become a back-scratching tool. I am
18 Even in information-process and functionalist frameworks, a syntactic requirement that a definition of the computational task and its logic are needed points to a deficiency in a notion of impulse that would be self-sufficient. Furthermore, the very idea of input needs to be specified in semantic terms, that is, in terms of how it will be turned into a specific representation (See Marr 1982).
234
certain that the reader gets my point: the domain of what is possible on the basis of the
perceptual is, in everyday life, multimodal and rather creative.
The object is always incomplete from the point of view of perception although it comes
with a sense of full presence. When we perceive an object there are certain aspects of the object
that are evident to me in a factual way: these are the sides of the book which I actually touch at a
moment. There are other aspects of the object that are experienced as perceptually present but
not directly. Strictly speaking I am not touching several sides of the book and yet, my entire
experience of the book is not only of one side of the book but of the whole book. In his Lectures
on Thing and Space, Husserl refers to this duality in terms of proper and improper appearances.
Proper appearances are supported by presentational content, that is to say, by sensorily
perceived aspects of objects in the world that give rise to a certain experience. Improper
appearances are supported by a system of intentional references that yield expectations to be
‘fulfilled.’ Proper appearances are full intentions, in Husserl’s terminology, because they are
intended perceptually and realized or fulfilled. Improper appearances are empty intentions, for
they intend an aspect of the object but that intention is not at the very moment fulfilled (Husserl
1997, 35–50, <42–60>).
In improper appearances, the intention may be said to be “synchronically” empty, but not
entirely empty. It in fact seems misleading to call it empty, since it is not empty in two different
senses. First, the object is given in what Husserl calls horizonal intentionality: as a part of the
consciousness of the object, the ‘hidden’ profiles are also given in experience (Gallagher and
Zahavi 2008, 96–97). In the case of a physical object perceived visually or tactilely, like the book
of the example above, its back side is given to me in experience. This means, on the one hand,
that I don’t experience the book as lacking the aspect I am not currently “sensing,” and, on the
other, that I am for the most part able successfully to interact with the book: I can grab it with
an appropriate grip, and at least begin lifting it with an idea (somewhat vague, for sure), of its
weight. Part of the background at work here is naturally our habituation with the world: we find
235
ourselves at home in the world. We find the world stable, dependable, and regular; we know
materials that have properties we are acquainted with (e.g. weight or resistance), and at the
basis of this are also physical laws. This stability of the world is part of the conditions on which
perception takes place in everyday life.
Second, the not-yet-present profiles are often pro-tended, that is, they are expected. In this
second sense, the situation is two-fold: the perceptual object is extended in time and since object
consciousness operates within a time-consciousness that pro-tends, any specific ‘chunk’ of
object-consciousness is part of a continuum formed by an impression that lingers on in
consciousness—retention—and protends, that is, paves the ground for the following ‘chunk’ to
appear, based on the type of object at stake. In a sense, this chunk of intention is forward-
oriented, or as Husserl would put it, anticipatory. In the broader, governing sense, perceptual
intention is dynamic and continuous. Perceptual consciousness would otherwise be impossible
(Gallagher and Zahavi 2008, 97).
Proper and improper appearances (to use Husserl’s 1907 terminology) are structured as
systems of perceptual expectations: if I am touching a book, say the back of it, and get to the
edge of the spine, my movement would likely proceed as if the next surface will be shorter, and
my intending to touch the spine of book will be a fulfilled expectation if such surface is in fact
shorter than the back of the book. Notice, however, that even if there is no “actual confirmation”
of the hidden side, in terms of actual sensation-based interaction, a certain fulfillment takes place
when the object behaves in accordance with those expectations.
These expectations are not cashed out as propositions; they are implicit in perceptual
action. It is now to be noticed that the system of expectations and fulfillments—a “system of
referential implications” or “pointings” (Hinweisen)—is a system of pragmatic possibilities on
which the core content may or may not take on determinations it did not have before. Husserl
describes this situation as follows, making the perceptual object “call out on us” and saying:
“There is still more to see here, turn me so you can see all my sides, let your gaze run through
236
me, draw closer to me, open me up, divide me up; keep on looking me over again and again,
turning me to all sides. You will get to know me like this, all that I am, all my surface qualities,
all my inner sensible qualities” (Husserl 2001a, 41, <5>). It is plain that the sensory dimension
does not stand by itself: perceived aspects of the world are not simply aspects passively received.
In the view that I am arguing, there is no clear cut between action and perception in several
ways, as I have argued in several places in this and previous chapters. One of the connections
occurs here, because the system of expectations is one of expectations as affordances, for what I
expect (implicitly, to be sure) is something I can or can’t do. The expectations are to be fulfilled
as I interact with the object, or rather, in virtue of my interacting in this or that way with the
object. A practically unsurprising object, then, is an object that fulfills expectations and in that
sense does not ‘disprove’ the original sense of reality that comes with our perceptual
experiences. Notice how the base line here is a normal world that at times may be “challenged”
and not a putative world that is “confirmed” at each step.
These expectations, or better, these referential implications have feelers in every direction:
towards more or less determination of the perceived object, or, also, for instance, towards more
determination in regards to one sensory property and the detriment of another. Their
fulfillment can both increase or decrease in saturation of the presence of the object, e.g. in the
form of smelling a dessert more fully as I approach the kitchen, or losing it as I walk away.
These evidence-giving sequences strengthen or weaken initial takes on things (Mohanty 2008,
392–394). In my view, it is crucial to see that this fulfillment of a system of references or
indications, of expectations, does not point towards a better perception of the object —for there
is no standard of “best” perception for every pragmatic situation in which a perceptual object is
present, and sometimes ‘best’ would be indefinable or very context-specific (think in a
background that is to remain precisely in that way)—, but in every possible direction of
coherent existence of perceived objects, including its disappearance from the perceptual field.
237
As we saw earlier, it cannot be a merely sensational criterion that characterizes
contentfulness in the case of environing content. The criterion (which is also common ground to
the interpretive taking up that takes place at the most basic level of content with physical
reality, as I’ll show below) is pragmatic in nature: only those objectual-unintended and extra-
objectual (hence also unintended) aspects that at least play a functional role in the transitions
between moments of perception are aspects of environing content, including transitions in
terms of affordances. These transitions, to make sure, operate in every direction: it is just as
perceptually meaningful a smell that fades away in its fading away, as it is a smell that will
always remain vague, as yet another one that increases in determination. In terms of
affordances, it is perceptually meaningful that an object appears as graspable, as one whose
‘graspableness’ fades away as the distance between subject and object gets longer.
There is an interesting yet puzzling consequence of my account, which I shall call the thesis
of unspecifiability of total content. The totality of contents of a perceptual interaction is
unspecifiable, for the horizon of possibilities that is opened up by a state of affairs (a specific
perceptual interaction) is always changing, becoming fulfilled or actualized at each moment in a
specific direction, thereby opeining new horizons. At the moment in which one course of action
or perception is pursued, others start to change, to morph, and some to disappear. Now, at the
moment in which only one state of affairs is pursued, the horizon of possibilities is in a sense
present as a repertoire of possible implications or pointings-towards of the actual state of affairs.
Those possibilities figure in content, exactly in that measure, as possibilities.
This unspecifiability of content is not the same as the radical incompleteness of perception, though
both belong to the open-ended nature of perception, its perspectival nature in a changing world.
The incompleteness of perceptions means that perception is never fully achieved because it is
about dynamic continua, constantly in change. The unspecifiability of content means that the
whole set of contents at a given moment cannot be pinned down, because some of them are
238
indeterminate, some are vague—they are possibilities that have not achieved their specific
determination. Some of these contents should rather be understood as fields of possibilities.
The pragmatic nature of content applies then full content. It applies to environing content as
field of possibilities in which more specific perceptions can happen, and as the concrete
background that gives its specific grain to pieces of core content. This pragmatic nature applies
to core content in two ways: first, core content is the object of our pragmatic endeavors, and
second, it is partly individuated by its connection to the field of possibilities surrounding it, such
that it acquires a specific grain or flavor, and such that it is part of a dynamic sequence in which
there is a continuous determination issuing from precisely the continuous dynamic nature of the
perceptual object. It follows from this partial determination, that core content would not have
its specific nature were it not placed in precisely such environing content.
The pragmatic normativity of content provides an intrinsic way of understanding the
relation between core and environing content, that is, between the explicit object of our actions
and predications and to the unintendend and extra-aspectual aspects of the systems of
perceptual possibilities in which whole perception takes place. The pragmatic normativity of
content also provides a way to provide a normative justification for the different aspects of
perceptual consciousness. The claim, in this sense, is that the determinate configuration of
full=core+environing is operative in an understanding of our awareness of things, of the way we
relate to perceptual objects in thought, judgment and inference, of perceptual-related action and
perceptual-related emotion (see 5.1.1-5.1.4 above).
The Ambulance Siren case of chapter 4, for example, helps to exemplify how the specific
determination of the siren at each moment has to do with the whole sequence in which it
appears to me. When the siren is away from me, I do not perceive it as entailing perhaps a
certain action on my part, such as making sure I am out of the way, but I may perceive it as
entailing a warning that it will come closer to me. I won't pursue a detailed elaboration of the
different ways in which I am related to the siren as I perceive it, but the general idea is that the
239
specific mode in which I am aware of it, or the particular actions or non-actions that I am called
upon at each time, can be partly explained by recourse to the structure of content. The fact, for
instance, that when the siren gets closer to me it starts to cover over the voice of a person I am
talking to explains my anticipations of what is to come (complete covering over of the voice),
my actions in that respect (pausing for a moment) and my awareness of it as a powerful presence
in my perceptual field, interfering broadly with many other immediate activities, including,
perhaps, a quiet, reflexive introspection moment another bystander may have had at that
moment. Yet, for the caught-by-surprise introspective bystander, the ambulance may mostly be
absent from her field of awareness, save for the moment of inescapable presence (when the
sound is very loud, and everybody around the person moves in function of the siren). This last
case highlights, once again, that the pragmatic orientation of a person in the world, her taking
of position, governs the perceptual interaction, for it even gives the inescapable a specific tone or
grain.
5.2.4 Environing Content at the Lowest Level
The explanatory desideratum of content (namely, that perceptual content functions as an
explanation of the transitions and transformation of the way the world is presented in
perceptual interaction) finds part of an answer in the lowest level of contact with a physically
defined reality. The pragmatic nature of environing content as a field of possibilities extends to
the lowest level of environing content. In this section, I wish to sketch SEP's take on perceptual
content at this level. While this aspect needs a fuller treatment, the overview provided in section
4.2.1 and here should suffice for the account of normativity in general.
Let us first recall that the idea of the lowest level of contact with the world is to be
understood as part of environing content. This lowest level (for which I initially took an inkling
from Husserl’s hyletic stuff) is the idea that there something to be said about the relation
between a physical world whose physical characteristics (reflecting light, having a certain
kinetic molecular energy, having a certain material composition, the vibrations of airwaves at
240
certain frequencies, etc.) make it possible for a being like me to perceive it, that is, for me to take
heed of it in the manner in which I do (as being visible, as having a temperature, as telling of
shape, as opposing resistance, as being audible, etc.). In one sense, then, this is an issue of
sensory modalities: it is about my engaging in perceptual relation with aspects of the world,
such that I am able to be about them in the way that the different sensory modalities (as well as
inter and multimodal interactions) are about things. In another sense, while all of our
perceptions involve an interaction that can be defined in this basic sense—the sound of the
french horn or the bassoon is still a piece of audibilia in the sense that a physical property of the
world is available for auditory interaction—, parts of environing content remain at an
undetermined low level which I have characterized as marginal, and as the level of the
perceptually unsatured—perceptual inklings. To borrow Thompson’s way of talking about this
(see chapter 4, n.36), some things remain weak as to the force of their affective allure, while
other emerge into “affective prominence or salience” (2007, 263–264). Affective, to be sure, is
appropriately perceptual since affectivity refers to what has “a kind of affective force or allure, or
affective ‘grabbiness,’ in relation to one’s attention” (2007, 263).
Let me then clarify the claim that the pragmatic rationale for environing content extends
to this most basic level of contact with the world. How to understand the pragmatic at play at
the lowest level? And the question is puzzling because in the previous section I built the
pragmatic account upon the denial that the merely sensory can individuate content. And yet, to
the extent that perception relates a sensory being to its Umwelt, in a way that couples senses
and sensibilia—to that extent there is, at least, a limiting character in what the sensory allows.
Sets of sensations are tied to specific sensory horizons, and not to others: for instance, what is
audible is closer to what is loud than to what is freezing cold, and it stands in continua of
audible material rather than in continua of felt temperatures. By the same token, what is tasteful
(taste-bilia) is closer to what is sweet than to what is dark, and it stands in continua of smells
241
and flavor rather than in continua of illuminations.19 Part of what gives a hypothetical sensory
chunk its character is precisely its standing in the midst of some modal sequences and not in the
midst of others, and those sequences are a determining factor in the pragmatic possibilities of
perceptual interactions.
While the dynamic account of content I am proposing involves causal determinants in the
workings of perception, it is not a causal domain: perception is not simply determined by the
physically defined realities to which a perceiver is exposed. Rather, it is pragmatic in the rich
sense that a person’s being in the world is determined by her pragmatic relations to things and
people.20 While SEP’s take on content does not exclude causal conditions, they are for the most
part built into higher, more socially-informed and personally-enriched levels.21 The riches of the
world of food, its combinations and ways of enjoyment in terms of where sequences,
temperatures, amounts, and mixtures (intra- and inter-modal) are partly built upon the physical
and chemical properties of material items that can be combined in some ways and not others
(e.g. drinks that must be drank fast before they sediment), food items that cool down relatively
fast and are to be eaten warm, proportions in intensity of flavor of, say, hot sauces, etc. One does
not find the meaningfulness of food at the mere sensory level, but sensory-material conditions
feature in the meaningfulness of food, for they have implications in the manners of consumption
and enjoyment.
The information-theoretic approach of Dretske is seemingly compatible with my proposal.
It may be helpful briefly to consider that view in order to spin the idea of the pragmatic nature
of perceptual content that I have been. The idea of seeing as simple seeing, consisting in rich
information delivery (channeled modally, or rather, getting informationally rich in virtue of
modality) with no epistemic upshot seems to capture all my environing content (Dretske 2000).
19 A related claim, belonging to the specification of the idiosyncratic dependencies, is that the materiality of the world, and the materiality-attunement of perceptive capacities (according to each type of being), conditions the modes and horizons of perceptual experiences: it sets their limits and possibilities, according to the specific sense-sensibilia matches, without precluding further non-sensational configurations deriving from personal history, intersubjective influences, or in general, circumstantial configurations that give (or impede) further shape to material interactions. 20 See my (Arango 2014) for an account of the pragmatic in relation to our being in the world around the Husserlian notion of Stellungnahme. 21 See (Rorty 2009, 165–212) for an even broader discussion of these topics in a general epistemological terms.
242
Dretske crafts these contents epistemically inane; all things epistemic depend on the conceptual
powers of perceivers, hence not on the information, however rich it is. But can this be so? Can
there be mere information with no epistemic value in itself? This is part of my rejection of the
sensational criterion for environing content. Information’s specific richness depends on a system
for which it is information, but the perceptual system, with so much fineness of grain even in
terms of sensory modalities, puts part of that richness in the information itself, even if it is not
fully defined at that level. This means, in turn, that ‘information’ —environing content—cannot
be epistemically inane. Modal channeling has, in SEP’s view, a meaningful, epistemic
component. It seems then that rich information is not epistemically empty and that it is its
placement on a system of possibly related processes or outcomes that makes such information
what it is.
I have said that what makes content what it is, even in the case of environing content, is
that it, at least, plays a functional role in the transitioning between moments of perception or
that it marks possibilities for affordances. I must confess that I am not entirely convinced that
my ‘at least’ carries the weight I think it carries. Part of the problem is that it is difficult to
conceptualize and determine the role of what is not explicitly perceived. An approach like
Dretske’s has the advantage of starting light. Yet, when analyzed in detail it seems as if he’s just
unloaded information from the role it plays, turning an at least into a nothing, and wrongly
sending that unloaded aspect into ‘higher’ levels. If the idea is that the role of
information/environing content is undefined and could therefore not be specified or adjudicated
to concrete perceptions, I object to thinking that the only way to deal with it is making its
relevance a matter of a higher, non-conceptual processing. That vagueness or undefined
character is already built into lower levels of perception. Here is an argument: a low-level
sensory acquaintance with the world is not good for everything—i.e. it cannot combine with
any thing whatever (sounds aren’t good for tasting). Rather, it is only good for some transitions
(from sweet to bitter, as opposed to from sweet to loud), and is only a possible antecedent for the
243
appearing of certain affordances and not others. That field of implicit and explicit possibilities is
part of the sensory modal aspect of the perception. Hence, it seems that even in a minimal sense
it can be argued that no perceptual content is epistemically empty, even when, as said before,
epistemic content that is merely a potential for possible transitions is never accomplished or
actualized.22
5.3. Objections
5.3.1 Crowell, Environing Content, and the Lowest Basic Level of Contact With Physical
Reality
At this point I have the resources to object to Crowell’s take on the sensory in his account of
normativity (2013), according to which there is no place for the sensory in the perceptual
because the normative, he says, must respond to norms that are either fully conceptual or at
least very determinate, as is the case of bodily action aiming at the successful, optimal grasp of
something. The general conception of environing content in SEP (the unintended), and
especially the most basic level of contact with the world (the unsaturated, perceptual inklings),
do not belong in Crowell's conception of determinate objects guiding bodily action. The
normative then does not reach to the undetermined in perception, such as the sensory
contribution to perception found in the lowest level of contact with reality, or in the radical
incompleteness o perception.23
Crowell seems to agree that the normative dimension in perception entails a system of
references or implications obeying the law of motivation and not the law of association or
causation (2013, 24-26). Here we see a parallel between these two Husserlian notions and
22 As a normative framework, the pragmatic system of possibilities and expectations that explains the long braids in which perceptual aspects occur offers intelligible connections between events. The normative connection is found preeminently in the pragmatic position-taking of the perceiver. There is, however, an aspect in which the answer is yet to be investigated: how to understand the traffic and transitions between lack of stimulus, unsaturation, and saturation. This issue must be postponed for further inquiry. 23 Crowell’s position is that Husserl did not have the resources to provide a truly normative account for the perceptual, whereas Heidegger did. I object to this reading. As my references to Husserl all along this work show, Husserl does have the apparatus to offer true normativity.
244
McDowell’s and Davidson’s space of reasons and space of causes. The difference between the two
domains is that in associations or causes there are only sequences of things that simply follow
one another, whereas in motivations and reasons there are relations that can be justified by a
subject, such that the non-necessary connections can be made intelligible to self or to another.
What is at stake is, in a sense, a space that is between natural necessity and randomness.
Perception, Crowell and I agree, is fundamentally located in that middle space.
Crowell identifies the system of references or implications as guided by a model of
intention fulfillment in which fulfillment is governed by a concept-like determination that
allows for a veridicality judgment, in which one succeeds or fails, and one of whose tasks is "to
provide warrant for our judgments" (2013, 125, 129). In Crowell's own words: "My perception,
and not just my judgment, has a meaning, and this meaning has a structure identical to that of
the corresponding judgment, namely, a conceptual structure" (2013, 126). I perceive something
and if I perceive it correctly if the thing is what I thought (judged) it was. Notice, first, that this
is the same model I criticized profusely in chapter 3: a philosophy of perception built around a
veridicality concern.
Crowell adds a type of bodily intention-fulfillment somewhat different from the merely
conceptual to veridicality according to concepts. In his view, the difference between conceptual
fulfillment and perceptual-bodily fulfillment is that perception admits to a type of
counterfactual. This counterfactual is based on mastery of sensorimotor knowledge that allows
us to infer variations in the perception of objects according to movement (Crowell 2013, 129,
143–144). I will not rehearse once again my arguments against a sensorimotor-only
understanding of perceptual interaction in chapter 3, which led me to postulate the three
dependencies of perception. My point here is to show the closeness of conceptuality with
optimality-directed bodily skill at work in Crowell. The key here is to look at the commitment
to a notion of veridicality having a central role in normativity. For Crowell, talking of
normativity is to locate oneself in a space in which we can ask how an experience “might go
245
wrong.” In other words, to experience something perceptually for Crowell involves setting
oneself in “reference to normative satisfaction conditions that determine what the thing is
supposed to be, a certain meaning that establishes how the current experience must necessarily
be related to (former and) subsequent experiences if the thing perceived is in fact what it gives
itself to be” (2013, 16–17; 129)(2013, 16-17; 129).
What Crowell rejects is the Husserlian view, which SEP spouses, according to which there
can be epistemologically rich, intentionally-laden, nonconceptual content at the level of what I
have been referring to as the most basic level of contact with the world, in which physical
realities are taken up by us as something perceptually meaningful (Crowell 2013, 138).24
It is not difficult to see in this context why for Crowell the undetermined character of what
is taken up at the interpretive level and is at times unsaturated does not have a role in the
normative: there are not satisfaction conditions for them; there is nothing that determines “what
the thing is supposed to be.” What motivates his take on perceptual content to be occurring at
the level of optimality-directed bodily skill is that his view is “norm-governed” in a strong sense:
“getting a better look at something depends on knowing how to look — that is, being skilled at
bringing oneself into the circumstances that will allow the optimal look to emerge” (2013, 142,
emphasis mine). Perception, for Crowell, is skill based, entails success conditions, and constantly
aims at improvement of one’s body’s stance in relation to a phenomenon. My central critique at
this point is that, although in SEP’s view these are possibilities for perceptual interaction, this is
not all there is about perceptual interaction. Just as I have argued that the sensorimotor does
not exhaust the possibilities for embodiment and enaction in perception, the normative is not
exhausted (i) by what can be subsumed under goal-oriented perception, and (ii) certainly not in a
way in which actual perception confirms seeming-perception. The latter point (ii), a version of
the veridicality concern, constitutes a fundamental difference between SEP and Crowell’s view.
The former point (i), about goal-oriented bodily activity, is possible in the context of SEP. In
24 In Husserlian terminology, the issue at stake has to do with the status of hyletic stuff (see 4.2.1 for details) and the role of the lived body as an orthoaesthetic system, that is, as a system of “concordant perceptions,” as Ricoeur puts it (1967, 50).
246
SEP, the perceptual and perceptual normativity extend to aspects of content that are not yet
defined or determined. Thus, a view like SEP’s differs from Crowell’s, among other things, in
allowing for vague and unsaturated aspects of perception, namely, the connections between
physical realities and the perceptual interpretive take on them. Further, the role of pragmatic
orientation even at this most basic level of contact with the world is broader than the bodily
skill directness of Dreyfus’ view, which Crowell adopts. The crux of the problem might be
condensed thus:
Even if there is a pre-conceptual level of consciousness where concatenations of sensory fields emerge through the associative syntheses of similarity, contrast, and contiguity — and even if all higher-order conceptual syntheses (such as judgment) presuppose such an organized "pre-given" sensory field — we still do not know how such an association can admit of normative assessment, without which talk of intentionality is empty (Crowell 2013, 139–140). In contrast to Crowell, SEP holds that the intentionality of perception operates within
pragmatically governed fields of possibilities in which the dynamic continua of perception are
structured in such a way that everything that is within their field of possibilities and
expectations is a legitimate fulfillment of perceptual intentions. These continua are always
directed to core contents, and those take a leading role in guiding perceptual continua. In SEP,
possibilities and expectations operates within an idea of gradual fulfillment, not with a hard
notion of confirmation, as Crowell does (2013, 23). (Perceptual surprises are exactly surprises,
but we all know that the surprising takes a moment to be understood as part of a world in which
new things occur.25) These fields of possibilities and expectations are based on the regularity of
the physical world, our habituation to our life on earth, to the internal constrain of sensory
modalities and, above all, to our skilled knowledge of perceptual practices, such that we stand,
25 SEP’s dynamic account of content is holistic in that it takes every bit of content to be located within full=core+environing in specific ways. But the sequences are not supposed to be always existing and always related to specific goals. One of the features of SEP’s normativity that Crowell’s theory, following Drefyus, cannot account for is that of the immediate perception of perceptual surprises where no optimality or specific direction of bodily stance improvement is in sight. A fitting example comes from William James: “Into the awareness of the thunder itself the awareness of the previous silence creeps and continues; for what we hear when the thunder crashes is not thunder pure, but thunder-breaking-upon-silence-and-contrasting-with-it" (James 1981, 240). SEP is perfectly equipped to deal with this case.
247
forward-looking, in the midst of perceptual continua knowing how to deal with, how to
manipulate, and what to expect of the perceptual realities we interact with.
To be clear, then, I agree with Crowell in the desiderata of a theory of normativity
regarding motivation or reasons. I have extensively accounted for a rejection of the causal as
capturing the nature of perception. I have, however, made some room for the causal in the
normative. SEP’s view understands causal impingements from the world as entailing
constraints on what is possible, and what is possible is a necessary basis for the pragmatic.
However, when these causal impingements can actually be called perceptual they have already
been subject to the interpretive taking up that is located at the most basic level. In Husserl’s
view, these are the ‘functional connections’ featuring in pyscho-physical correlations, that is,
between the causal impingement and the location of its subjective or presenting aspect
(Drummond 1990, 146–149). But precisely the presenting aspect is not just caused by a physical
aspect of the world. Although it is conditioned by the physical configuration of the world, its
sense is located in the domain of the personal, which is governed by motivations. Still, the
domain of motivation is a relation at the personal level, and this means that the pragmatic
depends on the goals of the person who lives a life of projects and complex activities. One does
not have a limb that is elevated, with an appendix at the end that is moved to the sides: one
raises one’s own hand and waves the hand to say hello to a friend.
In the specific domain of the most basic level of contact with reality, in which some modally
taken up aspects of the world are still ’sensory’ in a way, SEP holds that the pragmatic nature of
perception still governs the occurrence and the movements between unsaturation and saturation
of perceptual happenings. Crowell is wrong about ruling out normativity from this area of
perception, arguing that it is empty to place intentionality and content there because there is a
relevant sensory element. His mistake is to assume that every reference to sensation is a matter
of causal sequences and that only what can be experienced as guided by norms (and not just in
accordance with them) generates meaning (Crowell 2013, 28). For SEP, the normative system
248
belonging to perception includes the embodied, practical, and social levels, as Crowell grants,
but it also extends to (contra Crowell) to the basic level on which physical events in the world
are just taken up sensationally. This basic level does not constitute meaning is contentful
independently or in isolation, but only by belonging to a pragmatic system of references in
which it plays a functional role.
Linking this discussion back to the diachronic account of perceptual practices, it is
important to remember that conceiving of practices as the ground of normative relations means
that we are within the normative space when we act in accordance with shared ways of doing
things, but this does not require knowing why things are done thus or so, or being conscious of
doing things thus or so. In the pragmatic spirit of SEP, the normative does not come from a
distinction between acting “in accord with norms” and not “in light of them,” as Crowell holds—
between being guided by a rule, or simply acting according to a rule, in the Wittgensteinian
discussion. The pragmatic take I have been articulating rejects a semantic requirement ('how to
proceed' is fixed semantically), and consciousness of a semantic requirement ('knowing how to
proceed') as essential to perceptual normativity.
It is in this sense that there is normativity at the level of basic contact with reality. As
accounted in chapter 1, the partaking in perceptual practices means to relate to perceptual
things in the manner of unreflective engagements with seemingly given aspects of perceptual
reality.26 Skilled practitioners display the normativity of perception in their relation to sensory
properties and ranges of them, to harmony or disharmony relations, to possible combinations, to
available moves, and to connections to objects and events. Practitioners experience the
familiarity of these elements and are disposed to act in specific ways about them. The sharing of
meaning that takes place in the perceptual interaction with the world starts at the level of
familiarity with different sensory configurations, which is acquired by training and
acculturation.
26 See chapter 1 for a detailed discussion of the seemingly given, which is SEP’s extension of the Wittgensteinian take on Quine-analytic sentences. The seemingly given is at the basis of the structure of perceptual appropriatenesses and entitlements that belongs to shared ways of doing things, to practices.
249
5.3.2 Siegel's Comparisons and Properties
I dispute Siegel’s reasoning according to which accepting that properties are presented in
experience entails the (detachable) content view (d-content view, from now on). The d-content
view holds that properties are presented in perception and that accuracy assessment is necessary
for perception. Whether it is taken in a strong or a weak form (either understanding properties
propositionally or in a more 'neutral' framework, as Siegel puts it), the content view entails that
contents are detachable and comparisons can be made, and these comparisons are first of all
meaningful in order to check for accuracy. Checking for accuracy (what I have referred to as the
veridicality concern) is at the basis of Siegel d-content view. I call her view the detachable content
view because the rationale based on accuracy-checking and the possibility of comparisons
essentially assumes that contents are a type of things that are detachable or able to be
abstracted from experiences themselves. It seems, however, that the argument that takes her
from someone’s admitting that perceptual experience is also about properties (as SEP does) to
the seemingly consequential claim that perception involves detachable contents and that
accuracy checking is essential to perception trades on two equivocations: the meaning of
comparisons and the meaning of properties, and with properties piggybacking on comparisons.
Siegel claims that to hold that real objects or situations are constituents of experience does
not preclude the possibility of comparing the experience of a situation against the situation, even
when the situation is not separable from the experience (Siegel 2010, 69). She says: “When we
focus on the subjective character of the experience, comparing it with the situation in which it is
had seems to make sense, no matter what metaphysical structure it may have […] We can ask
whether things are as they appear. In making this comparison, we don’t have to make any
assumptions about the underlying metaphysical structure of the experience. So the idea of
comparing a Good experience with the situation in which it is had is not illicit,” even if those
experiences have objects, situations, and properties as non-detachable constituents (Siegel 2010,
69, emphasis mine).
250
The equivocation about comparisons rests on a confusion between a comparison making
sense and a comparison being licit or illicit. In saying that for Naive Realism comparisons of the
accuracy-check kind are illicit is to say that they are not real comparisons because they do not
compare things of the same kind (or of the ‘metaphysical structure,’ as she puts it). To say, on
the other hand, that it makes sense to make a comparison is to say that there can be some
common aspect between the compared items. Does this mean that they are of the same kind?
Does this mean that a comparison is always of things of the same kind? More specifically, the
question is whether they are of the same kind in relevant perceptual terms. The answer of SEP
is negative. See Wittgenstein's picture-object, a simple drawing of a face with a sort of neutral
smile. It makes sense to ask a boy whether the guy in the picture-object is like or unlike a crying
baby. The comparison is more evidently perceptual when the game accentuates the shape of the
smiling mouth or the frown. A father, for instance, can help the boy compare by exaggerating
the frown. What does not make sense is to say that the meaningfulness of this comparison is
based upon the perception of a smiling property in the Picture-object, detachable from it, and a
perception of a smiling property in a real face, detachable from it. For, in this case, the
comparison is not a mental putting side by side of elements already existing in the mind. Rather,
it is the ‘mastery of a technique’ consisting in singling out an element of a picture, or rather, an
aspect of it. It is an aspect that does not exist in isolation from the interaction with a perceiver,
suitably situated to see it as such. Being able to find an aspect in an object perceived and
compare it with others is, in this case, perceptually based, but it does not rest on some basic
structure of the direct objects of perception. The same goes for a comparison between the colors
of flowers in the nightmare I had last night, and the color of the flowers of the tree I am going
by. While it makes sense for me to tell someone about my nightmare and compare with the
color of real flowers, that does not mean that in my real perception of the flowers there is a
property that is represented, that is of the same kind as another property represented in my
dream, such that the two are color properties, one instantiated in a nightmare, one instantiated
251
in a tree's flower. This last move, to turn what makes sense into something licit, is itself illicit.
Comparisons like this one show that a comparison can make sense and be illicit by the more
stringent requirement of whether the things compared are of the same metaphysical structure.
A related issue has to do with the situation of asking whether things are as they seem,
which features a baseline comparison. I will not rehearse the arguments of chapter 3, where I
took good care of the veridicality concern, thereby setting SEP apart from that view. Right now,
I would like to add a couple of elements to it. First, I would like to point to how confusing
things get by the language used in the d-content view. In this case, the "intuition" that
perception is essentially in need of confirmation as to its accuracy reflects more of the
intellectual and verbal behavior of some perceivers, some of them are practitioners of
philosophy, that on the nature of perceptual experience. I accept that we can meaningfully ask
the question of whether things are as they appear. It seems that the English language in which I
write these words allows for such an utterance and its meaning to be intelligible. Take this as a
piece of verbal behavior. I propose that the explanation for this verbal behavior is that such a
question is meaningful vis-a-vis hallucinations (not illusions), and then imported to perceptual
situations. This route is blocked by SEP and its disjunctivist commitment.
Alternatively, such a statement is meaningful because it makes sense in the framework of
intra-perceptual comparisons. In that case, the question is rather about in what way a given
perspective stands in relations with a range of other perspectival aspects. This question is a heuristic
device in perceptual exploration. For instance, one may initially perceive a certain smell in a
friend’s kitchen that one takes to be the smell of X, although with a certain hesitation. One then
proceeds to smell more carefully to supplement the initial impression. SEP treats this case (and
like cases in other sensory modalities) as evidence that perception does not occur in snapshots,
but in sequences, and that everything that is given in perception is given perspectivally in
spatial, modal, temporal, and pragmatic ways, and that the more perspectives one has, the richer
the experience can be. One does not check the perception for accuracy. Rather, one explores and
252
supplements to be better acquainted with an object. And yet, we live constantly with partial
perceptions, that is, with a world that we take to be what it is as it presents itself to us,
‘knowing’ that most perceptual things would admit of further exploration to more fully
determine what things are from every point of view. The point of better exploring some things
is not to check upon initial but rather to get a richer perception of something, according to
pragmatic orientations. That is why the type of question of whether something is as it seems to
be makes some sense, and yet, why it should be understood along the direct realist,
interactionalist view of SEP, that is, understanding that the comparison aims not to confirm
whether X is X but rather to situate aspect X in a continuum of perspectival appearances that
are normatively structured in the manner elaborated in this chapter.
In sum, I bite the bullet that at times—when one is delirious or had a nightmare, one may
ask whether what one is seeing is true. The question makes sense but is rapidly suppressed
when confronted with the full perceptual sequences that immediately provide an internal
coherence of its own. I acknowledge, then, that there could be bad cases. (Let's recall that the
baseline for SEP is only the (minimal) ‘good case,’ where a perceiver actually interacts with an
external object). But in the good case (understood in sequential, continuous, dynamic terms),
where the question of whether things are as they appear makes sense but more in an open-ended
way, all comparison is intra-perceptual, and since perception is necessarily perspectival, there is
no room for a sense of accuracy in which contents could be true or false (Siegel 2010, 28).
Let us now look at the issue of properties. According to Siegel, accepting that properties
are presented in experience follows from something more basic, to wit: that some bits of
experience that can be compared with some other bits of experience. Whatever the ontological
status of properties is, Siegel's view seems committed at least to properties being detachable, so
that they can be compared with one another, thereby allowing a link to veridicality assessment
(2010, 48). Even with all the relatively neutral framework that Siegel uses to define properties
253
(2010, 71, n.45), I hold that she is committed to a version of properties characterized by some
abstract detachability. I will call hers strong perceptual properties or strong properties.
Strong properties are definitional of her description of perception: "Suppose you see a cube,
and it looks red and cubical" (2010, 48). This means, she says, that the experience presents the
properties of being red and being cubical. I suggest that one can look at Siegel’s view in this
other way:
A Strong Perceptual Property: A strong perceptual property is what is needed to make sense
of comparing things. A property is the type of theoretical entity that grounds a comparison
between two things in one respect, assuming that the making-senseness of comparisons means
that they are grounded on the real existence of the aspects compared.
This is because for an aspect to be compared with others, the argument goes, I should be
able to abstract that aspect and compare it with another. Because this comparison is possible
(including the baseline case of asking whether things are as they seem), it seems that properties
are detached from their worldly entanglement with things, that is, detached from the things
they are instantiated in.
But, as I have just argued in relation to comparisons, there is no reason to assume the
existence of properties prior to the comparison, because they are brought about by the practice
of comparing and guided by the type of comparison sought. In other words, if in a
transcendental fashion one concludes that the fact that comparisons are possible make it
necessary that there are strong perceptual properties, then what is needed is a different
conception of the explanandum generating other conditions of possibility. SEP has such an
alternative conception, which does not fall on the confused version of comparisons that Siegel
spouses.
A Strong Perceptual Property is an exaggeration: A strong perceptual property is an
exaggeration of what is needed to make sense of comparing things. A property is the type of
theoretical entity that grounds a comparison between two things in one respect, when one
254
misunderstands that the making-senseness of comparisons does not mean that they are
grounded on the real existence of the aspects compared.
Think in a comparison between a billboard and a certain building, more wide than tall. Can
I ask someone to compare whether both objects have something like a rectangular shape? The
question is perfectly meaningful, and in both cases I refer to a way of looking at the object by
relating width and length, but this absolutely does not mean that in my perceptions of the
billboard and the building (more wide than tall)—that is, in my immediate acquaintance with
the object as I walk down the street—I perceive a property, rectangularity, which I am then able
to compare to other geometric-like properties. By the same token, Siegel’s position seems to be
committed to saying that there will be a perceived property for every aspect that we could
reasonably articulate in questions or statements based on comparisons. This is evidently absurd.
The same holds for the use of the Picture-Object in the comparison with a frown.
In the case of the baseline comparison “Are things as they appear?” I argued that they are
intra-perceptual comparisons between different perspectives of possible continua, which are
normatively structure. So what properties are compared when I ask for intra-perceptual
comparisons? I must bring back the difference between perceptual properties and properties of
the objects, events, and states of affairs can further be specified thus: objects, events, states of
affairs and their properties are presented perspectivally in perception and can only do so. We are
acquainted with F but only via F’, F’’, F’’’, etc. If a perceptual presentation is only perspectival,
a perfect presentation (F as F) is an impossibility. Physical occurrences—e.g. material objects in
their modal aspects—cannot be experienced by perceivers but in perspectival sequences.
We are now in the position to revisit a rejection of the veridicality concern I presented in
chapter three. I identified the traditional commitment to veridicality by two points: binary
nature, in which objects are presented as they are, or as they are not (F or no-F) and discrete
nature, in which at each moment it is possible to assess whether appearances match reality or
not (F or no-F at T1). But SEP sees things differently. F=F’, F’’, F’’’, etc., and (1) All F’, F’’, and
255
F’’’ are Fs, in the sense that perceptual profiles actually reveal how things are F-wise, and (2) a
single F’, F’’ or F’’’, etc. could not be assessed in isolation, but only as a part of a sequence,
where F* could be deviant, but only in relation to F’, F’’, F’’’, etc. Siegel confuses P-properties
with properties of the object (strong perceptual properties). In SEP’s model of comparison, it
makes no sense to say: “F and no-F are the only and exclusive alternatives.” Rather, there are F-
wise properties. As a matter of fact, there is no perceptually meaningful standard that is not one
perspective among others, so there is no extra-perceptual instance that can ground judgments of
accuracy in any robust sense (see my elaboration of Ayer’s ‘privileged appearance’ in chapter 3).
The possibility of intra-perceptual comparisons is taken as grounding the internal-coherence
and horizonal nature of perceptual normativity that I have elaborated in this chapter.
This line of thought explains why SEP's position is compatible with some versions of Naive
Realism and Radical Naive Realism. According to Siegel, Naive Realism depends on whether
experiences are individuated “by the particular things that the subject of the experience
perceives” (Siegel 2010, 76). And: “As standard versions of Naïve Realism construe Good
experiences, those experiences contain the relevant situations as constituents” (Siegel 2010, 69).
Thus, while under Siegel’s classification, SEP’s position would be that of the Naïve Realist, that
would be a mischaracterization. I accept that we can meaningfully talk about perceiving
properties of the things we perceive, like the Naïve Realist and unlike the Radical Naïve Realist,
who says that we are only presented with objects and not with properties.
The Radical Naive Realist, in Siegel’s taxonomy, denies that a good experience requires
superstrong veridicality: “seeing o when o looks F, o is F, and o’s looking F is due to o’s F-ness”
(Siegel 2010, 37, emphasis mine). SPE understand “o looks F” as “o looks F-wise,” where F-wise
refers to all the possible presentations of F’, F’’, and F’’’ etc. The relation F - F’,F’’,F’’’ is a one-
many relation. SEP holds that “o is F” is underdetermined because F is not necessarily
predicable of o in the absence of the perceptual interaction (think of the color of a pond as one
walks around it), even if it is meaningful to talk in such terms. As it follows from my discussion
256
of Ayer in chapter 3, I dispute that “o’s F-ness” (hence “o is F”) has a determined meaning
outside of a perceptual interaction. This is because the F that belongs to the object is not the F
that appears in the specific profiles or perspectives that are presented in perception. In
perception there are Fs or ‘F-wise Fs’, not just F. Lastly, SEP also finds underdetermined that
o looks F “due to o’s F-ness” since it discards interaction as a source of perceptual
determination, and SEP’s interactionalist nature holds just the opposite. I hold that perceptual
mediations of the kind I call idiosyncratic dependencies—e.g. eyeglasses that systematically
correct what a person would see, a person having a cold, so it systematically alters for the time
involved what the person smells or tastes, or Siegel’s case of stimulation in brain area V1—are
not only no threat to a legitimate perceptual interaction, but they are part of the constituting
factors of perceptual interactions. Pragmatic dependencies, social and non-social, render “due to
o’s F-ness” underdetermined. In SEP’s view, the good case is constituted only by an actual
interaction with a proper object of perception. SEP denies the need for superstrong veridicality.
Furthermore, SEP takes superstrong veridicality to be wrongheaded about the nature of
perceptual properties.
References
Albers, Josef. 2006. Interaction of Color. Rev. and expanded pbk. ed. New Haven [Conn.]:
Yale University Press.
Almäng, Jan. 2008. “Affordances and the Nature of Perceptual Content.” International Journal of Philosophical Studies 16 (2): 161–77.
Arango, Alejandro. 2014. “Husserl’s Concept of Position-Taking and Second Nature.” Phenomenology and Mind, no. 6 (Summer): 168–76.
———. 2015. “Animal Groups and Social Ontology: An Argument from the Phenomenology of Behavior.” Phenomenology and the Cognitive Sciences, July. doi:10.1007/s11097-015-9430-2.
Aristotle. 2001. “On the Soul.” In On the Soul and On Memory and Recollection, translated by Joe Sachs. Santa Fe, N.M.: Green Lion Press.
Augustine. 1953. “On Free Will.” In Augustine: Earlier Writings, edited by John H. S Burleigh, 102–217. Philadelphie: Westminster Press.
Augustine, Saint Bishop of Hippo. 2009. Confessions of St. Augustine. Auckland, NZL: The Floating Press. http://site.ebrary.com/lib/alltitles/docDetail.action?docID=10808283.
Austin, J. L. 1962. Sense and Sensibilia. Oxford, Clarendon Press, 1962.
Ayer, A. J. 1947. The Foundations of Empirical Knowledge. London: Macmillan & Co.
Bang, M., D. L. Medin, and S. Atran. 2007. “Cultural Mosaics and Mental Models of Nature.” Proceedings of the National Academy of Sciences 104 (35): 13868–74. doi:10.1073/pnas.0706627104.
Bar-On, Dorit. 2013a. “Expressive Communication and Continuity Skepticism.” Journal of Philosophy.
———. 2013b. “Origins of Meaning: Must We ‘Go Gricean’?.” Mind & Language.
Barthosuk, Linda M. 1991. “Taste, Smell, and Pleasure.” In The Hedonics of Taste, edited by Robert C. Bolles, 15–28. Hillsdale, N.J: L. Erlbaum Associates.
Bermúdez, José Luis. 2007. “What Is at Stake in the Debate on Nonconceptual Content?” Philosophical Perspectives 21 (1): 55–72. doi:10.1111/j.1520-8583.2007.00120.x.
Block, Ned. 1999. “Ridiculing Social Constructivism about Phenomenal Consciousness.” Behavioral and Brain Sciences 22 (1): 199.
Bolles, Robert C., ed. 1991. The Hedonics of Taste. Hillsdale, N.J: L. Erlbaum Associates.
Brewer, Bill. 2005. “Perceptual Experience Has Conceptual Content.” In Contemporary Debates in Epistemology, edited by Ernest Sosa and Matthias Steup. Blackwell.
Burghardt, Gordon M. 1998. “The Evolutionary Origins of Play Revisited: Lessons from Turtles.” In Animal Play, edited by Marc Bekoff and John Alexander Byers, 1–26. New York: Cambridge University Press.
258
Butterfill, S. 2011. “Seeing Causings and Hearing Gestures.” In The Admissible Contents of Experience, edited by Katherine Hawley and Fiona Macpherson, 36–59. Chichester, West Sussex, UK ; Malden, MA: Wiley-Blackwell.
Byrne, Alex. 2005. “Perception and Conceptual Content.” In Contemporary Debates in Epistemology, edited by Ernest Sosa and Matthias Steup. Blackwell.
Byrne, Alex, and Heather Logue. 2008. “Introduction.” In Disjunctivism: Contemporary Readings, edited by Alex Byrne and Heather Logue, vii – xxix. The MIT Press.
Campbell, John. 2002. Reference and Consciousness. Oxford Cognitive Science Series. Oxford : New York: Clarendon Press ; Oxford University Press.
Chalmers, David J. 2006. “Perception and the Fall from Eden.” In Perceptual Experience, edited by Tamar Szabó Gendler and John Hawthorne, 49–125. Oxford University Press.
Chua, H. F., Julie E. Boland, and Richard E. Nisbett. 2005. “Cultural Variation in Eye Movements during Scene Perception.” Proceedings of the National Academy of Sciences 102 (35): 12629–33. doi:10.1073/pnas.0506162102.
Clark, Andy. 1998. Being There : Putting Brain, Body, and World Together Again. Cambridge, Mass.: MIT Press.
Cox, Trevor J. 2014. The Sound Book: The Science of the Sonic Wonders of the World. First American edition. New York: W.W. Norton & Company.
Crane, Tim. 2001. Elements of Mind: An Introduction to the Philosophy of Mind. Oxford ; New York: Oxford University Press.
Crowell, Steven Galt. 2013. Normativity and Phenomenology in Husserl and Heidegger. New York: Cambridge University Press.
Cussins, Adrian. 1992. “Content, Embodiment and Objectivity: The Theory of Cognitive Trails.” Mind 101 (404): 651–88. doi:10.2307/2254446.
Cutler, Anne. 1994. “The Perception of Rhythm in Language.” Cognition 50 (1–3): 79–81. doi:10.1016/0010-0277(94)90021-3.
De Jaegher, Hanne. 2009. “Social Understanding through Direct Perception? Yes, by Interacting.” Consciousness and Cognition 18 (2): 535–42.
De Jaegher, Hanne, and Ezequiel Di Paolo. 2007. “Participatory Sense-Making: An Enactive Approach to Social Cognition.” Phenomenology and the Cognitive Sciences 6 (4): 485–507.
Deroy, Ophelia. 2012. “Object-Sensitivity versus Cognitive Penetrability of Perception.” Philosophical Studies 162 (1): 87–107. doi:10.1007/s11098-012-9989-1.
Dretske, Fred I. 2000. “Simple Seeing.” In Perception, Knowledge, and Belief: Selected Essays, 97–112. Cambridge Studies in Philosophy. Cambridge, U.K. ; New York: Cambridge University Press.
Drummond, John J. 1990. Husserlian Intentionality and Non-Foundational Realism: Noema and Object. Contributions to Phenomenology, v. 4. Dordrecht [Netherlands] ; Boston: Kluwer Academic Publishers.
———. 2012. “Intentionality without Representationalism.” In The Oxford Handbook of Contemporary Phenomenology, edited by Dan Zahavi. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
259
———. 2014. “Comment on Alejandro Arango’s ’The Concept of Position-Taking and the Pragmatic Dependence of Perception".”
Flynn, Molly Brigid. 2009. “The Living Body As the Origin of Culture: What the Shift in Husserl’s Notion of Expression Tells Us about Cultural Objects.” Husserl Studies 25 (1): 57–79.
Gallagher, Shaun. 2005. How the Body Shapes the Mind. Oxford.
Gallagher, Shaun, and Dan Zahavi. 2008. The Phenomenological Mind: An Introduction to Philosophy of Mind and Cognitive Science. London; New York: Routledge.
Gély, Raphaël. n.d. Les Usages de La Perception: Réflexions Merleau-Pontiennes. Louvain-la-Neuve Louvain ; Dudley, MA: Editions de l’Institut supérieur de philosophie; Editions Peeters.
Gibson, James Jerome. 1979. The Ecological Approach to Visual Perception. Boston: Houghton Mifflin.
Ginsborg, Hannah. 2013. “Kant’s Perceiver.” Philosophy and Phenomenological Research 87 (1): 221–28. doi:10.1111/phpr.12044.
Gottfried, Jay A. 2005. “A Truffle in the Mouth Is Worth Two in the Bush: Odor Localization in the Human Brain.” Neuron 47 (4): 473–76. doi:10.1016/j.neuron.2005.08.002.
Guenther, Lisa. 2011. “Subjects Without a World? An Husserlian Analysis of Solitary Confinement.” Human Studies 34 (3): 257–76. doi:10.1007/s10746-011-9182-0.
Haddock, Adrian, and Fiona Macpherson, eds. 2008a. Disjunctivism: Perception, Action, Knowledge. Oxford University Press.
———. 2008b. “Introduction: Varieties of Disjunctivism.” In Disjunctivism: Perception, Action, Knowledge, edited by Adrian Haddock and Fiona Macpherson. Oxford University Press.
Heidegger, Martin. 1988. The Basic Problems of Phenomenology. Translated by Albert Hofstadter. Bloomington [etc.]: Indiana University Press.
———. 2010. Being and Time. Translated by Joan Stambaugh. Revised. State Univ of New York Press.
Henrich, Joseph, Steven J. Heine, and Ara Norenzayan. 2010. “The Weirdest People in the World?” Behavioral and Brain Sciences 33 (2-3): 61–83. doi:10.1017/S0140525X0999152X.
Hopp, Walter. 2011. Perception and Knowledge a Phenomenological Account. Cambridge; New York: Cambridge University Press. http://site.ebrary.com/id/10476482.
Horgan, Terence. 2013. “Original Intentionality Is Phenomenal Intentionality.” The Monist 96: 232–51. doi:10.5840/monist201396212.
Hume, David. 1977. An Enquiry Concerning Human Understanding; A Letter from a Gentleman to His Friend in Edinburgh: An Abstract of a Treatise on Human Nature. Indianapolis: Hackett Pub. Co.
———. 2000. A Treatise of Human Nature (Selections). Edited by David Fate Norton and Mary J. Norton. Oxford; New York: Oxford University Press.
260
Hurley, Susan. 1998. Consciousness in Action. Cambridge, Mass: Harvard University Press.
———. 2001. “Overintellectualizing the Mind.” Philosophy and Phenomenological Research 63 (2): 423–31. doi:10.1111/j.1933-1592.2001.tb00115.x.
———. 2006. “Active Perception and Perceiving Action: The Shared Circuits Model.” In Perceptual Experience, edited by Tamar Szabó Gendler and John Hawthorne, 205–59. Oxford University Press.
Husserl, Edmund. 1970. The Crisis of European Sciences and Transcendental Phenomenology; an Introduction to Phenomenological Philosophy. Translated by David Carr. Evanston: Northwestern University Press.
———. 1973. Experience and Judgement. Edited by Ludwig Landgrebe. Translated by James S. Churchill and Karl Ameriks. Evanston, Ill.: Northwestern U. P.
———. 1983. Ideas Pertaining to a Pure Phenomenology and to a Phenomenological Philosophy: First Book: General Introduction to a Pure Phenomenology (Hua III). Translated by F. Kersten. 1st ed. Springer.
———. 1989. Ideas Pertaining to a Pure Phenomenology and to a Phenomenological Philosophy: Second Book: Studies in the Phenomenology of Constitution (Hua IV). Translated by Richard Rojcewicz and André Schuwer. Dordrecht; London: Kluwer Academic Publishers.
———. 1997. Thing and Space: Lectures of 1907 (Hua XVI). Translated by Richard Rojcewicz. Dordrecht; Boston: Kluwer Academic Publishers.
———. 1999. Cartesian Meditations : An Introduction to Phenomenology. Translated by Dorion Cairns. The Hague: M. Nijhoff.
———. 2001a. Analyses Concerning Passive and Active Synthesis: Lectures on Transcendental Logic. Translated by Anthony J. Steinbock. Dordrecht; Boston: Kluwer Academic Publishers.
———. 2001b. Logical Investigations, Vol. 2. Edited by Dermot Moran. Translated by J. N. Findlay. New edition. Routledge.
———. 2005. Phantasy, Image Consciousness, and Memory (1898-1925). Translated by John B Brough. Dordrecht: Springer. http://dx.doi.org/10.1007/1-4020-2642-0.
Hutto, Daniel D. 2006. “Knowing What? Radical Versus Conservative Enactivism.” Phenomenology and the Cognitive Sciences 4 (March): 389–405. doi:10.1007/s11097-005-9001-z.
Hutto, Daniel D., and Erik Myin. 2013. Radicalizing Enactivism: Basic Minds without Content. Cambridge, Mass: MIT Press.
James, William. 1981. The Principles of Psychology (Chapters 4, 9, 10). Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press.
Kandel, Eric R., and James H. Schwartz. 2000. Principles of Neural Science. 4th ed. New York: McGraw-Hill.
Kant, Immanuel. 1998. Critique of Pure Reason. Cambridge ; New York: Cambridge University Press.
261
Kitcher, Patricia. 2013. “Précis of Kant’s Thinker.” Philosophy and Phenomenological Research 87 (1): 200–212. doi:10.1111/phpr.12042.
Klatzky, Roberta, and Susan Lederman. 2003. “The Haptic Identification of Everyday Life Objects.” In Touching for Knowing: Cognitive Psychology of Haptic Manual Perception, edited by Yvette Hatwell, Arlette Streri, and Edouard Gentaz, 105–21. Advances in Consciousness Research, v. 53. Amsterdam ; Philadelphia: John Benjamins Pub.
Krebs, Víctor J. 2010. “The Bodily Root: Seeing Aspects and Inner Experience.” In Seeing Wittgenstein Anew, edited by William Day and Víctor J. Krebs, 120–39. Cambridge ; New York: Cambridge University Press.
Kripke, Saul A. 1982. Wittgenstein on Rules and Private Language: An Elementary Exposition. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press.
Lance, Mark Norris, and John O’Leary-Hawthorne. 1997. The Grammar of Meaning: Normativity and Semantic Discourse. 1 edition. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Lave, Jean, and Etienne Wenger. 1991. Situated Learning: Legitimate Peripheral Participation. Learning in Doing. Cambridge [UK]; New York: Cambridge University Press.
Levinas, E. 1963. Théorie de L’intuition Dans La Phénoménologie de Husserl. Bibliothèque D’histoire de La Philosophie. Paris: J. Vrin. http://books.google.com/books?id=SENXmgEACAAJ.
Lévinas, Emmanuel. 1995. The Theory of Intuition in Husserl’s Phenomenology. 2nd ed. Northwestern University Studies in Phenomenology & Existential Philosophy. Evanston, Ill: Northwestern University Press.
Loar, Brian. n.d. “Phenomenal Intentionality as the Basis of Mental Content.” In Reflections and Replies: Essays on the Philosophy of Tyler Burge, edited by Martin Hahn and Bjørn Ramberg.
Logothetis, Nikos. 2000. “Object Recognition: Holistic Representations in the Monkey Brain.” Spatial Vision 13 (2): 165–78. doi:10.1163/156856800741180.
Logue, Heather. 2012. “IX—Why Naive Realism?” Proceedings of the Aristotelian Society (Hardback) 112 (2pt2): 211–37. doi:10.1111/j.1467-9264.2012.00332.x.
Lugones, María. 1987. “Playfulness, ‘World’-Travelling, and Loving Perception.” Hypatia 2 (2): 3–19.
Marr, David. 1982. Vision. Freeman.
Martin, M. G. F. 2008. “The Reality of Appearances.” In Disjunctivism: Contemporary Readings, edited by Alex Byrne and Heather Logue, 91–115. The MIT Press.
Masuda, Takahiko, and Richard E. Nisbett. 2001. “Attending Holistically versus Analytically: Comparing the Context Sensitivity of Japanese and Americans.” Journal of Personality and Social Psychology 81 (5): 922–34. doi:10.1037//0022-3514.81.5.922.
McCandliss, Bruce D., Laurent Cohen, and Stanislas Dehaene. 2003. “The Visual Word Form Area: Expertise for Reading in the Fusiform Gyrus.” Trends in Cognitive Sciences 7 (7): 293–99. doi:10.1016/S1364-6613(03)00134-7.
McDowell, John. 1984. “Wittgenstein on Following a Rule.” Synthese 58 (March): 325–64.
262
———. 1994. Mind and World. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press.
———. 2008. “Selections from ‘Criteria, Defeasibility, and Knowledge.’” In Disjunctivism: Contemporary Readings, edited by Alex Byrne and Heather Logue, 75–90. The MIT Press.
McGann, Marek, and Hanne De Jaegher. 2009. “Self–other Contingencies: Enacting Social Perception.” Phenomenology and the Cognitive Sciences 8 (4): 417–37. doi:10.1007/s11097-009-9141-7.
Mead, George Herbert. 1967. Mind, Self, and Society; from the Standpoint of a Social Behaviorist. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Medina, José. 2002. The Unity of Wittgenstein’s Philosophy: Necessity, Intelligibility, and Normativity. SUNY Series in Philosophy. Albany: State University of New York Press.
———. 2003. “Identity Trouble: Disidentification and the Problem of Difference.” Philosophy and Social Criticism 29 (6): 655–80.
———. 2006. Speaking from Elsewhere: A New Contextualist Perspective on Meaning, Identity, and Discursive Agency. Albany: State University of New York Press.
———. 2010. “Wittgenstein as a Rebel: Dissidence and Contestation in Discursive Practices.” International Journal of Philosophical Studies 18 (1): 1–29. doi:10.1080/09672551003592227.
Medin, Douglas L., and Scott Atran. 2004. “The Native Mind: Biological Categorization and Reasoning in Development and Across Cultures.” Psychological Review 111 (4): 960–83. doi:10.1037/0033-295X.111.4.960.
Merleau-Ponty, Maurice. 1942. La Structure Du Comportement. Paris: Presses Universitaires de France.
———. 2002. Phenomenology of perception. London; New York: Routledge.
Micali, Stefano. 2012. “Zur Aktualität Der Phänomenologie Husserls.” Philosophische Rundschau 59 (2): 135–59. doi:10.1628/003181512801313391.
Mohanty, Jitendranath. 2008. Philosophy of Edmund Husserl : A Historical Development. New Haven: Yale University Press.
Mole, Christopher. 2010. “The Motor Theory of Speech Perception.” In Sounds and Perception: New Philosophical Essays, edited by Matthew Nudds and Casey O’Callaghan, 211–33. Oxford University Press.
Nagel, Thomas. 1974. “What Is It like to Be a Bat?” Philosophical Review 83 (October): 435–50.
Noë, Alva. 2004. Action in Perception. Cambridge, Mass.: MIT Press.
———. 2012. Varieties of Presence. Cambridge, Mass: Harvard University Press.
Norenzayan, Ara, Incheol Choi, and Kaiping Peng. 2007. “Perception and Cognition.” In Handbook of Cultural Psychology, edited by Shinobu Kitayama and Dov Cohen, 569–94. New York: Guilford Press.
O’Callaghan, Casey. 2007. Sounds : A Philosophical Theory. Oxford; New York: Oxford University Press.
263
———. 2009. “Auditory Perception.” In The Stanford Encyclopedia of Philosophy, edited by Edward N. Zalta, Summer 2009. http://plato.stanford.edu/archives/sum2009/entries/perception-auditory/.
O’Regan, J. Kevin, and Alva Noë. 2001. “A Sensorimotor Account of Vision and Visual Consciousness.” Behavioral and Brain Sciences 24 (5): 939.
Peacocke, Christopher. 1992. A Study of Concepts. Cambridge, Mass.: MIT Press.
Pellis, Sergio M., and Vivien C. Pellis. 1998. “The Structure-Function Interface in the Analysis of Play Fighting.” In Animal Play, edited by Marc Bekoff and John Alexander Byers, 115–40. New York: Cambridge University Press.
Pietersma, Henry. 2000. Phenomenological Epistemology. New York: Oxford University Press.
Porter, Jess, Tarini Anand, Brad Johnson, Rehan M. Khan, and Noam Sobel. 2005. “Brain Mechanisms for Extracting Spatial Information from Smell.” Neuron 47 (4): 581–92.
Price, H. H. 1950. Perception. 2nd. Revised. London: Methuen & Co.
Putnam, Hilary. 1999. The Threefold Cord: Mind, Body, and World. New York: Columbia University Press.
Ricoeur, Paul. 1967. Husserl: An Analysis of His Phenomenology. Translated by Edward G. Ballard and Lester E. Embree. Northwestern University Press.
Rorty, Richard, ed. 1992. The Linguistic Turn: Essays in Philosophical Method. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
———. 2009. Philosophy and the Mirror of Nature. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press.
Ryle, Gilbert. 2002. “The Concept of Mind (Selections).” In Philosophy of Mind : Classical and Contemporary Readings, edited by David J. Chalmers, 32–38. New York; Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Salisbury, David F. 2013. “Robot Evolution.” Vanderbilt Magazine.
Schellenberg, Susanna. Forthcoming. “The Relational and Representational Character of Perceptual Experience.” In Does Perception Have Content?. Oxford University Press.
———. 2007. “Action and Self-Location in Perception.” Mind 116 (463): 603–32. doi:10.1093/mind/fzm603.
———. 2011. “Perceptual Content Defended.” Noûs 45 (4): 714–50. doi:10.1111/j.1468-0068.2010.00791.x.
Schulkin, Jay. 1991. “Hedonic Consequences of Salt Hunger.” In The Hedonics of Taste, edited by Robert C. Bolles, 89–105. Hillsdale, N.J: L. Erlbaum Associates.
Sclafani, Anthony. 1991. “The Hedonics of Sugar and Starch.” In The Hedonics of Taste, edited by Robert C. Bolles, 59–87. Hillsdale, N.J: L. Erlbaum Associates.
Searle, John R. 1980. “Minds, Brains, and Programs.” Behavioral and Brain Sciences 3: 417–24. doi:10.1017/S0140525X00005756.
Shoemaker, Sidney. 2006. “On the Way Things Appear.” In Perceptual Experience, edited by Tamar Szabó Gendler and John Hawthorne, 461–80. Oxford University Press.
264
Siegel, Susanna. 2006. “Which Properties Are Represented in Perception?” In Perceptual Experience, edited by Tamar Szabó Gendler and John Hawthorne, 481–503. Oxford University Press.
———. 2010. The Contents of Visual Experience. Philosophy of Mind Series. New York: Oxford University Press.
———. 2011a. “The Contents of Perception.” In The Stanford Encyclopedia of Philosophy, edited by Edward N. Zalta, Winter 2011. http://plato.stanford.edu/archives/win2011/entries/perception-contents/.
———. 2011b. “The Visual Experience of Causation.” In The Admissible Contents of Experience, edited by Katherine Hawley and Fiona Macpherson, 150–71. Chichester, West Sussex, UK ; Malden, MA: Wiley-Blackwell.
Silins, Nicholas. 2013. “The Significance of High-Level Content.” Philosophical Studies 162 (1): 13–33. doi:10.1007/s11098-012-9991-7.
Small, Dana M., Johannes C. Gerber, Y. Erica Mak, and Thomas Hummel. 2005. “Differential Neural Responses Evoked by Orthonasal versus Retronasal Odorant Perception in Humans.” Neuron 47 (4): 593–605. doi:10.1016/j.neuron.2005.07.022.
Smith, Barry C. 2010. “Speech Sounds and the Direct Meeting of Minds.” In Sounds and Perception: New Philosophical Essays, edited by Matthew Nudds and Casey O’Callaghan, 183–210. Oxford University Press.
Snowdon, Paul. 1992. “How to Interpret ‘Direct Perception.’” In The Contents of Experience, edited by Tim Crane, 48–78. Cambridge University Press.
———. 2008. “The Objects of Perceptual Experience.” In Disjunctivism: Contemporary Readings, edited by Alex Byrne and Heather Logue, 49–74. The MIT Press.
Stein, Edith. 1964. On the Problem of Empathy. The Hague: M. Nijhoff.
Stevenson, Richard. 2009. The Psychology of Flavour. 1st ed. Oxford University Press, USA.
Tarr, Michael J., and Yi D. Cheng. 2003. “Learning to See Faces and Objects.” Trends in Cognitive Sciences 7 (1): 23–30. doi:10.1016/S1364-6613(02)00010-4.
Taylor, Charles. 2005. “Merleau-Ponty and the Epistemological Picture.” In The Cambridge Companion to Merleau-Ponty, 26–49. Cambdrige; New York: Cambridge University Press.
Thompson, Evan. 2007. Mind in Life: Biology, Phenomenology, and the Sciences of Mind. Cambridge, Mass.; London: Belknap.
———. 2009. “Mind in Life: Biology, Phenomenology, and the Sciences of Mind.” Phenomenology and the Cognitive Sciences 8 (1): 151–58.
Toribio, Josefa. 2007. “Nonconceptual Content.” Philosophy Compass 2 (3): 445–8211.
Tye, Michael. 2005. “On the Nonconceptual Content of Experience.” Schriftenreihe-Wittgenstein Gesellschaft.
Varela, Francisco J., Evan Thompson, and Eleanor Rosch. 1991. The Embodied Mind: Cognitive Science and Human Experience. Cambridge, Mass.: MIT Press.
265
Vohs, K. D., Y. Wang, F. Gino, and M. I. Norton. 2013. “Rituals Enhance Consumption.” Psychological Science 24 (9): 1714–21. doi:10.1177/0956797613478949.
Waldenfels, Bernard. 2000. “The Paradox of Expression.” In Chiasms : Merleau-Ponty’s Notion of Flesh, edited by Fred Evans and Leonard Lawlor, 89–102. Albany, NY: State University of New York Press.
Wartofsky, Marx. 1979a. Models: Representation and the Scientific Understanding. Dordrecht Holland ;;Boston: D. Reidel Pub. Co.
———. 1979b. “Perception, Representation, and the Forms of Action: Towards and Historical Epistemology.” In Models: Representation and the Scientific Understanding. Dordrecht Holland ;;Boston: D. Reidel Pub. Co.
Watson, Duncan M. 1998. “Kangaroos at Play: Play Behavior in the Macropodoidea.” In Animal Play, edited by Marc Bekoff and John Alexander Byers, 61–95. New York: Cambridge University Press.
Watters, Ethan. 2013. “We Aren’t the World.” Pacific Standard. February 25. http://www.psmag.com/magazines/pacific-standard-cover-story/joe-henrich-weird-ultimatum-game-shaking-up-psychology-economics-53135/.
Welton, Donn. 2000. The Other Husserl : The Horizons of Transcendental Phenomenology. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Williams, Meredith. 1999. Wittgenstein, Mind, and Meaning: Toward a Social Conception of Mind. Routledge.
Winerman, Lea. 2006. “The Culture-Cognition Connection: Recent Research Suggests That Westerners and East Asians See the World Differently–literally.” American Psychological Association. February. http://www.apa.org/monitor/feb06/connection.aspx.
Wittgenstein, Ludwig. 1965. Preliminary Studies for the “Philosophical Investigations”: Generally Known as the Blue and Brown Books. New York: Harper Perennial.
———. 1982. Last Writings on the Philosophy of Psychology. Edited by G. H. von Wright and Heikki Nyman. Translated by C. G. Luckhardt and Maximilian A. E. Aue. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
———. 2004. Remarks on Colour. Edited by G. E. M. Anscombe. Translated by Linda L. MacAlister and Margarete Schättle. 1. publ., [repr.]. Oxford: Blackwell.
———. 2009a. Philosophical Investigations (Philosophische Untersuchungen). Translated by G. E. M Anscombe, P. M. S. Hacker, and Joachim Schulte. Rev. 4th ed. / by P.M.S. Hacker and Joachim Schulte. West Sussex; Malden: Wiley-Blackwell.
———. 2009b. “Philosophy of Psychology - A Fragment [Previously Known as ‘Part II’ of the Philosophical Investigations].” In Philosophical Investigations (Philosophische Untersuchungen), translated by G. E. M Anscombe, P. M. S. Hacker, and Joachim Schulte, 173rd–265th ed. West Sussex; Malden: Wiley-Blackwell.
Zahavi, Dan. 2003. Husserl’s Phenomenology. Stanford, Calif: Stanford University Press.
———. 2010. “Empathy, Embodiment and Interpersonal Understanding: From Lipps to Schutz.” Inquiry 53 (3): 285–306. doi:10.1080/00201741003784663.
266
———. 2011. “Empathy and Direct Social Perception: A Phenomenological Proposal.” Review of Philosophy and Psychology 2 (3): 541–58. doi:10.1007/s13164-011-0070-3.
———. 2013. “Mindedness, Mindlessness, and First-Person Authority.” In Mind, Reason, and Being-in-the-World: The McDowell-Dreyfus Debate, edited by Joseph K. Schear, 320–43. Abingdon, Oxon ; New York: Routledge.
Zellner, Debra A. 1991. “How Foods Get to Be Liked: Some General Mechanisms and Some Special Cases.” In The Hedonics of Taste, edited by Robert C. Bolles, 199–217. Hillsdale, N.J: L. Erlbaum Associates.